2007 Acura RDX Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout this manual) to navigate through this reference. For a printed owner's manual, click on authorized manuals or go to www.helminc.com. Contents Owner's Identification Form Introduction ......................................................................................................................................... i A Few Words About Safety ................................................................................................................ iii Your Vehicle at a Glance ..................................................................................................................... 3 Driver and Passenger Safety .............................................................................................................. 5 Proper use and care of your vehicle's seat belts, and Supplemental Restraint System. Instruments and Controls ................................................................................................................. 61 Instrument panel indicator and gauge, and how to use dashboard and steering column controls. Comfort and Convenience Features .............................................................................................. 169 How to operate the climate control system, the audio system, and other convenience features. Before Driving.................................................................................................................................. 277 What gasoline to use, how to break-in your new vehicle, and how to load luggage and other cargo. Driving .............................................................................................................................................. 291 The proper way to start the engine, shift the transmission, and park, plus towing a trailer. Maintenance ..................................................................................................................................... 327 The Maintenance Schedule shows you when you need to take your vehicle to the dealer. Taking Care of the Unexpected ...................................................................................................... 381 This section covers several problems motorists sometimes experience, and how to handle them. Technical Information ..................................................................................................................... 405 ID numbers, dimensions, capacities, and technical information. Warranty and Customer Relations (U.S. and Canada) ................................................................ 421 A summary of the warranties covering your new Acura, and how to contact us. Authorized Manuals (U.S. only)...................................................................................................... 425 How to order manuals and other technical literature. Index...................................................................................................................................................... I Service Information Summary A summary of information you need when you pull up to the fuel pump.
This document is posted to help you gain knowledge. Please leave a comment to let me know what you think about it! Share it to your friends and learn new things together.
Transcript
2007 Acura RDX Online Reference Owner's Manual Use these links (and links throughout this manual) to navigate through this reference. For a printed owner's manual, click on authorized manuals or go to www.helminc.com.
Contents
Owner's Identification Form
Introduction .........................................................................................................................................i A Few Words About Safety ................................................................................................................iii
Your Vehicle at a Glance .....................................................................................................................3 Driver and Passenger Safety ..............................................................................................................5 Proper use and care of your vehicle's seat belts, and Supplemental Restraint System. Instruments and Controls ................................................................................................................. 61 Instrument panel indicator and gauge, and how to use dashboard and steering column controls. Comfort and Convenience Features .............................................................................................. 169 How to operate the climate control system, the audio system, and other convenience features. Before Driving.................................................................................................................................. 277What gasoline to use, how to break-in your new vehicle, and how to load luggage and other cargo. Driving .............................................................................................................................................. 291 The proper way to start the engine, shift the transmission, and park, plus towing a trailer. Maintenance ..................................................................................................................................... 327 The Maintenance Schedule shows you when you need to take your vehicle to the dealer. Taking Care of the Unexpected ...................................................................................................... 381 This section covers several problems motorists sometimes experience, and how to handle them. Technical Information..................................................................................................................... 405 ID numbers, dimensions, capacities, and technical information. Warranty and Customer Relations (U.S. and Canada) ................................................................ 421A summary of the warranties covering your new Acura, and how to contact us. Authorized Manuals (U.S. only)...................................................................................................... 425 How to order manuals and other technical literature. Index...................................................................................................................................................... I
Service Information Summary A summary of information you need when you pull up to the fuel pump.
Accord Value Package Audio System
This owner’s manual should be considereda permanent part of the vehicle and shouldremain with the vehicle when it is sold.
This owner’s manual covers all models ofthe Acura RDX. You may find descriptionsof equipment and features that are not onyour particular vehicle.
The information and specifications includedin this publication were in effect at the timeof approval for printing. Honda Motor Co.,Ltd. reserves the right, however, todiscontinue or change specifications ordesign at any time without notice andwithout incurring any obligation whatsoever.
Owner’s Identif ication
POUR CLIENTS CANADIENAVIS IMPORTANT: Si vous avezbesoin d’un Manuel du Conducteuren français, veuillez demander àvotre concessionnaire decommander le numéro de pièce33STKC00
OWNER
ADDRESS
V. I. N.
DELIVERY DATE
DEALER NAME DEALER NO.
ADDRESS
OWNER’S SIGNATURE
DEALER’S SIGNATURE
STREET
CITY STATE/PROVINCE ZIP CODE/POSTAL CODE
(Date sold to original retail purchaser)
STREET
CITY STATE/PROVINCE ZIP CODE/POSTAL CODE
One of the best ways to enhance the enjoyment of your new vehicle is toread this manual. In it, you will learn how to operate its driving controls andconvenience items. Afterwards, keep this owner’s manual in your vehicle soyou can refer to it at any time.
Several warranties protect your new vehicle. Read the warranty bookletthoroughly so you understand the coverages and are aware of your rightsand responsibilities.
As you read this manual, you willfind information that is preceded bya symbol. Thisinformation is intended to help youavoid damage to your vehicle, otherproperty, or the environment.
Congratulations! Your selection of a 2007 Acura RDX was a wise investment.It will give you years of driving pleasure.
Maintaining your vehicle according to the maintenance minder shown in theinstrument panel helps to keep your driving trouble-free while it preservesyour investment. When your vehicle needs maintenance, keep in mind thatyour dealer’s staff is specially trained in servicing the many systems uniqueto your vehicle. Your dealer is dedicated to your satisfaction and will bepleased to answer any questions and concerns.
Introduction
i
06/05/19 14:16:57 31STK600 0002
California Proposition 65 Warning
This product contains or emits chemicals known to the state of California to cause cancer and birthdefects or other reproductive harm.
Event Data RecordersThis vehicle is equipped with one or more devices commonly referred to as event data recorders. These devicesrecord front seat belt use, front passenger seat occupancy, airbag deployment data, and the failure of any airbagsystem component. This data belongs to the vehicle owner and may not be accessed by anyone else except as legallyrequired or with the permission of the vehicle owner.
Service Diagnostic RecordersThis vehicle is equipped with service-related devices that record information about powertrain performance. The datacan be used to verify emissions law requirements and/or help technicians diagnose and solve service problems. It mayalso be combined with data from other sources for research purposes, but it remains confidential and is never linked tothe vehicle owner.
WARNING:
Introduction
ii
06/06/16 19:02:01 31STK600 0003
-California Perchlorate Contamination Prevention ActThe airbags, seat belt tensioners, and CR type batteries in this vehicle contain perchlorate materials specialhandling may apply. See www.dtsc.ca.gov/hazardouswaste/perchlorate.
-
--
-
--
Your safety, and the safety of others,is very important. And operating thisvehicle safely is an importantresponsibility.
To help you make informeddecisions about safety, we haveprovided operating procedures andother information on labels and inthis manual. This information alertsyou to potential hazards that couldhurt you or others.
Of course, it is not practical orpossible to warn you about all thehazards associated with operating ormaintaining your vehicle. You mustuse your own good judgement.
You will find this important safety information in a variety of forms,including:
This entire book is filled with important safety information please read itcarefully.
how to use this vehicle correctly and safely.such as Driver and Passenger Safety.
such as Important Safety Reminders or ImportantSafety Precautions.
These signal words mean:
preceded by a safety alert symbol and one ofthree signal words: , , or .
on the vehicle.
InstructionsSafety Section
Safety Headings
Safety MessagesSafety Labels
A Few Words About Safety
DANGER WARNING CAUTION
iii
You CAN be HURT if you don’t followinstructions.
You CAN be KILLED or SERIOUSLYHURT if you don’t follow instructions.
You WILL be KILLED or SERIOUSLYHURT if you don’t follow instructions.
06/05/19 14:17:11 31STK600 0004
These advantages come at some cost. Because your vehicle is taller and rides higher off the ground, it has a highcenter of gravity. This means your vehicle can tip or roll over if you make abrupt turns. Utility vehicles have asignificantly higher rollover rate than other types of vehicles. In a rollover crash, an unbelted person is significantlymore likely to die than a person wearing a seat belt. As a reminder, make sure you and your passengers always wearseat belts.
For information on how to reduce the risk of rollover, read ‘‘Driving Guidelines’’ on page of this manual and thesection on page . Failure to operate your vehicle correctly might result in loss of
control or an accident.
Your RDX has higher ground clearance than a passenger vehicle designed for use only on pavement. Higher groundclearance has many advantages for off-highway driving. It allows you to travel over bumps, obstacles, and roughterrain. It also provides good visibility so you can anticipate problems earlier.
292324Off-Highway Driving Guidelines
Important Handling Information
iv
06/05/19 14:17:16 31STK600 0005
* *
*
*
**
Front Ceiling Light Switch
HomeLink ButtonsMoonroof Switch (P.153)
(P.158)
(P.253)
1: On RDX model onlyOn RDX with Technology Package model only
3:2:
Your Vehicle at a Glance
Your
Vehicle
ataG
lance
3
HOOD RELEASE HANDLE
POWER DOOR LOCKMASTER SWITCH
GAUGES
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSIONPARKING BRAKE PEDAL
CLIMATE CONTROLSYSTEM
INSTRUMENT PANELINDICATORS
POWER DOOR LOCKMASTER SWITCH
(P.9 ,26)
AUDIO SYSTEM
POWER WINDOWSWITCH
POWER WINDOWSWITCHES
FUEL FILL DOORRELEASE HANDLE
DRIVER’S FRONT AIRBAG
PASSENGER’S FRONT AIRBAG(P.65)
(P.75)
(P.151)
(P.282)
(P.279)(P.157)
ACCESSORY POWERSOCKET (P.164)
(P.199)
(P.151)
(P.170)
(P.9, 34)(P.180)
(P.295)
CEILING CONSOLE
(P.131)(P.131)
AUDIO SYSTEM
1 3
2
06/05/19 14:17:49 31STK600 0008
*
*
*
* *
* *
*
*
****
To use the horn, press the center pad of the steering wheel.
Refer to the navigation system manual.
1 :2 : On RDX model only3 :4 :
On RDX with Technology Package model only
Your Vehicle at a Glance
4
MIRROR CONTROLS
VEHICLE STABILITYASSIST (VSA) OFF SWITCH
REMOTE AUDIOCONTROL BUTTONS
CRUISE CONTROLBUTTONS
SEAT HEATER SWITCHES
PADDLE SHIFTERS
REAR WINDOWDEFOGGER/HEATED MIRRORBUTTON
PASSENGER AIRBAGOFF INDICATOR
HAZARD WARNING BUTTON
STEERING WHEEL ADJUSTMENT
(P.299)
(P.237)
(P.316)
(P.155)
(P.126)
(P.125)
(P.178)
(P.34)
(P.125/156)
(P.230)
(P.164)
(P.150)(P.241)
ACCESSORY POWERSOCKET
(P.179)
(P.121/122)
AUXILIARY INPUT JACK
HEADLIGHTS/TURNSIGNAL/FOG LIGHTS
HANDSFREELINKBUTTONS
MULTI-INFORMATIONBUTTONS
(P.119/120)
UPPER DISPLAY
VOICE CONTROLBUTTONS
NAVIGATION SYSTEM /CENTER DISPLAY
(P.258)
(P.79)
HORN
WINDSHIELDWIPERS/WASHERS/REAR WINDOWWIPER/WASHER
TM
3
3
3
3, 4
3, 4
2
1
06/06/16 19:02:18 31STK600 0009
-
This section gives you importantinformation about how to protectyourself and your passengers. Itshows you how to use seat belts. Itexplains how your airbags work. Andit tells you how to properly restraininfants and children in your vehicle.
.........Important Safety Precautions . 6.......Your Vehicle’s Safety Features . 7
You’ll find many safetyrecommendations throughout thissection, and throughout this manual.The recommendations on this pageare the ones we consider to be themost important.
A seat belt is your best protection inall types of collisions. Airbags aredesigned to supplement seat belts,not replace them. So even thoughyour vehicle is equipped with airbags,make sure you and your passengersalways wear your seat belts, andwear them properly (see page ).
Alcohol and driving don’t mix. Evenone drink can reduce your ability torespond to changing conditions, andyour reaction time gets worse with
every additional drink. So don’t drinkand drive, and don’t let your friendsdrink and drive, either.
While airbags can save lives, theycan cause serious or fatal injuries tooccupants who sit too close to them,or are not properly restrained.Infants, young children, and shortadults are at the greatest risk. Besure to follow all instructions andwarnings in this manual.
Children age 12 and under shouldride properly restrained in a backseat, not the front seat. Infants andsmall children should be restrainedin a child seat. Larger childrenshould use a booster seat and a lap/shoulder belt until they can use thebelt properly without a booster seat(see pages ).
Excessive speed is a major factor incrash injuries and deaths. Generally,the higher the speed, the greater therisk, but serious injuries can alsooccur at lower speeds. Never drivefaster than is safe for currentconditions, regardless of themaximum speed posted.
Having a tire blowout or amechanical failure can be extremelyhazardous. To reduce the possibilityof such problems, check your tirepressures and condition frequently,and perform all regularly scheduledmaintenance (see page ).
16
37 57
330
Important Safety Precautions
Always Wear Your Seat Belt
Don’t Drink and Drive
Be Aware of Airbag Hazards
Restrain All Children
Control Your Speed
Keep Your Vehicle in SafeCondition
6
06/06/16 19:02:32 31STK600 0011
Your vehicle is equipped with manyfeatures that work together toprotect you and your passengersduring a crash.
However, you and your passengerscan’t take full advantage of thesefeatures unless you remain sitting ina proper position and
. In fact, some safetyfeatures can contribute to injuries ifthey are not used properly.
The following pages explain how youcan take an active role in protectingyourself and your passengers.
Some features do not require anyaction on your part. These include astrong steel framework that forms asafety cage around the passengercompartment, front and rear crushzones, a collapsible steering column,and tensioners that tighten the frontseat belts in a crash.
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
always wearyour seat belts
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
7
(5)
(7)
(10)
(3)(1)
(2)(8)
(6)
(2)
(9)
(11)
(4) (6)(8)
(1) Safety Cage(2) Crush Zones(3) Seats and Seat-Backs(4) Head Restraints(5) Collapsible Steering Column(6) Seat Belts(7) Front Airbags(8) Side Airbags(9) Side Curtain Airbags(10) Door Locks(11) Front Seat Belt Tensioners
06/06/16 19:02:38 31STK600 0012
Your vehicle is equipped with seatbelts in all seating positions.
Seat belts are the single mosteffective safety device for adults andlarger children. (Infants and smallerchildren must be properly restrainedin child seats.)
Not wearing a seat belt properlyincreases the chance of seriousinjury or death in a crash, eventhough your vehicle has airbags.
In addition, most states and allCanadian provinces require you towear seat belts.
When properly worn, seat belts:
Help protect you in almost everytype of crash, including frontal,side, and rear impacts androllovers.
Keep you connected to the vehicleso you can take advantage of thevehicle’s built-in safety features.
Always wear your seat belt, andmake sure you wear it properly.
Of course, seat belts cannotcompletely protect you in everycrash. But in most cases, seat beltscan reduce your risk of seriousinjury.
Help keep you in a good positionshould the airbags ever deploy. Agood position reduces the risk ofinjury from an inflating airbag andallows you to get the bestadvantage from the airbag.
Keep you from being thrown outof the vehicle.
Help keep you from being thrownagainst the inside of the vehicleand against other occupants.
Your seat belt system also includesan indicator on the instrument paneland a beeper to remind you and yourpassengers to fasten your seat belts.
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
Seat Belts
Why Wear Seat Belts
What You Should Do:
8
Not wearing a seat belt properlyincreases the chance of seriousinjury or death in a crash, eventhough your vehicle has airbags.
Be sure you and yourpassengers always wear seatbelts and wear them properly.
06/05/19 14:18:30 31STK600 0013
CONTINUED
Your vehicle has a supplementalrestraint system (SRS) with frontairbags to help protect the heads andchests of the driver and a front seatpassenger during a moderate tosevere frontal collision (see page
for more information on howyour front airbags work).
Your vehicle also has side airbags tohelp protect the upper torso of thedriver or a front seat passengerduring a moderate to severe sideimpact (see page for moreinformation on how your side airbagswork).
In addition, your vehicle has sidecurtain airbags to help protect theheads of the driver, front passenger,and passengers in the outer rearseating positions during a moderateto severe side impact or rollover (seepage for more information on howyour side curtain airbags work).
26
31
32
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
Airbags
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
9
06/06/16 19:02:45 31STK600 0014
The most important things you needto know about your airbags are:
They are designed to supplementthe seat belts.
Always wearyour seat belt properly, and situpright and as far back from thesteering wheel as possible whileallowing full control of the vehicle. Afront passenger should move theirseat as far back from the dashboardas possible.
The rest of this section gives moredetailed information about how youcan maximize your safety.
Remember, however, that no safetysystem can prevent all injuries ordeaths that can occur in a severecrash, even when seat belts areproperly worn and the airbags deploy.
To do their job, airbags mustinflate with tremendous force. Sowhile airbags help save lives, theycan cause minor injuries or moreserious or even fatal injuries ifoccupants are not properlyrestrained or sitting properly.
Your Vehicle’s Safety Features
Airbags do not replace seat belts.
Airbags offer no protection in rearimpacts, or minor frontal or sidecollisions.
What you should do:
Airbags can pose serious hazards.
10
06/05/19 14:18:44 31STK600 0015
-
The following pages provideinstructions on how to properlyprotect the driver, adult passengers,and teenage children who are largeenough and mature enough to driveor ride in the front.
See pages for importantguidelines on how to properlyprotect infants, small children, andlarger children who ride in yourvehicle.
After everyone has entered thevehicle, be sure the doors and thetailgate are closed and locked.
Your vehicle has a door and tailgateopen monitor on the informationdisplay to indicate when a specificdoor or the tailgate is not tightlyclosed.
37 41
CONTINUED
On RDX model
Close and Lock the DoorsIntroduction 1.
Protecting Adults and Teens
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
11
DOOR AND TAILGATEOPEN MONITOR
06/06/16 19:02:53 31STK600 0016
When both tailgate and one or moredoors are not tightly closed, the‘‘DOOR & TAILGATE OPEN’’message will come on.
When the tailgate is not tightlyclosed, the ‘‘TAILGATE OPEN’’message will come on.
When one or more doors are nottightly closed, the ‘‘DOOR OPEN’’message will come on.
The door and tailgate open monitorappears on the multi-informationdisplay to indicate when a specificdoor or the tailgate is not tightlyclosed.
Locking the doors and the tailgatereduces the chance of someonebeing thrown out of the vehicleduring a crash, and it helps preventpassengers from accidentallyopening a door or the tailgate andfalling out.
Locking the doors and the tailgatealso helps prevent an outsider fromunexpectedly opening a door or thetailgate when you come to a stop.
This vehicle has auto door locking/unlocking features. See pages
and for how to set them.
This vehicle has auto door locking/unlocking features. See page forhow to set them.
See page for how to lock thedoors and the tailgate.
131
133
108 116
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX model
Protecting Adults and Teens
12
06/06/16 19:03:02 31STK600 0017
If you sit too close to the steeringwheel or dashboard, you can beseriously injured by an inflating frontairbag, or by striking the steeringwheel or dashboard.
The National Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration and TransportCanada recommend that driversallow at least 10 inches (25 cm)between the center of the steeringwheel and the chest. In addition toadjusting the seat, you can adjust thesteering wheel up and down, and inand out (see page ).
If you cannot get far enough awayfrom the steering wheel and stillreach the controls, we recommendthat you investigate whether sometype of adaptive equipment may help.
Adjust the driver’s seat as far to therear as possible while allowing you tomaintain full control of the vehicle.Have a front passenger adjust theirseat as far to the rear as possible.
Once your seat is adjusted correctly,rock it back and forth to make surethe seat is locked in position.
See pages and for how toadjust the front seats.
126145144
Adjust the Front Seats2.
Protecting Adults and Teens
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
13
Sitting too close to a frontairbag can result in seriousinjury or death if the frontairbags inflate.
Always sit as far back from thefront airbags as possible.
06/05/19 14:19:07 31STK600 0018
Adjust the driver’s seat-back to acomfortable, upright position,leaving ample space between yourchest and the airbag cover in thecenter of the steering wheel.
Passengers with adjustable seat-backs should also adjust their seat-back to a comfortable, uprightposition.
Reclining a seat-back so that theshoulder part of the belt no longerrests against the occupant’s chestreduces the protective capability ofthe belt. It also increases the chanceof sliding under the belt in a crashand being seriously injured. Thefarther a seat-back is reclined, thegreater the risk of injury.
See pages and for how toadjust the seat-backs.
144 145
Protecting Adults and Teens
Adjust the Seat-Backs3.
14
Reclining the seat-back too farcan result in serious injury ordeath in a crash.
Adjust the seat-back to anupright position, and sit wellback in the seat.
06/05/19 14:19:15 31STK600 0019
Properly adjusted head restraintswill help protect occupants fromwhiplash and other crash injuries.
See page for how to adjust thehead restraints.
Adjust the driver’s head restraint sothe back of your head rests againstthe center of the restraint.
Have passengers adjust their headrestraints properly as well. Tallerpersons should adjust their restraintas high as possible.
146
Protecting Adults and Teens
Adjust the Head Restraints4.
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
15
Improperly positioning headrestraints reduces theireffectiveness and you can beseriously injured in a crash.
Make sure head restraints arein place and positioned properlybefore driving.
06/05/19 14:19:21 31STK600 0020
This spreads the forces of a crashover the strongest bones in yourupper body.
If the seat belt touches or crossesyour neck, or if it crosses your arminstead of your shoulder, you need toadjust the seat belt anchor height.
Position the lap part of the belt aslow as possible across your hips,then pull up on the shoulder part ofthe belt so the lap part fits snugly.This lets your strong pelvic bonestake the force of a crash and reducesthe chance of internal injuries.
If necessary, pull up on the belt againto remove any slack, then check thatthe belt rests across the center ofyour chest and over your shoulder.
Insert the latch plate into the buckle,then tug on the belt to make sure thebelt is securely latched. Check thatthe belt is not twisted, because atwisted belt can cause seriousinjuries in a crash.
Protecting Adults and Teens
Fasten and Position the SeatBelts
5.
16
Improperly positioning the seatbelts can cause serious injuryor death in a crash.
Make sure all seat belts areproperly positioned beforedriving.
06/05/19 14:19:28 31STK600 0021
CONTINUED
After all occupants have adjustedtheir seats and put on seat belts, it isvery important that they continue tosit upright, well back in their seats,with their feet on the floor, until thevehicle is parked and the engine isoff.
Sitting improperly can increase thechance of injury during a crash. Forexample, if an occupant slouches,lies down, turns sideways, sitsforward, leans forward or sideways,or puts one or both feet up, thechance of injury during a crash isgreatly increased.
This could causevery serious injuries in a crash.
See page for additionalinformation about your seat beltsand how to take care of them.
Using a seatbelt that is not working properly canresult in serious injury or death.Have your dealer check the belt assoon as possible.
If a seat belt does not seem to workproperly, it may not protect theoccupant in a crash.
The front seats have adjustable seatbelt anchors. To adjust the height ofan anchor, press and hold the releasebutton and slide the anchor up ordown as needed (it has fourpositions).
20
Protecting Adults and Teens
Maintain a Proper SittingPosition
6.Never place the shoulder portion of alap/shoulder belt under your arm orbehind your back.
No one should sit in a seat with aninoperative seat belt.
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
17
RELEASEBUTTON
06/05/19 14:19:36 31STK600 0022
If you are pregnant, the best way toprotect yourself and your unbornchild when driving or riding in avehicle is to always wear a seat belt,and keep the lap part of the belt aslow as possible across the hips.
When driving, remember to situpright and adjust the seat as farback as possible while allowing fullcontrol of the vehicle. When ridingas a front passenger, adjust the seatas far back as possible.
This will reduce the risk of injuriesto both you and your unborn childthat can be caused by a crash or aninflating front airbag.
Each time you have a checkup, askyour doctor if it’s okay for you todrive.
In addition, an occupant who is out ofposition in the front seat can beseriously or fatally injured in a crashby striking interior parts of thevehicle or being struck by aninflating front airbag.
Protecting Adults and Teens
Advice for Pregnant Women
18
Sitting improperly or out ofposition can result in seriousinjury or death in a crash.
Always sit upright, well back inthe seat, with your feet on thefloor.
06/05/19 14:19:44 31STK600 0023
If they do, theycould be very seriously injured in acrash.
A passenger who is notwearing a seat belt during a crashor emergency stop can be thrownagainst the inside of the vehicle,against other occupants, or out ofthe vehicle.
If they do, theycould be very seriously injured in acrash.
Devices intended to improveoccupant comfort or reposition theshoulder part of a seat belt canreduce the protective capability ofthe belt and increase the chance ofserious injury in a crash.
Carrying hard or sharpobjects on your lap, or driving witha pipe or other sharp object inyour mouth, can result in injuriesif your front airbag inflates.
Objects onthe covers marked ‘‘SRS AIRBAG’’could interfere with the properoperation of the airbags or bepropelled inside the vehicle andhurt someone if the airbags inflate.
If yourhands or arms are close to anairbag cover, they could be injuredif the airbag inflates.
If a side airbag or aside curtain airbag inflates, a cupholder or other solid objectattached on or near the door couldbe propelled inside the vehicle andhurt someone.
Additional Safety Precautions
Protecting Adults and Teens
Never let passengers ride in thecargo area or on top of a folded-down back seat.
Passengers should not stand up orchange seats while the vehicle ismoving.
Two people should never use thesame seat belt.
Do not put any accessories on seatbelts.
Do not place hard or sharp objectsbetween yourself and a frontairbag.
Do not attach or place objects onthe front airbag covers.
Keep your hands and arms awayfrom the airbag covers.
Do not attach solid objects on ornear a door.
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
19
06/05/19 14:19:51 31STK600 0024
Your seat belt system includes lap/shoulder belts in all five seatingpositions. The front seat belts arealso equipped with automatic seatbelt tensioners.
This system uses the same sensorsas the front airbags to monitorwhether the front seat belts arelatched or unlatched, and how muchweight is on the front passenger’sseat (see pages and ).
If either the driver or a frontpassenger does not fasten their seatbelt while driving, the beeper willsound and the indicator will flashagain at regular intervals.
This system monitors the front seatbelts. If you turn the ignition switchto the ON (II) position before yourseat belt is fastened, the beeper willsound and the indicator will flash. Ifyour seat belt is not fastened beforethe beeper stops, the indicator willstop flashing but remain on.
If a front passenger does not fastentheir seat belt, the indicator willcome on about 6 seconds after theignition switch is turned to the ON(II) position.
You will also see a ‘‘FASTEN SEATBELT’’ or ‘‘FASTEN PASSENGERSEAT BELT’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
When no one is sitting in the frontpassenger’s seat, or a child or smalladult is riding there, the indicatorshould not come on and the beepershould not sound.
The seat belt systemincludes an indicator on the
instrument panel and a beeper toremind you and your passengers tofasten your seat belts.
29 3084
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Additional Information About Your Seat Belts
Seat Belt System Components
20
06/05/19 14:19:59 31STK600 0025
All seat belts have an emergencylocking retractor. In normal driving,the retractor lets you move freely inyour seat while it keeps sometension on the belt. During a collisionor sudden stop, the retractorautomatically locks the belt to helprestrain your body.
The seat belts in all positions exceptthe driver’s have an additionallockable retractor that must beactivated to secure a child seat (seepage ).
The lap/shoulder belt goes overyour shoulder, across your chest,and across your hips.
To fasten the belt, insert the latchplate into the buckle, then tug on thebelt to make sure the buckle islatched (see page for how toproperly position the belt).
If the indicator comes on or thebeeper sounds when the driver’s seatbelt is latched and there is no frontseat passenger and no items on thefront seat, something may beinterfering with the monitoringsystem. Look for and remove:
To unlock the belt, press the redPRESS button on the buckle. Guidethe belt across your body so that itretracts completely. After exiting thevehicle, be sure the belt is out of theway and will not get closed in thedoor.
Any items under the frontpassenger’s seat.
Any objects hanging on the seat orin the seat-back pocket.
Any objects, such as a folded-downback seat, that is touching the rearof the seat-back.
If no obstructions are found, haveyour vehicle checked by a dealer.
16
51
CONTINUED
Additional Information About Your Seat Belts
Lap/Shoulder Belt
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
21
06/05/19 14:20:08 31STK600 0026
The tensioners can also be activatedduring a collision in which the frontairbags . In this case, theairbags would not be needed, but theadditional restraint could be helpful.
When the tensioners are activated,the seat belts will remain tight untilthey are unbuckled.
The tensioners are designed toactivate in any collision severeenough to cause the front airbags todeploy, or if a sensor detects yourvehicle is about to roll over (see page
).
If a side airbag or side curtain airbagdeploys during a side impact, thetensioner on that side of the vehiclewill also deploy.
For added protection, the front seatbelts are equipped with automaticseat belt tensioners. When activated,the tensioners immediately tightenthe belts to help hold the driver anda front passenger in position.
If the shoulder part of the belt ispulled all the way out, the lockableretractor will activate. The belt willretract, but it will not allow thepassenger to move freely.
To deactivate the lockable retractor,unlatch the buckle and let the seatbelt fully retract. To refasten theseat belt, pull it out only as far asneeded.
32
do not deploy
Additional Information About Your Seat Belts
Automatic Seat Belt Tensioners
22
06/05/19 14:20:15 31STK600 0027
For safety, you should check thecondition of your seat belts regularly.
The dealer should also inspect theanchors for damage and replacethem if needed. If the automatic seatbelt tensioners activate during acrash, they must be replaced.
If a seat belt is worn during a crash,it must be replaced by your dealer. Abelt that has been worn during acrash may not provide the same levelof protection in a subsequent crash.Pull each belt out fully, and look for
frays, cuts, burns, and wear. Checkthat the latches work smoothly andthe belts retract easily. If a belt doesnot retract easily, cleaning the beltmay correct the problem (see page
). Any belt that is not in goodcondition or working properly willnot provide good protection andshould be replaced as soon aspossible.
Acura provides a limited warranty onseat belts. See your
booklet for details.
366
Acura WarrantyInformation
Seat Belt Maintenance
Additional Information About Your Seat Belts
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
23
Not checking or maintainingseat belts can result in seriousinjury or death if the seat beltsdo not work properly whenneeded.
Check your seat belts regularly,and have any problemcorrected as soon as possible.
06/05/19 14:20:22 31STK600 0028
Airbag System Components
Additional Information About Your Airbags
24
(3)
(14)
(9)
(9)(10)
(1)
(6)
(7)(11)
(4) (5)
(17)
(16)
(8)
(15)
(16)
(2)(13)
(12)
(5)
(11)
(4)
(6)
(7) Driver’s Seat Position Sensor(8) Front Passenger’s Weight Sensors(9) Front Impact Sensors(10) Passenger Airbag Off Indicator(11) Side Impact Sensors (First)(12) Occupant Position Detection System (OPDS) Sensors(13) Front Passenger’s Weight Sensors/OPDS Sensors Control Unit(14) Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) Indicator
(1) Driver’s Front Airbag(2) Passenger’s Front Airbag(3) Control Unit(4) Front Seat Belt Tensioners(5) Side Airbags(6) Side Curtain Airbags
(15) Rollover Sensor(16) Side Impact Sensors (Second)(17) Seat Belt Buckle Tensioners
06/05/19 14:20:28 31STK600 0029
Your airbag system includes:
Two SRS (supplemental restraintsystem) front airbags. The driver’sairbag is stored in the center ofthe steering wheel; the frontpassenger’s airbag is stored in thedashboard. Both are marked ‘‘SRSAIRBAG’’ (see page ).
Two side airbags, one for thedriver and one for a frontpassenger. The airbags are storedin the outer edges of the seat-backs. Both are marked ‘‘SIDEAIRBAG’’ (see page ).
Two side curtain airbags, one foreach side of the vehicle. Theairbags are stored in the ceiling,above the side windows. The frontand rear pillars are marked ‘‘SIDECURTAIN AIRBAG’’ (see page
).
Sensors that can detect whetherthe driver’s seat belt and a frontpassenger’s seat belt is latched orunlatched (see page ).
A driver’s seat position sensor thatmonitors the distance of the seatfrom the front airbag. If the seat istoo far forward, the airbag willinflate with less force (see page
).
Weight sensors that monitor theweight on the front passenger’sseat. If the weight is about 65 lbs(29 kg) or less (the weight of aninfant or small child), thepassenger’s front airbag will beturned off (see page ).
Automatic front seat belttensioners (see page ).
Sensors that can detect whether achild is in the passenger’s sideairbag path and signal the controlunit to turn the airbag off (seepage ).
Sensors that can detect amoderate to severe front impact,side impact, or rollover.
26
31
22
20
30
29
32
31
CONTINUED
Additional Information About Your Airbags
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
25
06/05/19 14:20:37 31STK600 0030
If you ever have a moderate tosevere frontal collision, sensors willdetect the vehicle’s rapiddeceleration.
If the rate of deceleration is highenough, the control unit will instantlyinflate the driver’s and frontpassenger’s airbags, at the time andwith the force needed.
A rollover sensor that can detect ifyour vehicle is about to roll overand signal the control unit todeploy both side curtain airbagsand front seat belt tensioners (seepage ).
A sophisticated electronic systemthat continually monitors andrecords information about thesensors, the control unit, theairbag activators, the seat belttensioners, and driver and frontpassenger seat belt use when theignition switch is in the ON (II)position.
An indicator on the instrumentpanel that alerts you to a possibleproblem with your airbags,sensors, or seat belt tensioners(see page ).
An indicator on the instrumentpanel that alerts you that thepassenger’s side airbag has beenturned off (see page ).
An indicator on the dashboard thatalerts you that the passenger’sfront airbag has been turned off(see page ).
Emergency backup power in caseyour vehicle’s electrical system isdisconnected in a crash.
32
33
34
33
How Your Front Airbags Work
Additional Information About Your Airbags
26
06/05/19 14:20:45 31STK600 0031
During a frontal crash, your seat beltrestrains your lower body and torso,and the front airbag helps protectyour head and chest.
Although both airbags normallyinflate within split second of eachother, it is possible for only oneairbag to deploy.
This can happen if the severity of acollision is at the margin, orthreshold, that determines whetheror not the airbags will deploy. Insuch cases, the seat belt will providesufficient protection, and thesupplemental protection offered bythe airbag would be minimal.
After inflating, the front airbagsimmediately deflate, so they won’tinterfere with the driver’s visibility,or the ability to steer or operateother controls.
Only the driver’s airbag will deploy ifthere is no passenger in the frontseat, or if the advanced airbagsystem has turned the passenger’sairbag off (see page ).29
CONTINUED
Additional Information About Your Airbags
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
27
06/05/19 14:20:51 31STK600 0032
Your front airbags are also dual-threshold airbags. Airbags with thisfeature have two deploymentthresholds that depend on whethersensors detect the occupant iswearing a seat belt or not.
If the occupant’s belt is ,the airbag will deploy at a slightlylower threshold, because theoccupant would need extraprotection.
If the occupant’s belt , theairbag will inflate at a slightly higherthreshold, when the airbag would beneeded to supplement the protectionprovided by the seat belt.
Your front airbags are dual-stageairbags. This means they have twoinflation stages that can be ignitedsequentially or simultaneously,depending on crash severity.
In a crash, both stageswill ignite simultaneously to providethe quickest and greatest protection.
In a crash, one stage willignite first, then the second stagewill ignite a split second later. Thisprovides longer airbag inflation timewith a little less force.
The total time for inflation anddeflation is one-tenth of a second, sofast that most occupants are notaware that the airbags deployed untilthey see them lying in their laps.
After a crash, you may see whatlooks like smoke. This is actuallypowder from the airbag’s surface.Although the powder is not harmful,people with respiratory problemsmay experience some temporarydiscomfort. If this occurs, get out ofthe vehicle as soon as it is safe to doso.
Additional Information About Your Airbags
Dual-Threshold Airbags
not latched
is latched
Dual-Stage Airbags
more severe
less severe
28
06/05/19 14:20:59 31STK600 0033
Your front airbags are also advancedairbags. The main purpose of thisfeature is to help prevent airbag-caused injuries to short drivers andchildren who ride in front.
The driver’s advanced front airbagsystem includes a seat positionsensor under the seat. If the seat istoo far forward, the airbag willinflate with less force, regardless ofthe severity of the impact.
If there is a problem with the sensor,the SRS Indicator will come on, andthe airbag will inflate in the normalmanner regardless of the driver’sseating position.
For both advanced airbags to workproperly:
Do not spill any liquids on orunder the seats, cover the sensors,or put any cargo or metal objectsunder the front seats.
Occupants must sit upright andwear their seat belts properly.
Back-seat passengers should notput their feet under the front seats.
Failure to follow these instructionscould damage the sensors or preventthem from working properly.
CONTINUED
Additional Information About Your Airbags
Advanced Airbags
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
29
DRIVER’SSEATPOSITIONSENSOR
06/05/19 14:21:07 31STK600 0034
Be aware that objects placed on thepassenger’s seat can also cause theairbag to be turned off.
When the airbag is turned off, a‘‘passenger airbag off’’ indicator inthe center of the dashboard comeson (see page ).
If the weight sensors detect there isno passenger in the front seat, theairbag will be off. However, thepassenger airbag off indicator willnot come on.
To ensure that the passenger’sadvanced front airbag system willwork properly,
This includes:
A rear passenger pushing orpulling on the back of the frontpassenger’s seat.
Moving the front seat forciblyback against cargo on the seat orfloor behind it.
Hanging heavy items on the frontpassenger seat, or placing heavyitems in the seat-back pocket.
Moving the front seat or seat-backforcibly back against the foldedrear seat.
The passenger’s advanced frontairbag system has weight sensorsunder the seat. Although Acura doesnot encourage carrying an infant orsmall child in front, if the sensorsdetect the weight of an infant orsmall child (up to about 65 lbs or 29kg), the system will automaticallyturn the passenger’s front airbag off.
34
Additional Information About Your Airbags
do not do anythingthat would increase or decrease theweight on the front passenger’s seat.
30
PASSENGER’SSEAT WEIGHTSENSORS
06/06/16 19:06:14 31STK600 0035
Only one airbag will deploy during aside impact. If the impact is on thepassenger’s side, the passenger’sside airbag will deploy even if thereis no passenger.
To get the best protection from theside airbags, front seat occupantsshould wear their seat belts and situpright and well back in their seats.
Your vehicle has a side airbag cutoffsystem designed primarily to protecta child riding in the front passenger’sseat.
The side airbag may also shut off if ashort adult leans sideways, or alarger adult slouches and leanssideways into the airbag’sdeployment path.
Objects placed on the frontpassenger seat can also cause theside airbag to be shut off.
Although Acura does not encouragechildren to ride in front, if thesensors in the seat detect a child hasleaned into the side airbag’sdeployment path, the airbag will shutoff.
If you ever have a moderate tosevere side impact, sensors willdetect rapid acceleration and signalthe control unit to instantly inflateeither the driver’s or the passenger’sside airbag and activate the seat belttensioner.
CONTINUED
Additional Information About Your Airbags
How Your Side Airbags Work Side Airbag Cutoff System
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
31
06/06/16 19:06:22 31STK600 0036
To get the best protection from theside curtain airbags, occupantsshould wear their seat belts and situpright and well back in their seats.
If the impact is on the passenger’sside, the passenger’s side curtainairbag will inflate even if there are nooccupants on that side of the vehicle.
If the rollover sensor detects yourvehicle is about to roll over, it signalsthe control unit, which immediatelydeploys both side curtain airbags andactivates both front seat belttensioners.
The airbag on the passenger’s sidewill deploy, and the seat belttensioner will activate, even if thereare no passengers on that side of thevehicle.
In a moderate to severe side impact,sensors will detect rapid accelerationand signal the control unit toinstantly inflate the side curtainairbag and activate the seat belttensioner on the driver’s or thepassenger’s side of the vehicle.
If the side airbag off indicator comeson (see page ), have thepassenger sit upright. Once thepassenger is out of the airbag’sdeployment path, the system willturn the airbag back on, and theindicator will go out.
There will be some delay betweenthe moment the passenger movesinto or out of the airbag deploymentpath and when the indicator comeson or goes off.
A front seat passenger should notuse a cushion or other object as abackrest. It may prevent the cutoffsystem from working properly.
33
In a Rollover
In a Side Impact
How Your Side Curtain AirbagsWork
Additional Information About Your Airbags
32
SIDE CURTAIN AIRBAG
06/05/19 14:21:33 31STK600 0037
The SRS indicator alertsyou to a potential problem
with your airbags or seat belttensioners.
If the indicator comes on orflashes on and off while you drive.
If the indicator stays on after theengine starts.
If the SRS indicator does not comeon after you turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position.
If the indicator comes on at anyother time, or does not come on at all,you should have the system checkedby your dealer. For example:
This indicator alerts you that thepassenger’s side airbag has beenautomatically shut off. It doesmean there is a problem with yourside airbags.
When you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, the indicatorshould come on for several secondsand then go off (see page ). If itdoesn’t come on, stays on, or comeson while driving without a passengerin the front seat, have the systemchecked.
You will also see a ‘‘PASSENGERSIDE AIRBAG OFF’’ message on themulti-information display (see page
).
When you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, this indicatorcomes on for several seconds thengoes off. This tells you the system isworking properly.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECKAIRBAG SYSTEM’’ message on themulti-information display (see page
).
If you see any of these indications,the airbags and seat belt tensionersmay not work properly when youneed them.
67
85
85
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
How the Side Airbag OffIndicator Works
How the SRS Indicator Works
not
Additional Information About Your Airbags
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
33
U.S. Canada
Ignoring the SRS indicator canresult in serious injury or deathif the airbag systems ortensioners do not work properly.
Have your vehicle checked by adealer as soon as possible ifthe SRS indicator alerts you toa possible problem.
06/06/16 19:06:34 31STK600 0038
This indicator alerts you that thepassenger’s front airbag has beenshut off because weight sensorsdetect about 65 lbs (29 kg) or less(the weight of an infant or smallchild) on the front passenger’s seat.It does there is a problemwith the airbag.
Be aware that objects placed on thefront seat can cause the indicator tocome on.
If no weight is detected on the frontseat, the airbag will be automaticallyshut off. However, the indicator willnot come on.
The passenger airbag off indicatormay come on and off repeatedly ifthe total weight on the seat is nearthe airbag cutoff threshold.
If the indicator comes on with nofront seat passenger and no objectson the seat, or with an adult ridingthere, something may be interferingwith the weight sensors. Look forand remove:
Any items under the frontpassenger’s seat.
Any objects hanging on the seat orin the seat-back pocket.
If no obstructions are found, haveyour vehicle checked by a dealer assoon as possible.
If an adult or teenage passenger isriding in front, move the seat as farto the rear as possible, and have thepassenger sit upright and wear theseat belt properly.
Any object, such as a folded-downback seat, that is touching the rearof the seat-back.
How the Passenger Airbag OffIndicator Works
not mean
Additional Information About Your Airbags
34
PASSENGER AIRBAG OFF INDICATOR
Canada
U.S.
06/05/19 14:21:55 31STK600 0039
Take your vehicle to anauthorized dealer as soon aspossible. If you ignore thisindication, your airbags may notoperate properly.
Any airbagthat has deployed must bereplaced along with the controlunit and other related parts. Anyseat belt tensioner that activatesmust also be replaced.
Do not try to remove or replaceany airbag by yourself. This mustbe done by an authorized dealer ora knowledgeable body shop.
Your airbag systems are virtuallymaintenance free, and there are noparts you can safely service.However, you must have yourvehicle serviced if:
Even if yourairbags do not inflate, your dealershould inspect the driver’s seatposition sensor, the frontpassenger’s weight sensors, thefront seat belt tensioners, and allseat belts worn during the crash tomake sure they are operatingproperly.
The SRS indicator alerts you to aproblem.
An airbag ever inflates.
If your vehicle has a moderate tosevere impact.
Airbag Service
Additional Information About Your Airbags
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
35
06/05/19 14:22:01 31STK600 0040
Together, airbags andseat belts provide the bestprotection.
Tampering could causethe airbags to deploy, possiblycausing very serious injury.
If water oranother liquid soaks into a seat-back, it can prevent the side airbagcutoff system from workingproperly.
Improperly replacingor covering front seat-back coverscan prevent your side airbags frominflating during a side impact.
This could make thedriver’s seat position sensor or thefront passenger’s weight sensorsineffective. If it is necessary toremove or modify a front seat toaccommodate a person withdisabilities, first contact AcuraClient Services at 800-382-2238.
Additional Safety PrecautionsDo not attempt to deactivate yourairbags.
Do not tamper with airbagcomponents or wiring for anyreason.
Do not expose the front passenger’sseat-back to liquid.
Do not cover or replace front seat-back covers without consultingyour dealer.
Do not remove or modify a frontseat without consulting yourdealer.
Additional Information About Your Airbags
36
06/05/19 14:22:06 31STK600 0041
--
-
Children depend on adults to protectthem. However, despite their bestintentions, many adults do not knowhow to protect childpassengers.
If you have children, or ever need todrive with a child in your vehicle, besure to read this section. It beginswith important general guidelines,then presents special information forinfants, small children, and largerchildren.
To reduce the number of childdeaths and injuries, every state andCanadian province requires thatinfants and children be properlyrestrained when they ride in avehicle.
(see pages ).(see pages ).
Each year, many children are injuredor killed in vehicle crashes becausethey are either unrestrained or notproperly restrained. In fact, vehicleaccidents are the number one causeof the death of children aged 12 andunder.
42 5754 57
properly
All Children Must Be Restrained
Infants and small children must berestrained in an approved child seatthat is properly secured to thevehicle
Larger children must be restrainedwith a lap/shoulder belt and ride ona booster seat until the seat belt f itsthem properly
Protecting Children General Guidelines
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
37
Children who are unrestrainedor improperly restrained can beseriously injured or killed in acrash.
Any child too small for a seatbelt should be properlyrestrained in a child seat. Alarger child should be properlyrestrained with a seat belt anduse a booster seat if necessary.
06/05/19 14:22:14 31STK600 0042
-
If the vehicle seat istoo far forward, or the child’s head isthrown forward during a collision, aninflating front airbag can strike thechild with enough force to kill orvery seriously injure a small child.
Whenever possible,larger children should sit in the backseat, on a booster seat if needed, andbe properly restrained with a seatbelt (see page for importantinformation about protecting largerchildren).
Front airbags have been designed tohelp protect adults in a moderate tosevere frontal collision. To do this,the passenger’s front airbag is quitelarge, and it can inflate with enoughforce to cause very serious injuries.
Even though your vehicle has anadvanced front airbag system thatautomatically turns the passenger’sfront airbag off (see page ),please follow these guidelines:Children who ride in back are less
likely to be injured by strikinginterior vehicle parts during acollision or hard braking. Also,children cannot be injured by aninflating front airbag when they ridein the back.
Ifthe airbag inflates, it can hit the backof the child seat with enough forceto kill or very seriously injure aninfant.
According to accident statistics,children of all ages and sizes aresafer when they are restrained in aback seat. The National HighwayTraffic Safety Administration andTransport Canada recommend thatall children aged 12 and under beproperly restrained in a back seat.Some states have laws restrictingwhere children may ride.
34
54
All Children Should Sit in a BackSeat
The Passenger’s Front AirbagCan Pose Serious Risks
Small ChildrenPlacing a forward-facing child seat inthe front seat of a vehicle equippedwith a passenger’s front airbag canbe hazardous.
Larger ChildrenChildren who have outgrown childseats are also at risk of being injuredor killed by an inflating passenger’sfront airbag.Infants
Never put a rear-facing child seat inthe front seat of a vehicle equippedwith a passenger’s front airbag.
Protecting Children General Guidelines
38
06/05/19 14:22:23 31STK600 0043
-
To remind you of the passenger’sfront airbag hazards, and thatchildren must be properly restrainedin a back seat, your vehicle haswarning labels on the dashboard(U.S. models) and on the front visors.Please read and follow theinstructions on these labels.
U.S. Models
Canadian Models
Protecting Children General Guidelines
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
39
DASHBOARD
SUN VISORS
SUN VISORS
06/06/16 19:06:45 31STK600 0044
-
Many parents say they prefer to putan infant or a small child in the frontpassenger seat so they can watch thechild, or because the child requiresattention.
Your vehicle has a back seat wherechildren can be properly restrained.If you ever have to carry a group ofchildren, and a child must ride infront:
Placing a child in the front seatexposes the child to hazards in afrontal collision, and paying closeattention to a child distracts thedriver from the important tasks ofdriving, placing both of you at risk.
Place the largest child in the frontseat, provided the child is largeenough to wear the lap/shoulderbelt properly (see page ).
Move the vehicle seat as far to therear as possible (see page ).
Have the child sit upright and wellback in the seat (see page ).
Make sure the seat belt is properlypositioned and secured (see page
).
If a child requires close physicalattention or frequent visual contact,we strongly recommend that anotheradult ride with the child in a backseat. The back seat is far safer for achild than the front.
17
16
54
145
If a Child Requires CloseAttention
If You Must Drive with SeveralChildren
Protecting Children General Guidelines
40
06/05/19 14:22:42 31STK600 0045
-
If a child wraps a looseseat belt around their neck, theycan be seriously or fatally injured.(See pages and for how toactivate and deactivate thelockable retractor.)
Leaving children withoutadult supervision is illegal in moststates and Canadian provinces,and can be very hazardous.
For example, infants and smallchildren left in a vehicle on a hotday can die from heatstroke. Achild left alone with the key in theignition switch can accidentally setthe vehicle in motion, possiblyinjuring themselves or others.This can prevent
children from accidentally fallingout (see page ).
If you are not wearing aseat belt in a crash, you could bethrown forward and crush thechild against the dashboard or aseat-back. If you are wearing aseat belt, the child can be tornfrom your arms and be seriouslyhurt or killed.
During a crash, the beltcould press deep into the child andcause serious or fatal injuries.
If they do, theycould be very seriously injured in acrash.
Children who play in vehicles canaccidentally get trapped inside.Teach your children not to play inor around vehicles.
Even very youngchildren learn how to unlockvehicle doors, turn on the ignitionswitch, and open the tailgate,which can lead to accidental injuryor death.
51 52
132
Make sure any unused seat beltthat a child can reach is buckled,the lockable retractor is activated,and the belt is fully retracted andlocked.
Do not leave children alone in avehicle.
Use the childproof door locks toprevent children from opening therear doors.
Never hold an infant or child onyour lap.
Never put a seat belt over yourselfor a child.
Never let two children use thesame seat belt.
Lock all doors and the tailgatewhen your vehicle is not in use.
Keep vehicle keys/remotetransmitters out of the reach ofchildren.
Additional Safety Precautions
Protecting Children General Guidelines
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
41
06/05/19 14:22:50 31STK600 0046
An infant must be properlyrestrained in a rear-facing, recliningchild seat until the child reaches theseat maker’s weight or height limitfor the seat, and the child is at leastone year old.
A rear-facing child seat can be placedin any seating position in the backseat, but not in the front.
If the passenger’s front airbaginflates, it can hit the back of thechild seat with enough force to kill orseriously injure an infant.If placed
facing forward, an infant could bevery seriously injured during afrontal collision.
Two types of seats may be used: aseat designed exclusively for infants,or a convertible seat used in the rear-facing, reclining mode.
Only a rear-facing child seat providesproper support for a baby’s head,neck, and back.
When properly installed, a rear-facing child seat may prevent thedriver or a front passenger frommoving their seat as far back asrecommended, or from locking theirseat-back in the desired position.
It can also interfere with properoperation of the passenger’sadvanced front airbag system.
Child Seat Type
Rear-facing Child Seat Placement
Never put arear-facing child seat in the frontseat.
Do not put a rear-facing child seat ina forward-facing position.
Protecting Infants
Protecting Infants and Small Children
42
06/05/19 14:22:59 31STK600 0047
In any of these situations, westrongly recommend that you installthe child seat directly behind thefront passenger’s seat, move the seatas far forward as needed, and leave itunoccupied. Or, you may wish to geta smaller rear-facing child seat.
A child who is at least one year old,and who fits within the child seatmaker’s weight and height limits,should be restrained in a forward-facing, upright child seat.
Of the different seats available, werecommend those that have a five-point harness system as shown.
We also recommend that a smallchild use the child seat until the childreaches the weight or height limitfor the seat.
CONTINUED
Protecting Small Children
Child Seat Type
Protecting Infants and Small Children
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
43
Placing a rear-facing child seatin the front seat can result inserious injury or death during acollision.
Always place a rear-facing childseat in the back seat, not thefront.
06/05/19 14:23:06 31STK600 0048
We strongly recommend placing aforward-facing child seat in a backseat, not the front.
If the vehicle seat is toofar forward, or the child’s head isthrown forward during a collision, aninflating airbag can strike the childwith enough force to cause veryserious or fatal injuries.
Even with advanced front airbagsthat automatically turn thepassenger’s front airbag off (seepage ), a back seat is the safestplace for a small child.
If it is necessary to put a forward-facing child seat in the front, movethe vehicle seat as far to the rear aspossible, and be sure the child seat isfirmly secured to the vehicle and thechild is properly strapped in the seat.
34
Child Seat Placement
Placing a forward-facing child seat inthe front seat of a vehicle equippedwith a passenger’s airbag can behazardous.
Protecting Infants and Small Children
44
Placing a forward-facing childseat in the front seat can resultin serious injury or death if thefront airbag inflates.
If you must place a forward-facing child seat in front, movethe vehicle seat as far back aspossible, and properly restrainthe child.
06/05/19 14:23:12 31STK600 0049
When buying a child seat, you needto choose either a conventional childseat, or one designed for use withthe lower anchors and tethers forchildren (LATCH) system.
Since LATCH-compatible child seatsare easier to install and reduce thepossibility of improper installation,we recommend selecting this style.
We also recommend selecting aLATCH-compatible seat with a rigid,rather than a flexible, anchor (seepage ).
In seating positions and vehicles notequipped with LATCH, a LATCH-compatible child seat can be installedusing a seat belt.
Whatever type of seat you choose, toprovide proper protection, a childseat should meet threerequirements:
Look for FMVSS213 or CMVSS 213 on the box.
Rear-facing for infants, forward-facing for small children.
Before purchasing a conventionalchild seat, or using a previouslypurchased one, we recommend thatyou test the seat in the specificvehicle seating position or positionswhere the seat will be used.
Conventional child seats must besecured to a vehicle with a seat belt,whereas LATCH-compatible seatsare secured by attaching the seat tohardware built into the rear seatingpositions.
48
The child seat should meet U.S. orCanadian Motor Vehicle SafetyStandard 213.
The child seat should be of theproper type and size to fit the child.
The child seat should fit thevehicle seating position (orpositions) where it will be used.
1.
2.
3.
Selecting a Child Seat
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
45
06/05/19 14:23:20 31STK600 0050
After selecting a proper child seatand a good place to install the seat,there are three main steps ininstalling the seat:
All child seats must besecured to the vehicle with the lappart of a lap/shoulder belt or withthe LATCH (lower anchors andtethers for children) system. Achild whose seat is not properlysecured to the vehicle can beendangered in a crash.
After installing a childseat, push and pull the seatforward and from side-to-side toverify that it is secure.
A child seat secured with a seat beltshould be installed as firmly aspossible. However, it does not needto be ‘‘rock solid.’’ Some side-to-sidemovement can be expected andshould not reduce the child seat’seffectiveness.
If the child seat is not secure, tryinstalling it in a different seatingposition, or use a different style ofchild seat that can be firmly secured.
Make sure the child is properlystrapped in the child seataccording to the child seat maker’sinstructions. A child who is notproperly secured in a child seatcan be seriously injured in a crash.
The following pages provideguidelines on how to properly installa child seat. A forward-facing childseat is used in all examples, but theinstructions are the same for rear-facing child seats.
Installing a Child Seat
Properly secure the child seat tothe vehicle.
Make sure the child seat is firmlysecured.
Secure the child in the child seat.
1.
2.
3.
46
06/05/19 14:23:27 31STK600 0051
Your vehicle is equipped withLATCH (lower anchors and tethersfor children) at the rear seats tosecure a child seat in any seatingposition: one in each outer seatingposition, or one in the center.
The five lower anchors are locatedbetween the seat-back and seatbottom, and are to be used only witha child seat designed for use withLATCH. The location of each lower anchor is
indicated by a small button above theanchor point.
When you install a child seat in therear center seating position, use thecenter LATCH as shown in theillustration. To install a child seat inthe outer seating position, use eitherLATCH. You can install up to twochild seat at a time with outerLATCH.
To install a LATCH-compatible childseat in either of the rear outer seats:
Move the seat belt buckle ortongue away from the loweranchors.Make sure there are no objectsnear the anchors that couldprevent a secure connectionbetween the child seat and theanchors.
1.
2.
CONTINUED
Installing a Child Seat withLATCH
Using the Outer LATCH
Installing a Child Seat
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
47
LOWER ANCHORSFOR OUTER LATCH
BUTTON LOWER ANCHORSFOR CENTER LATCH
OUTER LOWER ANCHORS
06/05/19 14:23:37 31STK600 0052
Whatever type you have, followthe child seat maker’s instructionsfor adjusting or tightening the fit.
Remove the cargo area cover, andplace it on the cargo area floor(see page ).
Lift the head restraint (see page), then route the tether strap
through the legs of the headrestraint and over the seat-back,making sure the strap is nottwisted.
Other LATCH-compatible seats havea flexible-type connector as shownabove.
Place the child seat on the vehicleseat, then attach the seat to thelower anchors according to thechild seat maker’s instructions.
Some LATCH-compatible seatshave a rigid-type connector asshown above.
5.
6.
4.
3.146
167
Installing a Child Seat
48
Flexible typeRigid type TETHER STRAP
06/05/19 14:23:45 31STK600 0053
Attach the tether strap hook to thetether anchor, then tighten thestrap as instructed by the childseat maker.
Push and pull the child seatforward and from side-to-side toverify that it is secure.
To install a LATCH-compatible childseat in the rear center seatingposition, use the center loweranchors as shown above.
Follow step 1 through 8 as describedpreviously to secure the child seat.
When you install the child seat in therear center seating position, youcannot use the seat belt behind thedriver’s seat.
Remove the head restraint (see page). Make sure the removed head
restraint is secured in the cargo area.Reinstall the head restraint when thechild seat is removed.
7.
8.
146
CONTINUED
Using the Center LATCH
Installing a Child Seat
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
49
CENTER LOWER ANCHORS
TETHER STRAP HOOK ANCHOR
06/06/16 19:06:54 31STK600 0054
If you want to install two child seatsin the back seats, place each childseat in the outer seat, as shown inthe above illustration.
Do not attach two child seatconnectors to a single lower anchorat a time.
The LATCH system or the childseats might be damaged if you try toinstall three child seats in the rearseats.
Installing a Child Seat
50
06/06/16 19:06:58 31STK600 0055
When not using the LATCH system,all child seats must be secured to thevehicle with the lap part of a lap/shoulder belt.
With the child seat in the desiredseating position, route the beltthrough the child seat accordingto the seat maker’s instructions,then insert the latch plate into thebuckle.
To activate the lockable retractor,slowly pull the shoulder part of thebelt all the way out until it stops,then let the belt feed back into theretractor.
After the belt has retracted, tug onit. If the belt is locked, you will notbe able to pull it out. If you can pullthe belt out, it is not locked, andyou will need to repeat these steps.
In addition, the lap/shoulder belts inall seating positions except thedriver’s have a lockable retractorthat must be activated to secure achild seat.
2.1.
3.
CONTINUED
Installing a Child Seat with a Lap/Shoulder Belt
Installing a Child Seat
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
51
06/05/19 14:24:05 31STK600 0056
After confirming that the belt islocked, grab the shoulder part ofthe belt near the buckle, and pullup to remove any slack from thelap part of the belt. Remember, ifthe lap part of the belt is not tight,the child seat will not be secure.
Push and pull the child seatforward and from side-to-side toverify that it is secure enough tostay upright during normal drivingmaneuvers. If the child seat is notsecure, unlatch the belt, allow it toretract fully, then repeat thesesteps.
To remove slack, it may help toput weight on the child seat, orpush on the back of the seat whilepulling up on the belt.
To deactivate the lockable retractorand remove a child seat, unlatch thebuckle, unroute the seat belt, and letthe belt fully retract.
A child seat with a tether can beinstalled in any seating position inthe back seat.
Since a tether can provide additionalsecurity to the lap/shoulder beltinstallation, we recommend using atether whenever one is required oravailable.
4. 5.
Installing a Child Seat
Installing a Child Seat with aTether
52
TETHER ANCHORAGE POINT
06/06/16 19:07:06 31STK600 0057
Tighten the strap according to theseat maker’s instructions.
Attach the tether strap hook to theanchor, making sure the tetherstrap is not twisted.
Remove the cargo area cover, andplace it on the cargo area floor(see page ).
After properly securing the childseat (see page ), lift the headrestraint, then route the tetherstrap over the seat-back andthrough the head restraint legs.
Remove the head restraint (seepage ). Make sure the removedhead restraint is secured in thecargo area. Reinstall the headrestraint when the child seat isremoved.
After properly securing the childseat (see page ), route thetether strap over the top of theseat-back.
When you install the child seat inthe rear center seating position,you cannot use the seat beltbehind the driver’s seat.
1.
4.
2.
3.
(Outer seating position)
(Rear center seating position)
51
146
51167
Installing a Child Seat
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
53
TETHER STRAP HOOKTETHER STRAP ANCHOR
06/06/16 19:07:14 31STK600 0058
When a child reaches therecommended weight or height limitfor a forward-facing child seat, thechild should sit in a back seat on abooster seat and wear a lap/shoulderbelt.
The following pages giveinstructions on how to check properseat belt fit, what kind of boosterseat to use if one is needed, andimportant precautions for a childwho must sit in front.
To determine if a lap/shoulder beltproperly fits a child, have the childput on the seat belt, then askyourself:
Does the child sit all the way backagainst the seat?
Do the child’s knees bendcomfortably over the edge of theseat?
1.
2.
Checking Seat Belt Fit
Protecting Larger Children
54
Allowing a child age 12 or underto sit in front can result in injuryor death if the passenger’s frontairbag inflates.
If a child must ride in front,move the vehicle seat as farback as possible, use a boosterseat if needed, have the childsit up properly and wear theseat belt properly.
06/05/19 14:24:27 31STK600 0059
CONTINUED
Does the shoulder belt crossbetween the child’s neck and arm?
Is the lap part of the belt as low aspossible, touching the child’sthighs?
Will the child be able to stayseated like this for the whole trip?
If you answer yes to all thesequestions, the child is ready to wearthe lap/shoulder belt correctly. Ifyou answer no to any question, thechild needs to ride on a booster seat. A child who has outgrown a forward-
facing child seat should ride in aback seat and use a booster seatuntil the lap/shoulder belt fits themproperly without the booster.
Booster seats can be high-back orlow-back. Whichever style you select,make sure the booster seat meetsfederal safety standards (see page
) and that you follow the boosterseat maker’s instructions.
Some states and Canadian provincesalso require children to use a boosterseat until they reach a given age orweight (e.g., 6 years or 60 lbs). Besure to check current laws in thestates or provinces where you intendto drive.
3.
4.
5.
45
Protecting Larger Children
Using a Booster Seat
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
55
06/05/19 14:24:35 31STK600 0060
If a child who uses a booster seatmust ride in front, move the vehicleseat as far back as possible and besure the child is wearing the seatbelt properly.
A child may continue using a boosterseat until the tops of their ears areeven with the top of the vehicle’s orbooster’s seat-back. A child of thisheight should be tall enough to usethe lap/shoulder belt without abooster seat.
The National Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration and TransportCanada recommend that all childrenaged 12 and under be properlyrestrained in a back seat.
If the passenger’s front airbaginflates in a moderate to severefrontal collision, the airbag can causeserious injuries to a child who isunrestrained, improperly restrained,sitting too close to the airbag, or outof position.
A side airbag also poses risks. If anypart of a larger child’s body is in thepath of a deploying side airbag, thechild could receive possibly seriousinjuries.
Of course, children vary widely. Andwhile age may be one indicator ofwhen a child can safely ride in front,there are other important factors youshould consider.
Physically, a child must be largeenough for the lap/shoulder belt toproperly fit (see pages and ). Ifthe seat belt does not fit properly,with or without the child sitting on abooster seat, the child should not sitin front.
To safely ride in front, a child mustbe able to follow the rules, includingsitting properly, and wearing the seatbelt properly throughout a ride.
16 54
When Can a Larger Child Sit inFront
Physical Size
Maturity
Protecting Larger Children
56
06/06/16 19:07:22 31STK600 0061
If you decide that a child can safelyride up front, be sure to:
Carefully read the owner’s manual,and make sure you understand allseat belt instructions and all safetyinformation.
Have the child sit up straight, backagainst the seat, and feet on ornear the floor.
Move the vehicle seat to the rear-most position.
Devices intended toimprove a child’s comfort orreposition the shoulder part of aseat belt can make the belt lesseffective and increase the chanceof serious injury in a crash.
This could resultin serious neck injuries during acrash.
Check that the child’s seat belt isproperly and securely positioned. If they do, they
could be very seriously injured in acrash.
This couldcause very serious injuries duringa crash. It also increases thechance that the child will slideunder the belt in a crash and beinjured.
Supervise the child. Even a maturechild sometimes needs to bereminded to fasten the seat belt orsit properly.
Do not put any accessories on aseat belt.Do not let a child wear a seat belt
across the neck.
Two children should never use thesame seat belt.
Do not let a child put the shoulderpart of a seat belt behind the backor under the arm.
Additional Safety Precautions
Protecting Larger Children
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
57
06/05/19 14:24:51 31STK600 0062
Your vehicle’s exhaust containscarbon monoxide gas. Carbonmonoxide should not enter thevehicle in normal driving if youmaintain your vehicle properly andfollow the information on this page.
Have the exhaust system inspectedfor leaks whenever:
High levels of carbon monoxide cancollect rapidly in enclosed areas,such as a garage. Do not run theengine with the garage door closed.Even with the door open, run theengine only long enough to move thevehicle out of the garage.
The vehicle is raised for an oilchange.
You notice a change in the soundof the exhaust.
The vehicle was in an accidentthat may have damaged theunderside.
With the tailgate open, airflow canpull exhaust gas into your vehicle’sinterior and create a hazardouscondition. If you must drive with thetailgate open, open all the windows,and set the climate control system asshown below.
If you must sit in your parked vehiclewith the engine running, even in anunconfined area, adjust the climatecontrol system as follows:
Select the fresh air mode.Select the mode.Set the fan speed to high.Set the temperature control to acomfortable setting.
1.2.3.4.
Carbon Monoxide Hazard
58
Carbon monoxide gas is toxic.Breathing it can causeunconsciousness and even killyou.
Avoid any enclosed areas oractivities that expose you tocarbon monoxide.
06/05/19 14:24:59 31STK600 0063
These labels are in the locationsshown. They warn you of potentialhazards that could cause seriousinjury or death. Read these labelscarefully.
If a label comes off or becomes hardto read (except for the U.S.dashboard label which may beremoved by the owner), contact yourdealer for a replacement.
CONTINUED
U.S. models only
Canadian modelsU.S. models
U.S. models only
Safety Labels
Driver
andP
assengerSafety
59
DASHBOARD
SUN VISOR
SUN VISORS
06/06/16 19:11:18 31STK600 0064
Canadian modelsU.S. modelsU.S. models
Canadian models
Safety Labels
60
HOOD
RADIATOR CAP
DOOR JAMBS
06/05/19 14:25:33 31STK600 0065
This section gives information aboutthe controls and displays thatcontribute to the daily operation ofyour vehicle. All the essentialcontrols are within easy reach.
The instrument panel has manyindicators that give you importantinformation about your vehicle.
This indicator comes on when youturn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position. It reminds you and yourpassengers to fasten your seat belts.A beeper also sounds if you have notfastened your seat belt.
If you turn the ignition switch to theON (II) position before fasteningyour seat belts, the beeper sounds,and the indicator flashes. If you donot fasten your seat belts before thebeeper stops, the indicator stopsflashing but remains on.
If your front passenger does notfasten their seat belt, the indicatorcomes on about 6 seconds after theignition switch is turned to the ON(II) position.
You will also see a ‘‘FASTEN SEATBELT’’ or ‘‘FASTEN PASSENGERSEAT BELT’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
If either of you do not fasten yourseat belt while driving, the beeperwill sound and the indicator will flashagain at regular intervals. For moreinformation, see page .
The engine can be severely damagedif this indicator flashes or stays onwhen the engine is running. Formore information, see page .
You will also see a ‘‘OIL PRESSURELOW’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
For more information, see page .
You will also see a ‘‘CHECKEMISSION SYSTEM’’ message onthe multi-information display (seepage ).
84
394
393
84
2084
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Instrument Panel Indicators
Seat Belt ReminderIndicator
Malfunction IndicatorLamp
Low Oil PressureIndicator
Instruments
andC
ontrols
65
06/05/19 14:26:15 31STK600 0070
You will also see a ‘‘CHECKCHARGING SYSTEM’’ message onthe multi-information display (seepage ).
This indicator monitors thetemperature of the automatictransmission fluid. If it comes onwhile driving, it means thetransmission fluid temperature is toohigh. Pull to the side of the roadwhen it is safe, shift to Park, and letthe engine idle until the indicatorgoes out.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECKTRANSMISSION’’ message on themulti-information display (see page
).
If this indicator comes on when theengine is running, the battery is notbeing charged. For more information,see page .
This indicator comes on for severalseconds when you turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position. If itcomes on at any other time, itindicates a potential problem withyour front airbags. This indicator willalso alert you to a potential problemwith your side airbags, passenger’sside airbag automatic cutoff system,side curtain airbags, automatic seatbelt tensioners, driver’s seat positionsensor, or the front passenger’sweight sensors. For moreinformation, see page .
You will also see a ‘‘CHECKAIRBAG SYSTEM’’ message on themulti-information display (see page
).
393
85
85
33
84 On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Instrument Panel Indicators
Charging SystemIndicator
A/T TemperatureIndicator
Supplemental RestraintSystem (SRS) Indicator
66
Continuing to drive with the A/Ttemperature indicator on may causeserious damage to the transmission.
06/05/19 14:26:24 31STK600 0071
This indicator comes on when youturn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position. If it comes on at anyother time, it indicates that thepassenger’s side airbag hasautomatically shut off. For moreinformation, see page .
You will also see a ‘‘PASSENGERSIDE AIRBAG OFF’’ message on themulti-information display (see page
).You will also see a ‘‘CHECK ABSSYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position, and when the ignitionswitch is turned to the START (III)position. If it comes on at any othertime, there is a problem with theABS. If this happens, have yourvehicle checked at a dealer. Withthis indicator on, your vehicle stillhas normal braking ability but noanti-lock function. For moreinformation, see page .
This indicator comes on briefly whenyou turn the ignition switch to theON (II) position. It will then go off ifyou have inserted a properly-codedignition key. If it is not a properly-coded key, the indicator will blink,and the engine will not start (seepage ).
85
307
85
33128
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Instrument Panel Indicators
Side Airbag Off Indicator
Anti-lock Brake System(ABS) Indicator
Immobilizer SystemIndicator
Instruments
andC
ontrols
67
CanadaU.S.
06/05/19 14:26:33 31STK600 0072
This indicator has two functions:
It comes on when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position. It is a reminder to checkthe parking brake. A beepersounds if you drive with theparking brake not fully released.Driving with the parking brake notfully released can damage thebrakes and tires.
You will also see a ‘‘RELEASEPARKING BRAKE’’ message on themulti-information display (see page
).
If it remains on after you havefully released the parking brakewhile the engine is running, or if itcomes on while driving, therecould be a problem with the brakesystem. For more information, seepage .
You will also see a ‘‘BRAKE FLUIDLOW’’ or ‘‘CHECK BRAKESYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
The brake system indicator (amber)normally comes on for a few secondswhen you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position. If the indicatoris still on or comes on again after theengine starts, there is a problem inthe brake system including theelectric vacuum pump. If thishappens, have your vehicle checkedby your dealer. For more information,see page .
You will also see a ‘‘CHECK BRAKESYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
2.
1.
84
84
395
84396
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Instrument Panel Indicators
Parking Brake and Brake SystemIndicator (Red)
Brake System Indicator (Amber)
68
U.S. Canada U.S. Canada
06/05/19 14:26:43 31STK600 0073
This indicator is in the fuel gauge. Itcomes on as a reminder that youmust refuel soon. When the indicatorcomes on, there is about 2.0 US gal(7.6 ) of fuel remaining in the tankbefore the reading reaches E. Thereis a small reserve of fuel remainingin the tank when the reading doesreach E.
You will also see a ‘‘FUEL LOW’’message on the multi-informationdisplay (see page ).
If it comes on and stays on at anyother time, or if it does not come onwhen you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, there is aproblem with the VSA system. Takeyour vehicle to a dealer to have itchecked. Without VSA, your vehiclestill has normal driving ability, butwill not have VSA traction andstability enhancement. See page
for more information on theVSA system.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECK VSASYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position.
85
315
85
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Instrument Panel Indicators
Low Fuel Indicator Vehicle Stability Assist(VSA) System Indicator
Instruments
andC
ontrols
69
LOW FUEL INDICATOR
06/05/19 14:26:51 31STK600 0074
It comes on as a reminder that youhave turned off the vehiclestability assist (VSA) system.
This indicator has three functions: This indicator comes on when youturn on the cruise control system bypressing the CRUISE button (seepage ).
The left or right turn signal indicatorblinks when you signal a lane changeor turn. If an indicator does not blinkor blinks rapidly, it usually meansone of the turn signal bulbs isburned out (see pages and ).Replace the bulb as soon as possible,since other drivers cannot see thatyou are signaling.
When you press the hazard warningbutton, both turn signal indicatorsand all turn signals on the outside ofthe vehicle flash.
This indicator comes on when youset the cruise control. See page
for information on operating thecruise control.
This indicator comes on with thehigh beam headlights. For moreinformation, see page .
This indicator also comes on withreduced brightness when thedaytime running lights (DRL) are on(see page ).
It flashes when VSA is active (seepage ).It comes on along with the VSAsystem indicator if there is aproblem with the VSA system.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECK VSASYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page
).
This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position. See page for moreinformation on the VSA system.
1.
2.
3.
241
241
122
123
362360315
85
315
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Instrument Panel Indicators
VSA Activation Indicator
Cruise Control Indicator
Turn Signal and Hazard WarningIndicators
Cruise Main Indicator
High Beam Indicator
70
06/05/19 14:27:06 31STK600 0075
If you see a ‘‘CHECK DRLSYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display, there is aproblem in the high beam headlight’scircuit. Take your vehicle to a dealerto have it checked (see page ).
This indicator comes on when thesecurity system is set. For moreinformation, see page .
If this indicator comes on when theignition switch is turned to the ON(II) position and the parking brake isreleased, it means there is a problemin the high beam headlight’s circuit.Have your vehicle checked by yourdealer.
This indicator reminds you that theexterior lights are on. It comes onwhen the light switch is in either the
or position. If you turn theignition switch to the ACCESSORY(I) or the LOCK (0) position withoutturning off the light switch, thisindicator will remain on. A reminderchime will also sound when you openthe driver’s door and remove the keyfrom the ignition switch.
This indicator comes on when youturn on the fog lights. For moreinformation, see page .12285
240
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX model only
Instrument Panel Indicators
Security System IndicatorDaytime Running LightsIndicator
Lights On Indicator
Fog Light Indicator
Instruments
andC
ontrols
71
SECURITY SYSTEM INDICATOR
06/05/19 14:27:14 31STK600 0076
If a ‘‘CHECK SH-AWD SYSTEM’’message on the multi-informationdisplay comes on (see page )along with the SH-AWD indicator atany other time, there is a problem inthe SH-AWD system.
If this indicator comes on at anyother time, there is a problem in theSH-AWD system. Avoid rapidacceleration, and take your vehicle toa dealer to have it checked as soonas possible.
This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position.
If this indicator blinks while driving,it indicates the differentialtemperature is too high.
If this indicator blinks while driving,you will also see an ‘‘SH-AWD DIFFTEMP HIGH’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
Pull to the side of the road when it issafe, shift to Park, and let the engineidle until the indicator goes out. Ifthe indicator does not go out, takeyour vehicle to a dealer to have itchecked.
For more information, see page .
This monitor is displayed as thesystem message on the multi-information display (see page ).
This monitor normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position. While driving, theappropriate tire indicator will comeon, along with the low tire pressureindicator, if a tire is extremelyunderinflated or has suddenly lostpressure. See
for what to do if thisindicator comes on.
85
30385
312
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX model
Instrument Panel Indicators
SH-AWD Indicator Tire Pressure Monitor
Low Tire PressureIndicator
72
Continuing to drive with the SH-AWDindicator blinking may cause seriousdamage to the system.
06/05/19 14:27:24 31STK600 0077
This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position.
If it comes on while driving, itindicates that one or more of yourvehicle’s tires are extremely low onpressure.
This indicator normally comes on fora few seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position.
If this indicator comes on and stayson at any other time, or if it does notcome on when you turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position, thereis a problem with the TPMS. Withthis indicator on, the low tirepressure indicator and the tirepressure monitor will not come onwhen a tire loses pressure. Take thevehicle to your dealer to have thesystem checked.
If this happens, pull to the side of theroad when it is safe. If it is becauseof a flat tire, replace the flat tire withthe compact spare (see page ),and have the flat tire repaired assoon as possible. If two or more tiresare underinflated, call a professionaltowing service (see page ). Formore information, see page .
Check the tire pressure monitor onthe multi-information display anddetermine the cause (see page ).
You may see one or more of the lowpressure tire positions the displayare displayed along with thismessage.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECK TIREPRESSURE’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
Check which tire has lost pressureon the tire pressure monitor (seepage ), and determine the cause.
84
403309
311
313
383
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX model only
On RDX model
Instrument Panel Indicators
Low Tire PressureIndicator
Tire Pressure MonitoringSystem (TPMS) Indicator
Instruments
andC
ontrols
73
06/06/16 19:11:51 31STK600 0078
This indicator comes on for a fewseconds when you turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position. Itreminds you that it is time to takeyour vehicle in for scheduledmaintenance. The maintenance mainitems and sub items will be displayedin the information display. See page
for more information on themaintenance minder.
This indicator goes off when yourdealer resets it after completing therequired maintenance service.
This indicator comes on when thereis a system message in the multi-information display. Press the INFObutton on the steering wheel (seepage ) to see the message (seepage ).
This indicator comes on when thewasher fluid level is low. Add washerfluid when you see this indicator(see page ).
Most of the time, this indicatorcomes on along with other indicatorsin the instrument panel such as theseat belt reminder indicator, SRSindicator, VSA system indicator, etc.
Your vehicle has a door and tailgateopen monitor on the informationdisplay. If any door(s) or the tailgateis not closed tightly, the appropriatelight/lights will come on to remindsyou to close the tailgate or thedoor(s).
The door and tailgate open monitorappears on the multi-informationdisplay (see page ).
79
330
353
84
86
On RDX model only On RDX with Technology Packagemodel only
Canadian RDX model only
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel only
On RDX model
Instrument Panel Indicators
Maintenance MinderIndicator
System MessageIndicator
Washer Level Indicator
Door and Tailgate Open Monitor
74
06/06/16 19:12:02 31STK600 0079
When the turbo charger is activated,this meter shows the boost pressure.
This shows how much fuel you have.It may show slightly more or lessthan the actual amount. The needlereturns to the bottom after you turnoff the ignition.
CONTINUED
Turbo Boost Meter
Fuel Gauge
Gauges
Instruments
andC
ontrols
75
RDX model
SELECT/RESETKNOB
SELECT/RESETKNOB
SPEEDOMETER
INFORMATIONDISPLAY
RDX with Technology Package model
FUEL GAUGE
FUEL GAUGE
SPEEDOMETER
TURBO BOOST METER
TURBO BOOST METER
MULTI-INFORMATIONDISPLAY
TACHOMETER
TACHOMETERAvoid driving with an extremely lowf uel level. Running out of f uel couldcause the engine to misf ire, damagingthe catalytic converter.
06/06/16 19:12:12 31STK600 0080
The odometer shows the totaldistance your vehicle has beendriven. It measures miles in U.S.models and kilometers in Canadianmodels. It is illegal under U.S.federal law and Canadian provincialregulations to disconnect, reset, oralter the odometer with the intent tochange the number of miles orkilometers indicated.
This meter shows the number ofmiles (U.S.) or kilometers (Canada)driven since you last reset it. Thereare two trip meters: Trip A and TripB. Each trip meter worksindependently, so you can keep trackof two different distances.
For information about multi-information display, see page .
When you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, what you lastselected is displayed.
To change the display, push theSelect/Reset knob on the instrumentpanel repeatedly until the desiredinformation appears.
The information display in theinstrument panel displays variousinformation when the ignition switchis in the ON (II) position. Someinformation helps your safety driving.Others help to keep you aware of theperiodic maintenance your vehicleneeds for continued trouble-freedriving.
79
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX model
Gauges
Odometer Trip Meter
Information Display
76
: Press the Select/Reset knob U.S. model is shown
06/05/19 14:28:04 31STK600 0081
± ±
- -- - -- - -
To reset a trip meter, display it, andthen press and hold the Select/Resetknob until the number resets to ‘‘0.0’’.
When you reset Trip A, AVG. FUELA is reset at the same time. Whenyou reset Trip B, AVG. FUEL B isreset.
This shows your vehicle’s averagefuel economy in mpg (U.S. models)or /100 km (Canadian models)since you last reset the Trip A orTrip B.
If the outside temperature isincorrectly displayed, you can adjustit up 5°F in U.S. models ( 3°C inCanadian models) warmer or cooler.
NOTE: The temperature must bestabilized before doing thisprocedure.
When the temperature reaches thedesired value, release the Select/Reset knob. You should see the newoutside temperature displayed.
The average fuel mileage will bereset when you reset the trip meter,or if the vehicle’s battery goes deador is disconnected.
This shows the outside temperaturein Fahrenheit (U.S. models), or inCentigrade (Canadian models).
The temperature sensor is in thefront bumper. The temperaturereading can be affected by heatreflection from the road surface,engine heat, and the exhaust fromsurrounding traffic. This can causean incorrect temperature readingwhen your vehicle speed is under19 mph (30 km/h). When you startyour trip, the sensor is not fullyacclimatized, therefore it may takeseveral minutes until the propertemperature is displayed.
In certain weather conditions,temperature readings near freezing(32°F, 0°C) could mean that ice isforming on the road surface.
To adjust the outside temperatureindicator, press and hold the Select/Reset knob for 10 seconds. Thefollowing sequence will appear for 1second each: 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 5, 4,
This shows the temperature of theengine’s coolant. During normaloperation, the reading should risefrom the ‘‘C (Cold)’’ mark to aboutthe middle of the gauge. In severedriving conditions, such as very hotweather or a long period of uphilldriving, the reading may rise to nearthe ‘‘H (Hot)’’ mark of the gauge. Ifit reaches the ‘‘H’’ mark, pull safelyto the side of the road. See page
for instructions and precautionson checking the engine’s coolantsystem.
The information display in theinstrument panel shows you theengine oil life and maintenanceservice items when the ignitionswitch is in the ON (II) position. Thisinformation helps to keep you awareof the periodic maintenance yourvehicle needs for continued trouble-free driving. Refer to page formore information.
If your fuel fill cap is loose ormissing, a ‘‘CHECK FUEL CAP’’message appears on the informationdisplay after you start the engine.For more information, see page .
391
330
280
Gauges
Temperature Gauge Check Fuel Cap MessageMaintenance Minder
78
06/05/19 14:28:21 31STK600 0083
▲▼
To change the display, press theSEL/RESET button or INFO ( /
) button on the steering wheelrepeatedly until the desiredinformation appears (see page ).
You can also change the display bypressing the Select/Reset knob inthe instrument panel.
The multi-information display in theinstrument panel displays variousinformation and messages when theignition switch is in the ON (II)position. Some of the messages helpyou operate your vehicle morecomfortably.Others help to keep you aware of theperiodic maintenance your vehicleneeds for continued trouble-freedriving.
When you open the driver’s door, a‘‘Welcome’’ message is shown on themulti-information display. When youturn the ignition switch from the ON(II) position to the ACCESSORY (I)position, a ‘‘Goodbye’’ message isshown on the display.
When you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, what you lastselected is displayed.
In the multi-information display, thesystem message is also displayed(see page ) and you cancustomize your vehicle controlsettings (see page ).
80
84
87
CONTINUED
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
79
SEL/RESETBUTTON
INFO BUTTONS
06/05/19 14:28:29 31STK600 0084
▲ ▼
Multi-Information Display
80
U.S. model is shown.
: Press the INFO( / ) Button
: Press the SEL/RESET Button
IGNITION OFF
IGNITION ON
06/05/19 14:28:35 31STK600 0085
The odometer shows the totaldistance your vehicle has beendriven. It measures miles in U.S.models and kilometers in Canadianmodels. It is illegal under U.S.federal law and Canadian provincialregulations to disconnect, reset, oralter the odometer with the intent tochange the number of miles orkilometers indicated.
This meter shows the number ofmiles (U.S.) or kilometers (Canada)driven since you last reset it. Thereare two trip meters: Trip A and TripB. Each trip meter worksindependently, so you can keep trackof two different distances.
When you reset Trip A, AVG.FUEL A is reset at the same time.When you reset Trip B, AVG.FUEL B is reset.
The temperature sensor is in thefront bumper. The temperaturereading can be affected by heatreflection from the road surface,engine heat, and the exhaust fromsurrounding traffic. This can causean incorrect temperature readingwhen your vehicle speed is under19 mph (30 km/h). When you startyour trip, the sensor is not fullyacclimatized, therefore it may takeseveral minutes until the propertemperature is displayed.
In certain weather conditions,temperature readings near freezing(32°F, 0°C) could mean that ice isforming on the road surface.
To reset a trip meter, display it, thenpress and hold the SEL/RESETbutton until the number resets to‘‘0.0’’.
You can adjust the outsidetemperature in the multi-informationdisplay (see page ).
You can customize the Trip A andAVG. FUEL A reset condition in themulti-information display (see page
).
This shows the outside temperaturein Fahrenheit (U.S. models), or inCentigrade (Canadian models).
98
96
Multi-Information Display
Odometer
Trip Meter
Outside Temperature Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
81
06/06/16 19:12:21 31STK600 0086
This shows the estimated distanceyou can travel on the fuel remainingin the fuel tank. This distance isestimated from the fuel economyyou received over the last severalmiles(U.S.) or kilometers (Canada),so it will vary with changes in speed,traffic, etc.
This shows the time traveled sinceyou last reset it. When you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position, ELAPSED TIME is reset.
You can customize the ELAPSEDTIME reset condition in the multi-information display (see page ).
You can customize the Trip A andAVG. FUEL A reset condition in themulti-information display (see page
).
This shows your vehicle’s averagefuel economy in mpg (U.S. models)or /100 km (Canadian models)since you last reset the Trip A orTrip B.
When you reset Trip A, AVG.SPEED is also reset.
This shows the average speed youare traveling in miles per hour (mph)for U.S. models or kilometers perhour (km/h) for Canadian models.
When the battery is disconnected, oryou refuel, RANGE is also reset.
The multi-information display in theinstrument panel shows you theengine oil life and maintenanceservice items when the ignitionswitch is in the ON (II) position. Thisinformation helps to keep you awareof the periodic maintenance yourvehicle needs for continued trouble-free driving. Refer to page formore information.
This shows your current fuelmileage.
When you turn off the engine, INST.MPG or INST. L/100 km is alsoreset.
The average fuel mileage will bereset when you reset the trip meter,or if the vehicle’s battery goes deador is disconnected.
This monitor shows how muchtorque is being delivered to eachwheel. For more information, seepage .
You can see the pressure of each tirein this monitor. If one or more tirepressure are low, inflate them to thecorrect pressure. For moreinformation, see page .
This shows the temperature of theengine’s coolant. During normaloperation, the reading should risefrom the ‘‘C (Cold)’’ mark to aboutthe middle of the gauge. In severedriving conditions, such as very hotweather or a long period of uphilldriving, the reading may rise to nearthe ‘‘H (Hot)’’ mark of the gauge. Ifit reaches the ‘‘H’’ mark, pull safelyto the side of the road. See page
for instructions and precautionson checking the engine’s coolantsystem.
You can receive or make phone callsfrom your cellphone through yourvehicle’s HandsFreeLink (HFL)system without touching yourcellphone.
To use the system, your cellphoneand the HFL system must be linked.Not all cellphones are compatiblewith this system. Refer to page
for instructions on how to linkyour cellphone to the HFL and howto receive or make phone calls, orvisit the handsfreelink.com website.
391
303
312262
SH-AWD Torque DistributionMonitor
Tire Pressure Monitor
Temperature Gauge HandsFreeLink
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
83
TM
06/06/16 19:12:29 31STK600 0088
If there is a problem with yourvehicle, for example, the engine oillevel is low or a door is not fullyclosed, the multi-information displaywill show you the problem. It doesthis by interrupting the currentdisplay with one or more messages.
Here is a list of messages shown onthe multi-information display:
See page12
See page394
See page393
See page393
See page20
See page395
See page313
See page312
See page68
See pages395, 396
Multi-Information Display
System Messages
84
U.S. Canada
CanadaU.S.
CanadaU.S.
06/06/16 19:12:42 31STK600 0089
CONTINUED
See page12
See page295
See page304
See page304
See page33
See page307
See page315
See page33
See page123
See page69
See page281
See page353
See page334
See page130
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
85
U.S. Canada
06/05/19 14:29:31 31STK600 0090
▲ ▼
▲ ▼▲ ▼
▲ ▼
The system message(s) triggers theappropriate indicator(s) on theinstrument panel, including thesystem message indicator, to comeon. The system message indicatordoes not go off until the problem(s)is corrected.
You will also hear a beep when thesystem message indicator comes onfor the first time.
Most of the messages are displayedfor about 5 seconds, and then thenormal display returns. If there areseveral system messages to beshown, the display switches thesemessages every 5 seconds.
To cancel the message(s) before 5seconds elapsed, press the INFO( / ) button on the steering wheel.
Even if you press the INFO ( / )button, some messages stay on orcome on again at regular intervalsuntil the problem is corrected.
You can see the message(s) again bypressing the INFO ( / ) buttonrepeatedly if the system messageindicator remains lit on theinstrument panel.
FASTEN SEAT BELTFASTEN PASSENGER SEATBELTRELEASE PARKING BRAKEDoor and Tailgate Open
Multi-Information Display
86
SYSTEM MESSAGE INDICATOR
Press the INFO ( / ) button
06/06/16 20:24:19 31STK600 0091
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
With the multi-information displayand the INFO ( / ) and SEL/RESET buttons on the right side ofthe steering wheel, you cancustomize some vehicle controlsettings.
To enter the customizing mode,press and hold the INFO ( / )button for more than 3 seconds.
To change the settings, the ignitionswitch must be in the ON (II)position, and the vehicle must bestopped with the transmission inPark.
You cannot customize the settingsunder these conditions:
If you turn the ignition switch tothe ACCESSORY (I) or the LOCK(0) position.
If you move the shift lever out ofPark.
If you want the settings as they werewhen the vehicle left the factory,select DEFAULT ALL, as describedon page .
Refer to the table in the next pageabout the settings you want tocustomize.
The first customizing menu is:CHG SETTINGDEFAULT ALL
If you want to change any vehiclecontrol settings, select CHGSETTING, then press the SEL/RESET button (see page ).
90
91
CONTINUED
Customized Settings
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
87
06/05/19 14:29:50 31STK600 0092
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
*
- ~± ~- ~± ~
*
Menu Item Setting Option PageGroup Setup DescriptionLANGUAGE SELECTION
ADJUST OUTSIDETEMP. DISPLAYTRIP A & AVG. FUELRESET with REFUELELAP. TIME RESETCONDITION
INTERIOR LIGHTDIMMING TIME
HEADLIGHT AUTO OFFTIMER
AUTO DOOR LOCK
ENGLISHFRENCHSPANISH
5°F 0°F 5°F3°C 0°C 3°C
ONOFFIGN RESETTRIP A RESETTRIP B RESET15 sec30 sec60 sec0 sec15 sec30 sec60 secSHIFT FROM PWITH VEH SPEEDOFF
94
96
98
100
103
105
108
METER SETUP(P.93)
LIGHTING SETUP(P.102)
DOOR SETUP(P.107)
Changes the language used in the display.
Changes the outside temperature reading above orbelow its current reading.Causes trip meter A and the average fuel economyto reset when you refuel.Resets the elapsed time of your current trip.
Changes how long (in seconds) the interior lightsstay on after you close the doors.
Changes how long (in seconds) the exterior lightsstay on after you close the driver’s door.
Changes when the doors automatically lock.
: Default setting
Multi-Information Display
88
06/05/19 14:29:55 31STK600 0093
*
*
*
*
*
Menu Item PageGroup Setup Setting OptionDescriptionDOOR LOCK MODE
KEYLESS LOCKACKNOWLEDGMENT
SECURITY RELOCK TIMER
AUTO DOOR UNLOCK
110
112
114
116
90
DOOR SETUP(P.107)
DEFAULT ALL
DRIVER DOORALL DOORSONOFF
30 sec60 sec90 secDRIVER’S DOOR WITHSHIFT TO PALL DOORS WITHSHIFT TO PDRIVER’S DOOR WITHIGN OFFALL DOORS WITH IGNOFFOFFSETEXIT
Changes which doors unlock with the remotetransmitter in a first push.The exterior lights flash each time you press theLOCK or UNLOCK button. A beeper will alsosound when you press the LOCK button twice.Changes how long it takes (in seconds) for thedoors to relock and the security system to set afteryou unlock and not opening the door.Changes when the doors automatically unlock.
Changes all the customized settings as they werethe vehicle left the factory.
: Default setting
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
89
06/05/19 14:30:01 31STK600 0094
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
If you want to set the default settings,press the INFO ( / ) button toselect DEFAULT ALL, then pressthe SEL/RESET button.
To enter the customizing mode,press and hold the INFO ( / )button for more than 3 seconds.
When DEFAULT ALL is set, you willsee the above display for severalseconds, then the screen returns toCUSTOMIZE ENTRY.
To set the default settings, selectDEFAULT ALL, and press the SEL/RESET button. Then select SET, andpress the SEL/RESET button.
Multi-Information Display
DEFAULT ALL
90
06/06/16 20:24:26 31STK600 0095
▲▼
▲ ▼
CONTINUED
You can customize some of thevehicle control settings to yourpreference. Here are the settingsyou can customize:
METER SETUPLIGHTING SETUPDOOR SETUP
While CHG SETTING in theCUSTOMIZE ENTRY is shown inthe multi-information display, pressthe SEL/RESET button. The screenchanges to METER SETUP in theCUSTOMIZE GROUP.
Each time you press the INFO ( /) button, the screen changes as
shown on the next page. Press theINFO ( / ) button, until you seethe setup you want to customize,then press the SEL/RESET buttonto enter your selection.
If DEFAULT ALL is not set, you willsee the above display for severalseconds, then the screen goes backto CUSTOMIZE ENTRY. Repeat theprocedure to select DEFAULT ALL.
If you want to cancel DEFAULTALL, select EXIT, then press theSEL/RESET button. The screengoes back to CUSTOMIZE ENTRY.
Multi-Information Display
Change Settings
Instruments
andC
ontrols
91
06/06/16 20:21:56 31STK600 0096
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
Multi-Information Display
92
: Press and hold theINFO ( / ) button(3 seconds)
: Press the SEL/RESETbutton or the Select/Reset knob
: Press the INFO ( / )button or rotate theSelect/Reset knob
See page 93
See page 102
See page 107
06/06/16 19:14:42 31STK600 0097
▲▼
▲ ▼▲ ▼
Here are the four custom settingsfor the meter setup:
LANGUAGE SELECTIONADJUST OUTSIDE TEMP.DISPLAYTRIP A & AVG. FUEL RESETwith REFUELELAP. TIME RESETCONDITION
While METER SETUP is shown inthe CUSTOMIZE GROUP of themulti-information display, press theSEL/RESET button.
Each time you press the INFO ( /) button, the screen changes as
shown in the illustration. Press theINFO ( / ) button until you seethe setting you want to customize,then press the SEL/RESET buttonto enter your selection.
CONTINUED
Meter Setup
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
93
: Press the SEL/RESET button orthe Select/Resetknob
: Press the INFO( / ) button orrotate Select/Reset knob
See page 94
See page 96
See page 98
See page 100
06/06/16 19:14:52 31STK600 0098
▲ ▼
There are three language selectionsyou can make: English, French, andSpanish. To choose the language youwant, follow these instructions:
While METER SETUP is shown inthe CUSTOMIZE GROUP of themulti-information display, press theSEL/RESET button. You will see theabove display.
Select the desired language bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then enter your selection by pressingthe SEL/RESET button.
Multi-Information Display
Language Selection
94
06/05/19 14:30:36 31STK600 0099
▲ ▼
To exit LANGUAGE SELECTIONwithout changing the current setting,select EXIT by pressing the INFO( / ) button, then press the SEL/RESET button. The screen goesback to CUSTOMIZE MENU.All messages in the multi-
information display will be shown inthe language you selected.
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU. If thishappens, you need to repeat thesame procedure.
CONTINUED
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
95
06/06/16 19:14:59 31STK600 0100
▲▼▲ ▼
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above. Thehighlighted number is the currentsetting above or below the outsidetemperature. Press the INFO ( /
) button repeatedly until thenumber you want appears, thenpress the SEL/RESET button toenter your selection.
If you sometimes find that thetemperature reading is a fewdegrees above or below the actualtemperature, you can adjust it byfollowing these instructions:
While METER SETUP is shown inthe CUSTOMIZE GROUP of themulti-information display, press theSEL/RESET button. The screenchanges to CUSTOMIZE MENU.Press the INFO ( / ) button untilyou see the above display.
Multi-Information Display
Adjust Outside Temp. Display
96
U.S.
Canada
06/05/19 14:30:49 31STK600 0101
▲ ▼
CONTINUED
To exit ADJUST OUTSIDE TEMP.DISPLAY without changing thecurrent setting, select EXIT bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then press the SEL/RESET button.The screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU. If thishappens, you need to repeat thesame procedure.
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
97
U.S.
Canada
06/06/16 20:24:33 31STK600 0102
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
While METER SETUP is shown inthe CUSTOMIZE GROUP of themulti-information display, press theSEL/RESET button. The screenchanges to CUSTOMIZE MENU.Press the INFO ( / ) button untilyou see the above display.
To cause Trip A and AVG. FUEL Ato reset every time you refuel yourvehicle, follow these instructions:
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select ON or OFF by pressing theINFO ( / ) button, then press theSEL/RESET button to enter yourselection.
Multi-Information Display
Trip A & Avg. Fuel Reset with Refuel
98
06/05/19 14:31:01 31STK600 0103
▲ ▼
To exit TRIP A & AVG. FUELRESET with REFUEL withoutchanging the current setting, selectEXIT by pressing the INFO ( / )button, then press the SEL/RESETbutton. The screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU. If thishappens, you need to repeat thesame procedure.
CONTINUED
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
99
06/06/16 20:24:40 31STK600 0104
▲ ▼
-
-
▲ ▼
-
While METER SETUP is shown inthe CUSTOMIZE GROUP of themulti-information display, press theSEL/RESET button. The screenchanges to CUSTOMIZE MENU.Press the INFO ( / ) button untilyou see the above display.
TRIP A The elapsed time is resetwhen the Trip A is reset.
TRIP B The elapsed time is resetwhen the Trip B is reset.
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select the desired setting bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then press the SEL/RESET buttonto enter your selection.
There are three elapsed time resetchoices you can make:
IGN RESET The elapsed time isreset when you turn the ignitionswitch to the LOCK (0) position.
Multi-Information Display
Elap. Time Reset Condition
100
06/05/19 14:31:15 31STK600 0105
▲ ▼
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU. If thishappens, you need to repeat thesame procedure.
To exit ELAP. TIME RESETCONDITION without changing thecurrent setting, select EXIT bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then press the SEL/RESET button.The display goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
101
06/06/16 20:24:46 31STK600 0106
▲ ▼
▲▼
▲ ▼▲ ▼
There are two settings in the lightingsetup:
INTERIOR LIGHTDIMMING TIMEHEADLIGHT AUTO OFF TIMER
While CUSTOMIZE GROUP isshown in the multi-informationdisplay, select LIGHTING SETUP bypressing INFO ( / ) button, thenpress the SEL/RESET button.
Each time you press the INFO ( /) button, the screen changes as
shown in the illustration. Press theINFO ( / ) button until you seethe setting you want to customize,then press the SEL/RESET buttonto enter your selection.
Multi-Information Display
Lighting Setup
102
: Press the SEL/RESETbutton or the Select/Resetknob
: Press the INFO ( / )button or rotate theSelect/Reset knob
Seepage103
Seepage105
06/06/16 19:15:05 31STK600 0107
▲ ▼
While LIGHTING SETUP is shownin the CUSTOMIZE GROUP of themulti-information display, press theSEL/RESET button. You will see theabove display.
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select how long you want the lightsto stay on before they fade out (15,30, or 60 seconds) by pressing theINFO ( / ) button, then press theSEL/RESET button to enter yourselection.
The interior lights fade out when youclose all doors. You can change thetime that the interior lights fade out.
CONTINUED
Multi-Information Display
Interior Light Dimming Time
Instruments
andC
ontrols
103
06/05/19 14:31:35 31STK600 0108
▲ ▼
To exit INTERIOR LIGHTDIMMING TIME without changingthe current setting, select EXIT bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then press the SEL/RESET button.The screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU. If thishappens, you need to repeat thesame procedure.
Multi-Information Display
104
06/06/16 20:24:52 31STK600 0109
▲ ▼ ▲ ▼
The headlights, parking lights, sidemarker lights, taillights, and licenseplate lights go off after the selectedtime when you close the driver’sdoor and take the remote with you.To change how long the lights stayon before they go off, follow theseinstructions:
While LIGHTING SETUP is shownin the CUSTOMIZE GROUP of themulti-information display, press theSEL/RESET button. The screenchanges to CUSTOMIZE MENU.Press the INFO ( / ) button untilyou see the above display.
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select how long you want the lightsto stay on before they go off (0, 15,30, or 60 seconds) by pressing theINFO ( / ) button, then press theSEL/RESET button to enter yourselection.
CONTINUED
Multi-Information Display
Headlight Auto Off Timer
Instruments
andC
ontrols
105
06/05/19 14:31:46 31STK600 0110
▲ ▼
To exit HEADLIGHT AUTO OFFTIMER without changing thecurrent setting, select EXIT bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then press the SEL/RESET button.The screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU. If thishappens, you need to repeat thesame procedure.
Multi-Information Display
106
06/06/16 20:25:30 31STK600 0111
▲ ▼
▲▼
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
CONTINUED
There are five settings to choosefrom in the door setup:
AUTO DOOR LOCKDOOR LOCK MODE
SECURITY RELOCK TIMER
KEYLESS LOCKACKNOWLEDGMENT
AUTO DOOR UNLOCK
While CUSTOMIZE GROUP isshown in the multi-informationdisplay, select DOOR SETUP bypressing INFO ( / ) button, thenpress the SEL/RESET button.
Each time you press the INFO ( /) button, the screen changes as
shown in the illustration. Press theINFO ( / ) button until you seethe setting you want to customize,then press the SEL/RESET buttonto enter your selection.
Multi-Information Display
Door Setup
Instruments
andC
ontrols
107
See page 108
See page 110
See page 112
See page 114
See page 116
: Press the SEL/RESET buttonor the Select/Reset knob
: Press the INFO( / ) button orrotate theSelect/Reset knob
06/06/16 19:15:16 31STK600 0112
-
-
-
▲ ▼
There are three settings you canchoose from:
WITH VEH SPDThe doors lock when the vehiclespeed reaches about 10 mph (about15 km/h).
OFFThe auto door lock is deactivated allthe time.
SHIFT FROM PThe doors lock whenever you movethe shift lever out of Park.
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select the desired setting bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then press the SEL/RESET buttonto enter your selection.
While DOOR SETUP is shown in theCUSTOMIZE GROUP of the multi-information display, press the SEL/RESET button. You will see theabove display.
Multi-Information Display
Auto Door Lock
108
06/05/19 14:32:10 31STK600 0113
▲ ▼
To exit AUTO DOOR LOCK withoutchanging the current setting, selectEXIT by pressing the INFO ( / )button, then press the SEL/RESETbutton. The screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU. If thishappens, you need to repeat thesame procedure.
CONTINUED
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
109
06/06/16 20:25:36 31STK600 0114
▲▼
▲ ▼
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select DRIVER DOOR or ALLDOORS by pressing the INFO ( /
) button, then press the SEL/RESET button to enter yourselection.
While DOOR SETUP is shown in theCUSTOMIZE GROUP of the multi-information display, press the SEL/RESET button. The screen changesto CUSTOMIZE MENU. Press theINFO ( / ) button until you seethe above display.
To select whether the driver’s doorunlocks or all the doors unlock whenyou unlock the doors with theremote transmitter or the key, followthese instructions.
Multi-Information Display
Door Lock Mode
110
06/06/16 19:15:22 31STK600 0115
▲ ▼
To exit DOOR LOCK MODEwithout changing the current setting,select EXIT by pressing the INFO( / ) button, and then press theSEL/RESET button. The screengoes back to CUSTOMIZE MENU.
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU. If thishappens, you need to repeat thesame procedure.
CONTINUED
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
111
06/06/16 20:25:42 31STK600 0116
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select ON or OFF by pressing theINFO ( / ) button, then press theSEL/RESET button to enter yourselection.
While DOOR SETUP is shown in theCUSTOMIZE GROUP of the multi-information display, press the SEL/RESET button. The screen changesto CUSTOMIZE MENU. Press theINFO ( / ) button until you seethe above display.
When you press the UNLOCKbutton on the remote transmitter tounlock the doors and the tailgate, theexterior lights blink twice to verifythat the doors and the tailgate areunlocked and the security system isturned off.
When you push the LOCK button onthe remote transmitter, someexterior lights flash, and a beepersounds when you push the LOCKbutton again within 5 seconds toverify that the doors and the tailgateare locked and the security systemhas set (see page ). You cancustomize the exterior lights not toflash and the beeper not to sound.
140
Multi-Information Display
Keyless Lock Acknowledgment
112
06/05/19 14:32:35 31STK600 0117
▲ ▼
CONTINUED
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU. If thishappens, you need to repeat thesame procedure.
To exit KEYLESS LOCKACKNOWLEDGMENT withoutchanging the current setting, selectEXIT by pressing the INFO ( / )button, then press the SEL/RESETbutton. The screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
113
06/06/16 20:25:49 31STK600 0118
▲ ▼▲ ▼
If you unlock the doors and thetailgate with the remote transmitter,but do not open any of the doors orthe tailgate within 30 seconds, thedoors and the tailgate automaticallyrelock and the security system sets.
You can change this relock timefrom 30 seconds to 60 or 90 seconds.
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select the relock time you want (30,60, or 90 seconds) by pressing theINFO ( / ) button, then press theSEL/RESET button to enter yourselection.
While DOOR SETUP is shown in theCUSTOMIZE GROUP of the multi-information display, press the SEL/RESET button. The screen changesto CUSTOMIZE MENU. Press theINFO ( / ) button until you seethe above display.
Multi-Information Display
Security Relock Timer
114
06/05/19 14:32:48 31STK600 0119
▲ ▼
To exit SECURITY RELOCKTIMER without changing thecurrent setting, select EXIT bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then press the SEL/RESET button.The screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU. If thishappens, you need to repeat thesame procedure.
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
115
06/06/16 20:25:55 31STK600 0120
▲ ▼
-
-
▲ ▼
-
There are three settings you canchoose from:
Press the SEL/RESET button. Thescreen changes as shown above.Select the desired setting bypressing the INFO ( / ) button,then press the SEL/RESET buttonto enter your selection.
SHIFT TO P The driver’s door orall the doors unlock when you movethe shift lever to Park.
IGN OFF The driver’s door or allthe doors unlock when you turn theignition switch to the LOCK (0)position.
While DOOR SETUP is shown in theCUSTOMIZE GROUP of the multi-information display, press the SEL/RESET button. The screen changesto CUSTOMIZE MENU. Press theINFO ( / ) button until you seethe above display.
OFF The auto door unlock isdeactivated all the time.
Multi-Information Display
Auto Door Unlock
116
06/05/19 14:33:01 31STK600 0121
▲ ▼
To exit AUTO DOOR UNLOCKwithout changing the current setting,select EXIT by pressing the INFO( / ) button, then press the SEL/RESET button. The screen goesback to CUSTOMIZE MENU.
When your choice is set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU.
If your choice is not set, you will seethe above display for several seconds,then the screen goes back toCUSTOMIZE MENU. If thishappens, you need to repeat thesame procedure.
Multi-Information Display
Instruments
andC
ontrols
117
06/06/16 20:26:00 31STK600 0122
* *
*
*
*
*
* *
*
****
To use the horn, press the center pad of the steering wheel.
Refer to the navigation system manual.
On RDX model only1 :2 :3 :4 :
On RDX with Technology Package model only
Controls Near the Steering Wheel
118
HAZARD WARNING BUTTON
CRUISE CONTROLBUTTONS
SEAT HEATER SWITCHES
VEHICLE STABILITYASSIST (VSA) OFFSWITCH
MIRROR CONTROLS
PASSENGER AIRBAGOFF INDICATOR
REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER/HEATED MIRROR BUTTON
(P.179)
(P.125/156)
(P.230)
ACCESSORY POWERSOCKET(P.164)
PADDLE SHIFTERS(P.299)
(P.241)
(P.150)
(P.237)
(P.125)
(P.34)
(P.178)
STEERING WHEELADJUSTMENT
REMOTE AUDIO CONTROLBUTTONS
(P.121/122)
(P.126)
VOICE CONTROLBUTTONS
HANDSFREELINKBUTTONS MULTI-INFORMATION
BUTTONS (P.79)
HORN
(P.119/120)
UPPER DISPLAY
NAVIGATION SYSTEM /CENTER DISPLAY
AUXILIARY INPUT JACK
(P.316)
(P.155)
(P.258)
HEADLIGHTS/TURN SIGNAL/FOG LIGHTS
WINDSHIELDWIPERS/WASHERS/REAR WINDOWWIPER/WASHER
3, 4
TM
3
3
1
3
3, 4
2
06/06/16 19:16:17 31STK600 0123
-
-
---
-
-
-
-
Push the right lever up or down toselect a position.
The wipers run at highspeed until you release the lever.
The wipers are not activated.
MISTOFFINT IntermittentLO Low speedHI High speedWindshield washers
The length of the wiperinterval is varied automaticallyaccording to the vehicle’s speed.Vary the delay by turning the INTTIME ring. If you turn it to theshortest delay, the wiper speed willincrease to low speed operationwhen the vehicle speed exceeds 12mph (20 km/h).
While the vehicle is stopped and ingear, the wipers sweep thewindshield whenever you removeyour foot from the brake pedal.
The wipers run at low speed.
The wipers run at high speed.
Pull thewiper control lever toward you,and hold it. The washers sprayuntil you release the lever. Thewipers run at low speed, thencomplete one more sweep afteryou release the lever.
1.2.3.4.5.6.
Windshield Wiper MIST
OFF
INT
LO
HI
Windshield Washers
Windshield Wipers and Washers
Instruments
andC
ontrols
119
06/05/19 14:33:23 31STK600 0124
--
-
-
ONOFFRear Window Wiper and WasherRear Window Washer
The wiper is not activated.When you turn the wiper switch toOFF while the rear window wiper isin action, it will return to its parkedposition.
Hold past ON to turn the rearwindow wiper on and to spray therear window washer. The rearwindow wiper makes one moresweep after you release the switch.
Rotate the switch clockwiseto turn the rear window wiper ON.The wiper operates intermittently.
When the wiper control leverposition is INT, the rear wiperoperates intermittently. When it isLO or HI, the rear wiper operatescontinuously.
Rotatethe switch counterclockwise fromOFF to spray the window washerwithout activating the wiper. Thewasher will operate until you releasethe switch.
The rear window washer uses thesame fluid reservoir as the wind-shield washer.
When you shift the transmission tothe reverse position with the frontwindshield wipers activated, the rearwindow wiper operates automatically.
1.2.3.4.
Rear Window Wiper and Washer OFF Rear Window Wiper and Washer
ON
Rear Window Washer
Windshield Wipers and Washers
120
06/06/16 19:16:24 31STK600 0125
- -Push down on thelever to signal a left turn and up tosignal a right turn. To signal a lanechange, push lightly on the lever,and hold it. The lever will return tocenter when you release it orcomplete a turn.
Turning the switch tothe ‘‘ ’’ position turns on theparking lights, taillights, instrumentpanel lights, side-marker lights, andrear license plate lights.
Turning the switch to the ‘‘ ’’position turns on the headlights.
When the light switch is in the‘‘ ’’ or ‘‘ ’’ position, thelights on indicator comes on as areminder. This indicator stays on ifyou leave the light switch on andturn the ignition switch to theACCESSORY (I) or the LOCK (0)position.
Turn signalOffParking and interior lightsHeadlightsHigh beamsFlash high beamsFog lights offFog lights on
If you leave the lights on with thekey removed from the ignitionswitch, you will hear a reminderbeeper when you open the driver’sdoor.
1.2.3.4.5.6.7.8.
CONTINUED
Turn Signal and Headlights
Turn Signal Headlights
Instruments
andC
ontrols
121
06/06/16 19:16:31 31STK600 0126
-This feature turns off the headlights,parking lights, taillights, side markerlights, license plate lights, andinstrument panel lights within 15seconds of removing the key fromthe ignition switch and closing thedriver’s door.
This feature activates if you leavethe headlight switch in the or
position, remove the key, thenopen and close the driver’s door.
If you remove the key from theignition switch with the headlightswitch on, but do not open the door,the lights will turn off after 10minutes.
Push the leverforward and the high beam indicatorwill come on (see page ). Pull itback to return to low beams.
To flash the high beams, pull thelever back lightly, then release it.The high beams will stay on as longas you hold the lever back.
Turn the fog lights on and off byturning the switch next to theheadlight switch.
You can use the fog lights only whenthe headlights are on low beam.They will go off when the headlightsare turned off.
70
Automatic Lighting Off FeatureHigh Beams Fog Lights
Headlights
122
06/06/16 19:16:39 31STK600 0127
The lights will turn on again whenyou unlock or open the driver’s door.If you unlock the door, but do notopen it within 15 seconds, the lightswill go off. With the driver’s dooropen, you will hear a lights onreminder beeper.
With the headlight switch off or inthe position, the high beamheadlights and the high beamindicator come on with reducedbrightness when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position and release the parkingbrake. They remain on until you turnthe ignition switch off, even if youset the parking brake.
The headlights revert to normaloperation when you turn them onwith the switch.
You can change the ‘‘HEADLIGHTAUTO OFF TIMER’’ setting on themulti-information display (see page
).105
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Daytime Running Lights
Headlights
Instruments
andC
ontrols
123
06/06/16 19:16:45 31STK600 0128
The level of brightness is shown onthe multi-information display whileyou adjust it. It goes out 5 secondsafter you finish adjusting.
The knob on the instrument panelcontrols the brightness of the instru-ment panel lights. Turn the knob toadjust the brightness.Separate adjustments can be madewhen the headlights are on and off.
To reduce glare at night, theinstrument panel illumination dimswhen you turn the light switch to the
or position.
The level of brightness is shown inthe information display while youadjust it. It goes out 5 seconds afteryou finish adjusting.
You will hear a beep when maximumor minimum brightness is reached.You will also hear a beep when themaximum level is canceled byturning the knob a click to the left.
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX model
Instrument Panel Brightness
124
INSTRUMENT PANEL BRIGHTNESSCONTROL KNOB
U.S. model is shownU.S. model is shown
06/06/16 19:16:52 31STK600 0129
The rear window defogger clears fog,frost, and thin ice from the window.Push the defogger button to turn iton and off. Pushing this button alsoturns the mirror heaters on and off.The indicator in the button comes onto show the defogger is on.
If you do not turn it off, the defoggerwill automatically shut itself off aftera certain period depending on theambient temperature. It also shutsoff when you turn off the ignitionswitch. You have to turn it on againwhen you restart the vehicle.
In cold weather, the defogger willnot automatically shut itself off. Youmust manually shut off the rearwindow defogger when it is nolonger needed.
The defogger wires on the inside ofthe rear window can be accidentallydamaged. When cleaning the glass,always wipe side-to-side.
Make sure the rear window is clearand you have good visibility beforestarting to drive.
Push the button between the centervents to turn on the hazard warninglights (four-way flashers). Thiscauses all outside turn signals andboth indicators in the instrumentpanel to flash. Use the hazardwarning lights if you need to park ina dangerous area near heavy traffic,or if your vehicle is disabled.
Rear Window Defogger Hazard Warning Button
Rear Window Defogger, Hazard Warning Button
Instruments
andC
ontrols
125
06/06/16 19:17:00 31STK600 0130
Make any steering wheel adjustmentbefore you start driving.
Push the lever under the steeringcolumn all the way down.
Move the steering wheel so itpoints toward your chest, nottoward your face. Make sure youcan see the instrument panelgauges and indicators.
The master key fits all the locks onyour vehicle. The valet key worksonly in the ignition and the doorlocks. You can keep the glove boxand console compartment lockedwhen you leave your vehicle and thevalet key at a parking facility.
Push the lever up to lock thesteering wheel in position.
Make sure you have securelylocked the steering wheel in placeby trying to move it up, down, in,and out.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Steering Wheel Adjustment, Keys and Locks
Steering Wheel Adjustment Keys
126
LEVER
VALET KEY(Light Gray)
KEYNUMBERTAG
MASTER KEYSWITH REMOTETRANSMITTER
Adjusting the steering wheelposition while driving maycause you to lose control of thevehicle and be seriously injuredin a crash.
Adjust the steering wheel onlywhen the vehicle is stopped.
06/06/16 19:17:10 31STK600 0131
You should have received a keynumber tag with your keys. You willneed this key number if you everhave to get a lost key replaced. Useonly Acura-approved key blanks.
These keys contain electroniccircuits that are activated by theimmobilizer system. They will notwork to start the engine if thecircuits are damaged.
Protect the keys from directsunlight, high temperature, andhigh humidity.
Do not drop the keys or set heavyobjects on them.
Keep the keys away from liquids.If they get wet, dry themimmediately with a soft cloth.
The valet key does not contain abattery. Do not try to take it apart.
The master key can be retracted intothe remote transmitter. When youuse the key, push the release buttonto pop the key out of the remotetransmitter. To retract the key, pushthe release button and at the sametime push the key into the remotetransmitter until it is securelylatched.
Always use the fully-extended keywhen you insert it to the ignitionswitch. If the key does not fullyextend, the immobilizer system maynot operate properly and preventsfrom starting the engine.
Retracting or extending the key mayhurt your finger. Make sure yourfingers do not touch the pivot of thekey when retracting or extending thekey.
Your vehicle has two transmitters;see page for an explanation ofthe operation.
140
Keys and Locks
Retractable Master Key
Remote Transmitter
Instruments
andC
ontrols
127
RELEASE BUTTON
Push
06/05/19 14:34:26 31STK600 0132
As required by the FCC:This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.
Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.
This device complies with IndustryCanada Standard RSS-210.Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference that may causeundesired operation of the device.
The immobilizer system protectsyour vehicle from theft. If animproperly-coded key (or otherdevice) is used, the engine will notstart.
When you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, the immobilizersystem indicator should come onbriefly, then go off. If the indicatorstarts to blink, it means the systemdoes not recognize the coding of thekey. Turn the ignition switch to theLOCK (0) position, remove the key,reinsert it, and turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position again. If you have lost your key and cannot
start the engine, contact your dealer.
Do not attempt to alter this systemor add other devices to it. Electricalproblems could result that may makeyour vehicle undrivable.
If the system repeatedly does notrecognize the coding of your key,contact your dealer.
The system may not recognize yourkey’s coding if another immobilizerkey or other metal object (i.e. keyfob) is near the ignition switch whenyou insert the key.
Immobilizer System
128
06/05/19 14:34:33 31STK600 0133
-
-
-
-The ignition switch has fourpositions: LOCK (0), ACCESSORY(I), ON (II), and START (III).
This is the normal keyposition when driving. Several of theindicators on the instrument panelcome on as a test when you turn theignition switch from theACCESSORY (I) to the ON (II)position.
Use this positiononly to start the engine. The switchreturns to the ON (II) position whenyou let go of the key.
You can insert orremove the key only in this position.To turn the key, the shift lever mustbe in Park, and you must push thekey in slightly.
If the front wheels are turned, theanti-theft lock may make it difficultto turn the key. Firmly turn thesteering wheel to the left or right asyou turn the key.
You canoperate the audio system and theaccessory power sockets in thisposition.
CONTINUED
Ignition Switch
ON (II)
START (III)
LOCK (0)
ACCESSORY (I)
Instruments
andC
ontrols
129
06/05/19 14:34:40 31STK600 0134
You will hear a reminder beeper ifyou leave the key in the LOCK (0) orthe ACCESSORY (I) position andopen the driver’s door. Remove thekey to turn off the beeper.
You will also see a ‘‘REMOVE KEY’’message on the multi-informationdisplay (see page ).
The shift lever must be in Parkbefore you can remove the key fromthe ignition switch.
85
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Ignition Switch
130
06/06/16 19:17:14 31STK600 0135
Each front door has a master doorlock switch. Either switch locks andunlocks all doors and the tailgate.Push the top of the switch to lock alldoors and the tailgate; push thebottom to unlock them.
Each door has a lock tab next to theinside door handle. When you pullbackward on the lock tab on thedriver’s door, all the doors and thetailgate lock. Push forward on thelock tab on the driver’s door unlocksonly that door. The lock tab on theeach passenger’s door locks andunlocks only that door.
When the door is unlocked, you cansee the red indicator on the lock tabnext to the inside door handle.
All doors and the tailgate can belocked from the outside by using thekey in the driver’s door lock. Tounlock only the driver’s door, insertthe key, turn the key, and release it.The remaining doors and the tailgateunlock when you turn the key asecond time within a few seconds.
You can change the ‘‘DOOR LOCKMODE’’ setting in the multi-information display (see page ).110
CONTINUED
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Door Locks
Power Door Locks
Instruments
andC
ontrols
131
To unlock
To lock
LOCK TAB
Passenger’s SideMASTER DOORLOCK SWITCH
Driver’s Side
Lock
Lock
Unlock
Unlock
06/05/19 14:34:53 31STK600 0136
When the vehicle speed reachesabout 9 mph (about 15 km/h) ormore, all the doors lockautomatically.To change the ‘‘AUTO DOORLOCK’’ setting, see page .
When you shift to P after driving, thedriver’s door unlocks.To change the ‘‘AUTO DOORUNLOCK’’ setting, see page .
With the driver’s door open and thekey in the ignition, both master doorlock switches are disabled. They arenot disabled if the driver’s door isclosed. Pushing the switch down onthe open front passenger’s door willlock all doors and the tailgate.
To lock any passenger’s door whengetting out of the vehicle, pullbackward on the lock tab and closethe door. To lock the driver’s door,remove the key from the ignitionswitch and pull backward on the locktab. Then close the door.
You can change the ‘‘AUTO DOORUNLOCK’’ setting in the multi-information display (see page ).
You can change the ‘‘AUTO DOORLOCK ’’ setting in the multi-information display (see page ).
The childproof door locks aredesigned to prevent children seatedin the rear from accidentally openingthe rear doors. Each rear door has alock lever near the edge. With thelever in the LOCK position (lever isdown), the door cannot be openedfrom the inside regardless of theposition of the lock tab. To open thedoor, push the lock tab forward anduse the outside door handle.
133
108
135
116
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Childproof Door Locks
Door Locks
Lockout Prevention
132
LEVER
Lock
06/06/16 19:17:23 31STK600 0137
CONTINUED
Your vehicle has customizablesettings for the doors and thetailgate to automatically lock andunlock. Make all settings before youstart driving.
To change the ‘‘AUTO DOORUNLOCK’’ setting, see page .
To change the ‘‘AUTO DOORLOCK’’ setting, see page .
With the auto door locking andunlocking, the tailgate also locks andunlocks.
The auto door locking feature hasthree possible settings:
The doors and the tailgate lockwhen the vehicle speed reaches 9mph (15 km/h).This is the default setting.
The auto door locking isdeactivated all the time.
The doors and the tailgate lockwhenever you move the shift leverout of the Park position.
Set the parking brake.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position.
Make sure the shift lever is inPark (P), and close the driver’sdoor.
1.
2.
3.
108
116
Locks all doors and the tailgate whenthe vehicle’s speed reaches about 9 mph(15 km/h).
On RDX model
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX model
Door Locks
To activate an auto door lock mode:Auto Door Locking/Unlocking Auto Door Locking
Instruments
andC
ontrols
133
06/05/19 14:35:15 31STK600 0138
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position.
Set the parking brake.
Release the switch, and turn theignition switch to theACCESSORY (I) position within 5seconds.
Push and hold the brake pedal,then move the shift lever out ofPark (P).
Push and hold the front of themaster door lock switch on thedriver’s door. You will hear aclicking sound, and after about 5seconds, you will hear anotherclicking sound.
Release the switch, move the shiftlever to Park (P), and turn theignition switch to theACCESSORY (I) position within 5seconds. Make sure the shift lever is in
Park (P), and open the driver’sdoor.
Push and hold the front of themaster door lock switch on thedriver’s door. You will hear aclicking sound after about 5seconds.5.
4.
6.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Door Locks
To turn the auto door lock modesoff:
134
06/05/19 14:35:24 31STK600 0139
Release the switch, and turn theignition switch to theACCESSORY (I) position within 5seconds.
Make sure the shift lever is inPark (P), and close the driver’sdoor.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position.
Push and hold the front of themaster door lock switch on thedriver’s door. You will hear aclicking sound, and after about 5seconds, you will hear anotherclicking sound.
The auto door unlocking feature hasfive possible settings:
The driver’s door unlockswhenever you turn the ignitionswitch to the ACCESSORY (I)position.
All doors and the tailgate unlockwhenever you turn the ignitionswitch to the ACCESSORY (I)position.
The auto door unlocking isdeactivated all the time.
The driver’s door unlocks whenyou move the shift lever to thePark position.This is the default setting.
All doors and the tailgate unlockwhen you move the shift lever tothe Park position.
3.
4.
1.
2.
CONTINUED
Locks all doors and the tailgate whenthe shift lever is moved out of Park (P).
On RDX model
Door Locks
Auto Door UnlockingTo activate an auto door lock mode:
Instruments
andC
ontrols
135
06/05/19 14:35:36 31STK600 0140
-
-
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position.
Set the parking brake.
Make sure the shift lever is inPark (P), and open the driver’sdoor.
Set the parking brake.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position.
Make sure the shift lever is inPark (P), and close the driver’sdoor.
Push and hold the brake pedal,then move the shift lever out ofPark (P).
Push and hold the rear of themaster door lock switch on thedriver’s door. You will hear aclicking sound. Continue to holddown the switch:
Until you hear one click (afterabout 5 seconds) to activate thedriver’s door unlock feature.
Release the switch, move the shiftlever to Park (P), and turn theignition switch to theACCESSORY (I) position within 5seconds.
Or, until you hear a second click(after about 10 seconds) toactivate the all doors andtailgate unlock feature.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
1.
2.
3.
6.
Unlocks driver’s door or all doors andthe tailgate when the ignition switch isout of the ON (II) position.
Door Locks
To activate an auto door unlockmode:
To turn the auto door unlock modesoff:
136
06/06/16 19:17:36 31STK600 0141
-
-Release the switch, and turn theignition switch to theACCESSORY (I) position within 5seconds.
Push and hold the rear of themaster door lock switch on thedriver’s door. You will hear aclicking sound, and after about 5seconds, you will hear anotherclicking sound.
Push and hold the rear of themaster door lock switch on thedriver’s door. You will hear aclicking sound. Continue to holddown the switch:
Until you hear one click (afterabout 5 seconds) to activate thedriver’s door unlock feature.
Release the switch, and turn theignition switch to theACCESSORY (I) position within 5seconds.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position.
Make sure the shift lever is inPark (P), and close the driver’sdoor.
Or, until you hear a second click(after about 10 seconds) toactivate the all doors andtailgate unlock feature.
4.
5.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Unlocks driver’s door or all doors andthe tailgate when the shift lever ismoved to Park (P).
Door Locks
To activate an auto door unlockmode:
Instruments
andC
ontrols
137
06/06/16 19:17:45 31STK600 0142
The tailgate will lock or unlock whenyou lock or unlock the driver’s doorby using the key, the lock tab on thedriver’s door, the master door lockswitch, or the remote transmitter.
To open the tailgate, press and holdthe switch, then lift up.
To close the tailgate, hold thetailgate handle, lower the tailgate,then press down on the back edge.
Keep the tailgate closed at all timeswhile driving to avoid damaging thetailgate and to prevent exhaust gasfrom getting into the interior. See
on page.58
Tailgate
Carbon Monoxide Hazard
138
SWITCH
TAILGATEHANDLE
06/05/19 14:36:04 31STK600 0143
If the power door lock system cannotunlock the tailgate, unlock itmanually.
Use a small flat-tip screwdriver toremove the cover on the back of thetailgate.
Push and hold the release lever tothe right as shown, then push thetailgate to open it.
If you need to unlock the tailgatemanually, it means there is aproblem with the tailgate. Have thevehicle checked by your dealer.
Tailgate
Unlocking the Tailgate
Instruments
andC
ontrols
139
COVER LEVER
06/05/19 14:36:11 31STK600 0144
-
- When you press the UNLOCKbutton, the ceiling lights (if the frontand rear ceiling light switches are inthe door activated position) willcome on. If you do not open any door,the lights stay on for about 30seconds, then fade out. If you relockthe doors with the remotetransmitter before 30 seconds haveelapsed, the lights go offimmediately.
You can change the ‘‘INTERIORLIGHT DIMMING TIME’’ setting inthe multi-information display (seepage ).
Press this button once tolock all doors and the tailgate. Someexterior lights will flash once. Whenyou push LOCK twice within 5seconds, you will hear a beep toverify that the security system hasset. You cannot lock the doors andthe tailgate if any door or the tailgateis not fully closed or the key is in theignition switch.
Press this button onceto unlock the driver’s door. Push ittwice to unlock the remaining doorsand the tailgate. Some exterior lightswill flash twice each time you pressthe button.
You can change the ‘‘KEYLESSLOCK ACKNOWLEDGMENT’’setting in the multi-informationdisplay (see page ).
You can change the ‘‘DOOR LOCKMODE’’ setting in the multi-information display (see page ).
103110
112
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Remote Transmitter
LOCK
UNLOCK
140
UNLOCKBUTTON LOCK
BUTTON
PANICBUTTON
06/05/19 14:36:18 31STK600 0145
-
If you unlock the doors and thetailgate with the remote transmitter,but do not open any of the doors orthe tailgate within 30 seconds, thedoors and the tailgate automaticallyrelock and the security system sets.
Protect the transmitter fromextreme temperature.
Do not immerse the transmitter inany liquid.
If you lose a transmitter, thereplacement needs to bereprogrammed by your dealer.
Avoid dropping or throwing thetransmitter.
You can change the ‘‘SECURITYRELOCK TIMER’’ setting in themulti-information display (see page
).
Press this button forabout 1 second to attract attention;the horn will sound, and the exteriorlights will flash for about 30 seconds.To cancel panic mode, press anybutton on the remote transmitter, orturn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position.
114
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Remote Transmitter
Remote Transmitter Care
PANIC
Instruments
andC
ontrols
141
06/06/16 19:17:52 31STK600 0146
If it takes several pushes on thebutton to lock or unlock the doorsand the tailgate, replace the batteryas soon as possible.Battery type: CR1616
To replace the battery:
Remove the screw at the base ofthe transmitter with a smallPhillips-head screwdriver.
Separate the keypad from thetransmitter by pushing any buttonfrom outside.
Place a cloth on the edge of thekeypad, and remove the upper halfby carefully prying on the edgewith a small flat-tip screwdriver.
1.
2.
3.
Remote Transmitter
Replacing the TransmitterBattery
142
SCREW
KEYPAD
BATTERY
06/05/19 14:36:33 31STK600 0147
-
As required by the FCC:This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.
Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.
This device complies with IndustryCanada Standard RSS-210.Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference that may causeundesired operation of the device.
Remove the old battery and notethe polarity. Make sure thepolarity of the new battery is thesame ( side facing up), theninsert it in the keypad.
Snap the two halves of the keypad,then install the parts in reverseorder.
An improperly disposed batterycan hurt the environment.Always confirm local regulationsfor battery disposal.
4.
5.
Remote Transmitter
Instruments
andC
ontrols
143
06/05/19 14:36:39 31STK600 0148
-
Moves the seatforward andbackward.
Raises or lowersthe seat.
The controls for the poweradjustable driver’s seat are on theoutside edge of the seat bottom. Youcan adjust the seat with the ignitionswitch in any position. Make all seatadjustments before you start driving.
Increases ordecreases thelumbar support.
Moves the frontof the seat up ordown.
Adjusts the seat-back angleforward orbackward.
Moves the wholeseat up andforward, or downand backward.The front of theseat also tilts upor down at thesame time.
See pages for important safetyinformation and warnings about how toproperly position the seats and seat-backs.
13 14
Seats
Driver’s Seat Adjustments
144
06/05/19 14:36:50 31STK600 0149
-
To adjust the seat forward orbackward, pull up on the bar underthe seat cushion’s front edge. Movethe seat to the desired position, andrelease the bar. Try to move the seatto make sure it is locked in position.
To change the seat-back angle, pullup on the lever on the outside of theseat bottom.
Make all seat adjustments beforeyou start driving.
Once your seat is adjusted correctly,rock it back and forth to make surethe seat is locked in position.
See pages for important safetyinformation and warnings about how toproperly position the seats and seat-backs.
13 14
Seats
Front Passenger’s SeatAdjustments
Instruments
andC
ontrols
145
BAR LEVER
06/05/19 14:36:57 31STK600 0150
See page for important safetyinformation and a warning about how toproperly position the head restraints.
15
Your vehicle is equipped with headrestraints in all seating positions tohelp protect you and yourpassengers from whiplash and otherinjuries.
They are most effective when youadjust them so the back of theoccupant’s head rests against thecenter of the restraint.
To remove a head restraint forcleaning or repair, pull it up as far asit will go. Push the release button,then pull the restraint out of the seat-back.
Make sure the removed headrestraints are securely stored.
The front and rear head restraintsadjust for height. You need bothhands to adjust the restraint. Do notattempt to adjust it while driving. Toraise it, pull upward. To lower therestraint, push the release buttonand push the restraint down.
Head Restraints
Seats
146
RELEASE BUTTON RELEASE BUTTON
Front Rear
06/05/19 14:37:04 31STK600 0151
The rear seat armrest is in thecenter of the rear seat. Pivot it downto use it.
Remove any items from the seatbefore folding down the seat-back.
Make sure there are no items on thefloor before folding down the seats.
The lid of the console compartmentcan be used as an armrest.
The rear seat-backs can be foldeddown to give more cargo room. Eachside folds down separately. So youcan still carry a passenger in the rearseat.
CONTINUED
Seats
Folding the Rear Seats DownArmrests
Instruments
andC
ontrols
147
Front Rear
06/06/16 19:18:36 31STK600 0152
Move the front seats as farforward as possible. Make surethe front seat-backs are in theupright positions.
Store the center seat belt buckleinto the pocket in the rear seat-back.
Lower the head restraints to theirlowest positions.
Pull up the release lever on theoutside of the seat-back.
Push the armrest back in place.
Lift the front edge of the rear seatcushion, then pull up on the:
Strap at the rear of the cushion(driver’s side)Rear of the seat cushion(passenger’s side)
then fold the cushion forward.
Fold the seat-back forward.
Move the front seats backward tothe desired position. Make surethe front passenger’s seat islocked in place.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Seats
148
STRAP RELEASE LEVERBUCKLE
06/05/19 14:37:21 31STK600 0153
Do not put any heavy items on theseat-back when it is folded down.
Make sure all items in the cargo areaare secured. Loose items can flyforward and cause injury if you haveto brake hard (Seeon page ).
Make sure that the folded down rearseat does not interfere with the frontpassenger’s seat-back. This willcause the front passenger’s weightsensors and the front passenger’sseat belt reminder indicator to workimproperly (see pages and ).Also check the passenger airbag offindicator to assure proper operationof the passenger’s front airbag.
To return the seat-back to theupright position, tug on the seat-backto make sure it is latched. If the seat-back is not latched fully, the seat beltwill not work properly and you willsee the red indicator behind therelease lever as shown.
To return the seat cushion to itsoriginal position, lift up the seatcushion, then place the rear of theseat cushion at the base of the seat-back. Use the seat buckles as guides.Lower the front of the seat cushionuntil it locks into place.
Make sure the seat-back and seatcushion are locked securely and allrear shoulder belts are positioned infront of the rear seat-backs.
34
287
21
Seats
Carrying Cargo
Instruments
andC
ontrols
149
RELEASELEVER
INDICATOR
06/06/16 19:18:42 31STK600 0154
In HI, the heater turns off when theseat gets warm, and turns back onafter the seat’s temperature drops.
In LO, the heater runs continuously.It does not cycle with temperaturechanges.
Follow these precautions wheneveryou use the seat heaters:
Use the HI setting only to heat theseats quickly, because it drawslarge amounts of current from thebattery.
If the engine is left idling for anextended period, do not use theseat heaters, even on the LOsetting. It can weaken the battery,causing hard starting.
Both front seats have seat heaters.The passenger seat is only heated inthe seat bottom because of the sideairbag cutoff system. The ignitionswitch must be in the ON (II)position to use seat heaters. Push thetop of the switch, HI, to rapidly heatup the seat. After the seat reaches acomfortable temperature, select LOby pushing the bottom of the switch.This will keep the seat warm.
Seat Heaters
150
SEAT HEATER SWITCHES
06/05/19 14:37:34 31STK600 0155
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position to raise or lower anywindow. To open the window, pushthe switch down and hold it. Releasethe switch when you want to stop thewindow. To close the window, pullback on the switch and hold it.
When you push the MAIN switch in,the switch is off, and the passengerwindows cannot be raised or lowered.To cancel this feature, push on theswitch again to get it to pop out.Keep the MAIN switch off when youhave children in the vehicle so theydo not injure themselves byoperating the windowsunintentionally.
The windows will operate for up to10 minutes after you turn off theignition switch. Opening either frontdoor cancels this function.
CONTINUED
Power Windows
Instruments
andC
ontrols
151
DRIVER’S WINDOWSWITCH
MAIN SWITCH
Closing a power window onsomeone’s hands or fingers cancause serious injury.
Make sure your passengers areaway from the windows beforeclosing them.
06/06/16 19:18:48 31STK600 0156
--
Auto reverse stops sensing when thewindow is almost closed. You shouldalways check that all passengers andobjects are away from the windowbefore closing it.
If either frontwindow senses any obstacle while itis closing automatically, it willreverse direction and then stop. Toclose the window, remove theobstacle, then use the window switchagain.
To open or close eitherfront window fully, push or pull thewindow switch firmly down or up tothe second detent, and release it.The window will automatically go upor down all the way. To stop thewindow, pull or push the windowswitch briefly.
To open or close either front windowpartially, push down or pull back onthe window switch lightly to the firstdetent and hold it. The window willstop when you release the switch.
Power Windows
AUTO REVERSEAUTO
152
06/06/16 19:18:53 31STK600 0157
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position before operating themoonroof switch on the ceilingconsole.
To open the moonroof fully, pullback the moonroof switch firmly.The moonroof opens all the way. Tostop the moonroof from openingfully, briefly move the switch ineither direction.
To tilt the moonroof, push the centerof the moonroof switch straight up.To stop the moonroof from tiltingfully open, push the moonroof switchforward.
To open or close the moonroofpartially, pull or push the moonroofswitch lightly to the first detent, andhold it. The moonroof will stop whenyou release the switch.
To close the moonroof fully, pushthe moonroof switch forward to thesecond detent, then release it. Themoonroof closes all the way. To stopthe moonroof from closing all theway, briefly move the switch ineither direction.
CONTINUED
Moonroof
Instruments
andC
ontrols
153
MOONROOF SWITCH
Tilt
Open
Close
06/05/19 14:37:54 31STK600 0158
The moonroof has a key-off delay.You can open and close themoonroof for up to 10 minutes afteryou turn off the ignition switch. Thekey-off delay cancels as soon as youopen either front door. You mustthen turn the ignition switch to theON (II) position for the moonroof tooperate.
If the moonroof runs into anyobstacle while it is closingautomatically, it will reversedirection, and then stop. To close themoonroof, remove the obstacle, thenuse the moonroof switch again.
Auto reverse stops sensing when themoonroof is almost closed. Youshould always check that allpassengers and objects are awayfrom the moonroof before closing it.
Auto Reverse
Moonroof
154
Opening or closing themoonroof on someone’s handsor fingers can cause seriousinjury.
Make sure all hands and fingersare clear of the moonroofbefore opening or closing it.
If you try to open the moonroof inbelow-f reezing temperatures, or whenit is covered with snow or ice, you candamage the moonroof panel or motor.
06/05/19 14:38:00 31STK600 0159
Keep the inside and outside mirrorsclean and adjusted for best visibility.Be sure to adjust the mirrors beforeyou start driving.
The inside mirror has day and nightpositions. The night position reducesglare from headlights behind you.Flip the tab on the bottom edge ofthe mirror to select the day or nightposition.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position.
Move the selector switch to L(driver’s side) or R (passenger’sside).
1.
2.
CONTINUED
Mirrors
Adjusting the Power Mirrors
Instruments
andC
ontrols
155
SELECTOR SWITCH
TAB
06/05/19 14:38:07 31STK600 0160
Push the appropriate edge of theadjustment switch to move themirror right, left, up, or down.
When you finish, move theselector switch to the center (off)position. This turns theadjustment switch off to keep yoursetting.
With the selector switch in the R(right) position, the passenger’s sidemirror will pivot downward slightlywhen you shift the transmission intoreverse. This gives you a better viewof the side of the vehicle whileparallel parking. The mirror returnsto its original position when you takethe transmission out of reverse.Turn this feature off by leaving theselector switch in the left or centerposition.
The outside mirrors are heated toremove fog and frost. With theignition switch in the ON (II)position, turn on the heaters bypressing the button. The indicator inthe button comes on as a reminder.Press the button again to turn theheaters off. Pressing this button alsoturns the rear window defogger onand off.
3.
4.
Mirrors
Reverse Mirror Tilt Heated Mirrors
156
ADJUSTMENT SWITCH
06/05/19 14:38:14 31STK600 0161
To apply the parking brake, push thepedal down with your foot. Torelease it, push on the pedal again.The parking brake indicator on theinstrument panel should go out whenthe parking brake is fully released(see page ).
You will also see a ‘‘RELEASEPARKING BRAKE’’ message on themulti-information display (see page
).
68
84
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Parking Brake
Instruments
andC
ontrols
157
Push
PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
Driving the vehicle with the parkingbrake applied can damage the rearbrakes and axles. A beeper will soundif the vehicle is driven with the parkingbrake on.
06/05/19 14:38:19 31STK600 0162
Each front and rear ceiling light hasthree-position switch.
Front ceiling lights:In the ‘‘ ’’ position, both frontand rear ceiling lights are on all thetime except when the rear ceilinglight switch is in the OFF position.
In the ‘‘ ’’ position, both frontand rear ceiling lights are off all thetime.
With the front ceiling lights switch inthis position, the rear ceiling lightdoes not work, and both front andrear ceiling lights do not come onwhen you open any door.
Rear ceiling light:You can use the rear ceiling lightindependently. In the OFF position,the light does not come on even ifthe front ceiling light switch is in the‘‘ ’’ position. In the ON position,the light stays on continuouslyexcept when the front ceiling lightswitch is in the ‘‘ ’’ position.
Ceiling Lights
Interior Lights
158
Front DOOR ACTIVATED
DOOR ACTIVATED
Rear
OFF
ON
06/05/19 14:38:29 31STK600 0163
Open any door.
Remove the key from the ignitionswitch.
Unlock the doors with the key,lock tab on the driver’s door,master door lock switch, orremote transmitter.
After all doors are closed tightly, thelight(s) dims slightly, then fades outin about 30 seconds.
If you do not open any door afterunlocking the driver’s door orremoving the key from the ignitionswitch, the light(s) fade out in about30 seconds. If you leave any dooropen without the key in the ignitionswitch, the light(s) will go off after 3minutes.
You can use the front ceiling lightswhenever the lights are off.To turn the lights on or off, push itslens.
In the door activated position, bothfront and rear ceiling lights come onwhen you:
You can change the ‘‘INTERIORLIGHT DIMMING TIME’’ setting inthe multi-information display (seepage ).103
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Interior Lights
Instruments
andC
ontrols
159
LENSES
06/06/16 19:19:00 31STK600 0164
The courtesy lights in the ceilingconsole come on when the lightswitch is in the or the
position. You can adjust theirbrightness by turning the Select/Reset knob on the instrument panel.
The cargo area light has a twoposition switch. In the OFF (right)position, the light does not come on.In the ON (left) position, the lightcomes on when you open the tailgate.
Your vehicle also has a courtesy lightin the ignition switch. This lightcomes on when you;
Unlock the driver’s door.Remove the key from the ignitionswitch.
Open any door.
The courtesy light in each front doorcomes on when the door is opened,and goes out when the door is closed.
After all doors are closed tightly, thelight fades out in about 30 seconds.
You can change the ‘‘INTERIORLIGHT DIMMING TIME’’ setting inthe multi-information display (seepage ).103
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Interior Lights
Courtesy Lights Cargo Area Light
160
COURTESY LIGHTS
ON OFF
06/06/16 19:19:09 31STK600 0165
Interior Convenience Items
Instruments
andC
ontrols
161
GLOVE BOX
COAT HOOK
CENTERPOCKET
SUN VISOR/VANITYMIRROR
BEVERAGEHOLDERS
BEVERAGE HOLDERS inREAR SEAT ARMREST
CENTER CONSOLE
FRONT DOORPOCKET
ACCESSORYPOWER SOCKETS
CARGO AREA COVER
DOOR LININGPOCKETS
06/05/19 14:38:50 31STK600 0166
Open the glove box by pulling thehandle to the left. Close it with a firmpush. Lock or unlock the glove boxwith the master key.
The glove box light comes on whenthe parking lights are on.
The interior of each front door hasan extendable pocket for maps andother small, lightweight items. Forsafety, be sure both front doorpockets are closed while driving.
Glove Box Front Door Pockets
Interior Convenience Items
162
Lock
FRONT DOOR POCKETAn open glove box can causeserious injury to your passengerin a crash, even if thepassenger is wearing the seatbelt.
Always keep the glove boxclosed while driving.
06/05/19 14:38:57 31STK600 0167
Be careful when you are using thebeverage holders. A spilled liquidthat is very hot can scald you or yourpassengers. Spilled liquids candamage the upholstery, carpeting,and electrical components in theinterior.
To use the front beverage holder,push on the lid. It will swing open. Toclose the lid, push it down until itlatches.
The rear seat also has a beverageholder in the center armrest. To useit, pivot the armrest down.
Interior Convenience Items
Beverage Holders
Instruments
andC
ontrols
163
Push
06/05/19 14:39:03 31STK600 0168
None of the sockets will power anautomotive type cigarette lighterelement. When both sockets arebeing used, the combined powerrating of the accessories should be120 watts or less (10 amps).
To use the sun visor, pull it down.You can also use the sun visor at theside window. Remove the supportrod from the clip and swing the sunvisor toward the side window.
Make sure you put the sun visorback in place when you are gettinginto or out of the vehicle.
To use the accessory power socket,pull up the cover. The ignition switchmust be in the ACCESSORY (I) orON (II) position.
These sockets are intended to supplypower for 12 volt DC accessoriesthat are rated 120 watts or less (10amps).
Interior Convenience Items
Accessory Power Sockets Sun Visor
164
COVER
Console Compartment
COVER
Front
06/05/19 14:39:11 31STK600 0169
CONTINUED
To use a vanity mirror on the back ofthe sun visor, pull up the cover.
Your vehicle has a multi-functionconsole compartment. It includes anarmrest, a coin holder, a pen holder,a card holder and a consolecompartment with two separatableshelves.
To open the console compartment,push the button and lift the lid.To close, lower the lid, and push itdown until it latches.
You can lock or unlock the consolecompartment lid with the master key.
The light comes on when you pull upthe cover.
Interior Convenience Items
Vanity Mirror Console Compartment
Instruments
andC
ontrols
165
VANITY MIRROR
MASTER KEY
LID
Push
BUTTON
Close
06/06/16 19:19:17 31STK600 0170
You can use the inside of the lid for apen holder, a coin holder and a cardholder.
The console compartment has twoshelves to divide it into two levels.To store small items, you can use theupper half of the space by puttingthe shelves down until they latch.The front and rear shelves can beused separately.
When you store a large item like abriefcase, lift the shelves up tocreate a large space.
The console compartment lightcomes on when the parking lightsare on.
The items on each shelves shouldnot exceed 11 lbs (5 kg). Heavyitems may damage the shelves.
The maximum dimensions of theitem you can store in the consolecompartment are:Length: 16.9 in (430 mm)Height: 12.2 in (310 mm)Width: 5.5 in (140 mm)
Interior Convenience Items
166
LID
CARD HOLDER
PEN HOLDER
COINHOLDER
SHELVES
06/05/19 14:39:27 31STK600 0171
Your vehicle has a cargo area coverto conceal your luggage and protectthem from direct sunlight.
To remove it: Place the cargo area cover on thecargo area floor.
Make sure the cargo area cover issecurely placed so it will not movewhile you are driving.
Do not put any items on top of thecargo area cover. They can blockyour view and be thrown around thevehicle during a crash.
The cargo area cover may beremoved to give you more cargospace.
Lift and pull the rear edge of thecargo area cover slightly to unlockit from the hanger bars, thenremove it straight out.
Reverse this procedure to install thecargo area cover.
Open the tailgate. Remove thehook from the tab on the tailgate.Make sure you use both hands toprevent the cargo area cover fromfalling accidentally.
1.
2.
3.
Interior Convenience Items
Cargo Area Cover
Instruments
andC
ontrols
167
CARGOAREACOVER
HANGER BAR
HOOK TAB
06/05/19 14:39:38 31STK600 0172
The climate control system in yourvehicle provides a comfortabledriving environment in all weatherconditions.
The standard audio system hasmany features. This sectiondescribes those features and how touse them.
Your vehicle has an anti-theft audiosystem that requires a code numberto enable it.
The security system helps to dis-courage vandalism and theft of yourvehicle.
The climate control system and theaudio system have a voice controlfeature. Refer to the navigationsystem manual for more information.
...............Climate Control System . 170..........Dual Temperature Control . 175
..............Climate Control Sensors . 177................................Audio System . 178
.Audio System (On RDX model) . 180.....To Play the AM/FM Radio . 180.....Operating the CD Changer . 183
..................XM Satellite Radio . 193.................Adjusting the Sound . 196
......................Setting the Clock . 198Audio System (On RDX with
..........................HandsFreeLink . 257.Rear View Camera and Monitor . 275
TM
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Features
Features
169
06/05/19 14:39:46 31STK600 0174
Climate Control System
170
RDX model
OFF BUTTON
U.S. model is shown.
MODE INDICATOR
DUAL BUTTON FAN CONTROL BUTTONS
AIR CONDITIONING (A/C) BUTTON
DRIVER’S SIDETEMPERATURECONTROL BUTTONS
AUTO BUTTON
RECIRCULATION BUTTON
MODE BUTTON
DRIVER’S SIDETEMPERATUREDIPLAY
RDX with Technology Package model
WINDSHIELDDEFROSTER BUTTON
MODE INDICATOR
DRIVER’S SIDETEMPERATURE DISPLAY
PASSENGER’S SIDETEMPERATURE DISPLAY
PASSENGER’S SIDETEMPERATURECONTROL BUTTONS
PASSENGER’S SIDETEMPERATURE DISPLAY
REAR WINDOW DEFOGGER/HEATED MIRROR BUTTON
06/06/16 19:19:23 31STK600 0175
▲ ▼Proper use of the climate controlsystem can make the interior dryand comfortable, and keep thewindows clear for best visibility.
For the climate control system toprovide heating and cooling, theengine must be running.
You can adjust the temperatures ofthe driver’s side and the passenger’sside independently (see page ).
The automatic climate controlsystem adjusts the fan speed andairflow levels to maintain the interiortemperature you select.
Set the desired temperature bypushing or of the driver’sside temperature control buttons.The selected temperature willshow in the display.
The system automatically selects theproper mix of conditioned and/orheated air that will, as quickly aspossible, raise or lower the interiortemperature to your preference.
Press the AUTO button. You willsee AUTO in the display. Theindicator in the button also comeson as a reminder.
In the AUTO mode, the vehicle’sinterior temperature isindependently regulated for thedriver and passenger. If the driver’sside of the vehicle is getting toomuch sun, the system will adjust to alower temperature.
When you push the passenger’s sidetemperature control buttons, theindicator in the DUAL button comeson and the driver’s side andpassenger’s side temperature can becontrolled independently (see page
).
The climate control system for yourvehicle can also be operated by voicecontrol. See the navigation section inyour quick start guide for anoverview of this system, and thenavigation system manual forcomplete details.
1.
2.
175175
CONTINUED
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Voice Control System
Automatic Operation
Climate Control System
Features
171
06/05/19 14:40:03 31STK600 0176
▲ ▼
▲▼
When you set the temperature to itslowest limit ( ) or its highestlimit ( ), the system runs atfull cooling or heating only. It doesnot regulate the interior temperature.
In cold weather, the fan will notcome on automatically until theheater starts to develop warm air.
Press the DUAL button to selectdual temperature control mode (seepage ). The indicator in theDUAL button comes on.
You can manually select variousfunctions of the climate controlsystem when it is in the AUTO mode.All other features remainautomatically controlled.
Making any manual selection causesthe word AUTO in the display to goout.
To adjust the desired temperature,push or of the temperaturecontrol buttons.
Select the fan speed by pressing thefan control buttons ( or
). The fan speed isrepresented by vertical bars in thedisplay.
When you press the DUAL buttonagain (indicator turns off), bothsides adjust to the driver’s sidetemperature.
Press the A/C button to turn the airconditioning on and off. You will seeA/C ON or A/C OFF in the display.
When you turn the A/C off, thesystem cannot regulate the insidetemperature if you set thetemperature control below theoutside temperature.
175
Climate Control System
Dual ButtonSemi-automatic Operation
Temperature Control
Fan Control Air Conditioning (A/C) Button
172
06/05/19 14:40:16 31STK600 0177
CONTINUED
When the indicator in the button ison, air from the vehicle’s interior issent throughout the system again.When the indicator is off, air isbrought in from the outside of thevehicle (fresh air mode).
The outside air intakes for theclimate control system are at thebase of the windshield. Keep thisarea clear of leaves and other debris.
The system should be left in freshair mode under almost all conditions.Keeping the system in recirculationmode, particularly with the A/C off,can cause the windows to fog up.
Switch to recirculation mode whendriving through dusty or smokyconditions, then return to fresh airmode.
This button turns the windshielddefrost on and off.
When you push this button, air flowsfrom the defroster vents at the baseof the windshield, and the systemautomatically switches to fresh airmode and turns on the A/C. Whenthe indicator in the button is on, thepassenger’s temperature cannot beset separately from the driver’s.
This button turns the rear windowdefogger on and off. Pushing thisbutton also turns the mirror heaterson and off (see page ).125
If you press the OFF button, theclimate control system shuts offcompletely.
Air flows from the centerand corner vents in the dashboard.
Airflow is divided betweenthe vents in the dashboard and thefloor vents.
Air flows from the floorvents.
Airflow is divided betweenthe floor vents and the defrostervents at the base of the windshield.
To keep stale air and mustinessfrom collecting, you should havethe fan running at all times.
Keep the system off for shortperiods only.The mode indicator in the display
changes to the current mode eachtime you press the button.
When the climate control system isturned off, the temperature in thedisplay will also turn off.
Use the MODE button to select thevents the air flows from. Some airwill flow from the dashboard cornervents in all modes.
To Turn Everything OffMode Button
Climate Control System
174
06/06/16 19:21:46 31STK600 0179
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
The driver’s side and the passenger’sside can be controlled independentlyby adjusting these buttons when theindicator in the DUAL button is lit.
To set the driver’s side temperatureto a different value than thepassenger’s, press the DUAL button,then press the temperature controlbuttons ( or ) on the driver’sside. To set the passenger’s side to adifferent value than the driver’s,press the temperature controlbuttons ( or ) on the passenger’sside. You can adjust the passenger’sside without pressing the DUALbutton first.
Your vehicle has four temperaturecontrol buttons, two for the driver,and two for the front passenger.
CONTINUED
Temperature Control Buttons
Dual Temperature Control
Features
175
RDX model
DRIVER’S SIDETEMPERATUREDIPLAY
DRIVER’S SIDETEMPERATUREDIPLAY
DUAL BUTTON
DRIVER’S SIDETEMPERATURECONTROLBUTTONS
PASSENGER’S SIDETEMPERATURE DIPLAY
PASSENGER’SSIDETEMPERATURECONTROLBUTTONS
RDX with Technology Package model
PASSENGER’SSIDETEMPERATUREDIPLAY
06/06/16 19:21:54 31STK600 0180
▲▼
When you set the temperature to itslower or upper limit, it is displayed as
or .
Push AUTO or . The selectedtemperatures appear in the display.When the indicator in the DUALbutton is off, you can adjust bothsides to the same temperature byadjusting the driver’s sidetemperature control buttons ( or
).
Dual Temperature Control
176
DRIVER’S SIDE PASSENGER’S SIDE
06/05/19 14:40:50 31STK600 0181
The climate control system has twosensors. A sunlight sensor is in thetop of the dashboard, and atemperature sensor is next to thesteering column. Do not cover thesensors or spill any liquid on them.
Sunlight Sensor/TemperatureSensor
Climate Control Sensors
Features
177
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
SUNLIGHT SENSOR
06/05/19 14:40:55 31STK600 0182
Read the appropriate pages in thissection for operation of the audiosystems installed in your vehicle.
For RDX model, see pagesthru .
For RDX with TechnologyPackage model, see page thru
.
179 198
199230
Audio System
178
RDX model
U.S. model is shown.
06/05/19 14:41:02 31STK600 0183
Audio System
Features
179
U.S. model is shown.
RDX with Technology Package model
06/06/16 19:22:01 31STK600 0184
XM satellite radio information isavailable on page .
The band and frequency that theradio was last tuned to is displayed.To change bands, press the AM orFM button. On the FM band, ‘‘ST’’will be shown on the center display ifthe station is broadcasting in stereo.Stereo reproduction on AM is notavailable.
The ignition switch must be in theACCESSORY (I) or the ON (II)position. Turn the system on bypushing the PWR/VOL knob, or theAM or FM button. Adjust the volumeby turning the PWR/VOL knob.
193
On U.S. models
On RDX model
Audio System
To Play the AM/FM Radio
180
STEREOINDICATOR
FM BUTTON
SCAN BUTTONTUNE/FOLDER BAR
AM BUTTON
SCANINDICATOR
A.SELINDICATOR
A.SEL/RDM BUTTON
VOLUMELEVEL
PWR/VOL KNOB
PRESET BARS
SEEK/SKIP BAR
U.S. model is shown.
06/06/16 19:22:08 31STK600 0185
-
-
- - -
-
CONTINUED
You can use any of five methods tofind radio stations on the selectedband: TUNE, SEEK, SCAN, thepreset bars, and AUTO SELECT.
Use the TUNE/FOLDERbar to tune the radio to a desiredfrequency. Press the side of thebar to tune to a higher frequency,and the side of the bar to tuneto a lower frequency.
The SEEK functionsearches up and down from thecurrent frequency to find a stationwith a strong signal. To activate it,press the or side of theSEEK/SKIP bar, then release it.
If you press and hold the orside of the bar, the frequency
will begin to change rapidly. It willstop when you release it.
The SCAN functionsamples all stations with strongsignals on the selected band. Toactivate it, press the SCAN button,then release it. You will see ‘‘SCAN’’on the center display. The systemwill scan for a station with a strongsignal. When it finds one, it will stopand play that station for about 10seconds.
If you do nothing, the system willthen scan for the next strong stationand play it for 10 seconds. When itplays a station you want to listen to,press the SCAN button again.
Each side of the bars (16) can store one frequency on AMand two frequencies on FM.
Select the desired band, AM orFM. FM1 and FM2 let you storetwo frequencies with each side ofthe preset bar.
Use the TUNE, SEEK, or SCANfunction to tune the radio to adesired station.
Pick the preset number (1 6), forthe station you want to store.Press the left or right side of thebar, and hold it until you hear abeep.
Repeat steps 1 through 3 to store atotal of six stations on AM andtwelve stations on FM.
1.
2.
3.
4.
To Select a Station
TUNE
SEEK
SCAN Preset
Audio System
Features
181
06/05/19 19:18:06 31STK600 0186
-
-
If you do not like the stations autoselect has stored, you can storeother frequencies on the preset bars.
, press theA. SEL/RDM button. This restoresthe presets you originally set.
For information on AM/FM radiofrequencies and reception, see page
.
For information, see page .
If you aretraveling far from home and can nolonger receive your preset stations,you can use the auto select feature tofind stations in the local area.
To activate it, press the A. SEL/RDM button. ‘‘A. SEL’’ will flash onthe center display, and the systemwill go into scan mode for severalseconds. It stores the frequencies ofsix AM and twelve FM stations inthe preset bars (1 6).
You will see ‘‘0’’ displayed if autoselect cannot find a strong station forevery preset bar.
231
196
To turn off auto select
Audio System
Radio Frequencies and Reception
Adjusting the Sound
AUTO SELECT
182
06/05/19 14:41:36 31STK600 0187
CONTINUED
On RDX model
Audio System
Operating the CD Changer
Features
183
Normal mode MP3/WMA mode
SCAN (D-SCAN) INDICATOR RPT (D-RPT)INDICATOR
WMA MODEINDICATOR
MP3 MODEINDICATOR
RDM (F-RDM)INDICATOR
RPT (F-RPT)INDICATOR
RDMINDICATOR
DISC NUMBER
DISC INDICATOR
TRACK NUMBER
FOLDER NUMBER
SCAN (F-SCAN)INDICATORVOLUME LEVEL
U.S. model is shown.
06/05/19 14:41:43 31STK600 0188
Audio System
184
LOAD BUTTON
DISC SLOT
EJECT BUTTON
DISC LOAD INDICATOR
CD/AUX BUTTON
RPT BUTTON
SCAN BUTTON
U.S. model is shown.
DISP/MODE BUTTON
TUNE/FOLDER BAR
A.SEL/RDM BUTTON
PWR/VOL KNOB
PRESET BARS
SEEK/SKIP BAR
06/06/16 19:22:14 31STK600 0189
Your audio system has an in-dashCD changer that holds up to six CDs,providing several hours ofcontinuous entertainment. Youoperate this CD changer with thesame controls used for the radio.
To load CDs or operate the CDchanger, the ignition switch must bein the ACCESSORY (I) or ON (II)position.
For best results when using CD-R orCD-RW discs, use only high qualitydiscs labeled for audio use. Whenrecording a CD-R or CD-RW, therecording must be closed in orderfor the disc to be played by CDplayer.
You cannot load and play 3-inch(8-cm) discs in this system.Video CDs and DVDs will not workin this unit.
The disc changer can play these discformats:
The disc packages or jackets shouldhave one of these marks.
The changer can also play MP3 orWMA format (see page ).CD (CD-DA)
CD-R/RW187
CONTINUED
Audio System
Features
185
Do not use CDs with adhesive labels.The label can curl up and cause the CDto jam in the unit.
06/06/16 20:22:20 31STK600 0190
To load a single disc:Press and release the LOADbutton on the changer unit. Youwill see ‘‘BUSY’’ on the centerdisplay, and the disc load indicatorturns red and starts blinking.
Insert a disc into the disc slotwhen the disc load indicator turnsgreen and ‘‘LOAD’’ appears on thecenter display at the same time.Insert the disc only about halfway;the drive will pull it in the rest ofthe way. You will see the discindicator blinking on the centerdisplay.
To load multiple discs in oneoperation:
When the disc load indicator turnsgreen and ‘‘LOAD’’ appears on thecenter display again, insert thenext CD in the slot.
Do not try to insert a disc until‘‘LOAD’’ appears. You coulddamage the audio unit.
Repeat steps 1 through 3 until allsix positions are loaded. If you arenot loading all six positions, pressthe LOAD button again after thelast CD has loaded. ‘‘DISC READ’’appears on the center display, thenthe system begins playing the lastCD loaded.
If you stop loading discs before allsix positions are filled, the systemwill wait for 10 seconds, stop the loadoperation, and begin playing the lastdisc loaded.
Press and hold the LOAD buttonon the changer unit until you heara beep. You will see ‘‘BUSY’’ onthe center display, and disc loadindicator turns red and startsblinking.
Insert the disc into the disc slotwhen the disc load indicator turnsgreen and ‘‘LOAD’’ appears on thecenter display at the same time.Insert it only halfway; the drivewill pull it in the rest of the way.You will see ‘‘BUSY’’ on the centerdisplay, and the disc load indicatorturns red again and blinks as theCD is loaded.
Do not try to insert a disc until‘‘LOAD’’ appears. You coulddamage the audio unit.
1.
2.
3.
1.
2.4.
Audio System
Loading CDs in the Changer
186
06/06/16 19:22:36 31STK600 0191
-
CONTINUED
The CD changer can play CD-Rs andCD-RWs compressed in MP3 andWMA format. When playing a disc inMP3 or WMA, you will see ‘‘MP3’’ or‘‘WMA’’ on the center display. A disccan support more than 99 folders,and each folder can hold up to 255playable files.
When there are more than 99 foldersin a disc, the center display onlyshows two digits.
If the disc has a complex structure, itwill be a while to read the disc beforethe system begins to play it.
Select the CD changer by pressingthe CD/AUX (U.S. model) or CD(Canadian model) button. You willsee ‘‘CD’’ on the center display. Thesystem will begin playing the lastselected CD in the CD changer. Youwill see the disc and track numbersdisplayed.
When the system reaches the end ofthe disc, the system will advance tothe next disc and begin to play. Toselect a different disc, press anappropriate side of the preset bar (1
6). If you select an empty positionin the CD changer, the system willtry to load the CD in the empty slot.
You will see ‘‘DISC READ’’ on thecenter display, then the systembegins to play the CD.
You can load a disc(s) in any mode(AM, FM, XM radio, or AUX) if youdo not select an empty position.
If you press the LOAD button whilea disc is playing, the system will stopplaying that disc and start theloading sequence. It will then playthe disc just loaded.
You can load a CD into an emptyposition while a CD is playing. Selectthe empty position (the discindicator is not shown on the centerdisplay) by pressing the appropriateside of the preset bars. The currentCD stops playing and starts theloading sequence. The CD justloaded will play.
3.
Audio System
Playing an MP3/WMA DiscTo Play a CD
Features
187
06/06/16 19:22:45 31STK600 0192
Each time you press the DISP/MODE (U.S. model) or DISP(Canadian model) button whileplaying a CD (CD-DA), the centerdisplay changes from album name,to track name, to artist name, andthen to normal display. If the discwas not recorded with CD-TEXT,‘‘NO INFO’’ will be shown on thecenter display.
If the title is too long, it will not showall at once. Press and hold the DISP/MODE (U.S. model) or DISP(Canadian model) button, and therest of the title will show on thecenter display.
When playing a disc compressed inMP3/WMA format, the displaychanges from folder name, to filename, to artist tag, to album tag, totrack tag, and then to normal displayeach time you press the DISP/MODE (U.S. model) or DISP(Canadian model) button. If the discwas not recorded with thisinformation, ‘‘NO INFO’’ will beshown on the center display.
You will also see the album and trackname (CD-TEXT), or the folder andfile name (MP3/WMA) under theseconditions:
Each time a new track, file, orfolder plays.
When you insert a disc, and thesystem begins to play.
Sampling frequency: 32/44.1/48 kHzBit rate: 48/64/80/96/128/160/192kbpsCompatible with variable bit rate andmulti-session.Maximum layers (including ROOT):8 layers
Name Display Function
Audio System
188
06/06/16 19:22:53 31STK600 0193
--
-
While a disc is playing you can usethe SEEK/SKIP bar to selectpassages and change tracks (files inMP3/WMA mode).
In MP3/WMA mode, use theTUNE/FOLDER bar to selectfolders in the disc, and use theSEEK/SKIP bar to change files.
Each time youpress and release the side ofthe SEEK/SKIP bar, the systemskips forward to the beginning of thenext track (file in MP3/WMA mode).Press and release the side ofthe bar to skip backward to thebeginning of the current track/file.Press it again to skip to thebeginning of the previous track/file.
Toselect a different folder, press andrelease the side of the TUNE/FOLDER bar to move to thebeginning of the next folder. Pressand release the side of the barto move to the beginning of thecurrent folder. Press it again to skipto the beginning of the previousfolder.
This feature, whenactivated, continuously replays thecurrent track (file in MP3/WMAmode). To activate it, press andrelease the RPT button. You will see‘‘RPT’’ on the center display. To turnoff this feature, press the RPTbutton for more than 2 seconds.
To move rapidly within a track/file,press and hold the or sideof the SEEK/SKIP bar.
In MP3/WMA mode
CONTINUED
To Change or Select Tracks/Files SEEK/SKIPFOLDER SELECTION
REPEAT
Audio System
Features
189
06/06/16 19:23:01 31STK600 0194
-
-
--
In MP3/WMA mode In MP3/WMA modeThis feature,
when activated, replays all the fileson the current folder in the orderthey are compressed in MP3/WMA.To activate folder repeat mode, pressthe RPT button twice. You will see‘‘F-RPT’’ on the center display. Pressand hold the RPT button for morethan 2 seconds to turn off thisfeature.
Press the RPTbutton twice to continuously replaythe current CD. In MP3/WMA mode,press the RPT button three times.You will see ‘‘D-RPT’’ on the centerdisplay. Press and hold the RPTbutton for more than 2 seconds toturn off this feature.
The scan function samplesall the tracks (files in a folder inMP3/WMA mode) of the currentdisc in the order they are recordedon the CD. To activate this feature,press and release the SCAN button.You will see ‘‘SCAN’’ and the track/file number flashing on the centerdisplay. The system will then playthe track/file for approximately 10seconds. To hear the rest of thetrack/file, press and hold the SCANbutton for more than 2 seconds. Ifyou do nothing, the system will thenplay the following tracks/files for 10seconds each. When the systemfinishes scanning all the tracks/filesin the current disc, the systemreturns to the track/file it firststarted scanning with, scan iscanceled and the system begins toplay that track/file normally.
The folder scanfunction samples the first file of eachfolder of the current disc in theorder they are compressed in MP3/WMA. To activate this feature, pressthe SCAN button twice. The first fileof each folder plays for about 10seconds. You will see ‘‘F-SCAN’’ andthe folder number flashing on thecenter display. To hear the rest ofthe file in the folder currentlyscanning, press and hold the SCANbutton for more than 2 seconds.When the system finishes scanningall the folders of the current disc, thesystem returns to the folder itstarted scanning with, folder scan iscanceled and the system begins toplay that folder normally.
Each time you press and release theRPT button, the mode changes fromrepeat to folder repeat, disc repeatthen to normal playing.
FOLDER REPEAT
DISC REPEAT
SCANFOLDER SCAN
Audio System
190
06/05/19 14:42:37 31STK600 0195
--
-
The disc scanfunction samples the first track (filein MP3/WMA mode) of each discwithin the changer in numericalorder. To activate this feature, pressthe SCAN button twice. In MP3/WMA mode, press the SCAN buttonthree times. The first track/file ofeach disc plays for about 10 seconds.You will see ‘‘D-SCAN’’ and discnumber flashing on the centerdisplay. To hear the rest of thetrack/file in the disc currentlyscanning, press and hold the SCANbutton for more than 2 seconds.When the system finishes scanningall the discs, disc scan is canceledand the system begins to play thefirst track/file of that disc normally.
Thisfeature plays the files within a folderin random order, rather than in theorder they are compressed in MP3/WMA. To activate it, press theA. SEL/RDM button once. You willsee ‘‘F-RDM’’ on the center display.The system will then select and playfiles randomly. This continues untilyou deactivate folder random play bypressing and holding the RDMbutton for more than 2 seconds.
Each time you press and release theSCAN button, the mode changesfrom scan to folder scan, disc scanthen to normal playing.
This feature plays thetracks (all files in each folder inMP3/WMA mode) within a disc inrandom order. To activate it, pressand release the A. SEL/RDM button.In MP3/WMA mode, press theA. SEL/RDM button twice to selectwithin a disc random play. You willsee ‘‘RDM’’ on the center display.Press and hold the A. SEL/RDMbutton for more than 2 seconds toreturn to normal play.
Each time you press and release theA. SEL/RDM button, the modechanges from folder random torandom, then to normal playing.
In MP3/WMA modeDISC SCANFOLDER RANDOM
RANDOM (Random within aDisc)
Audio System
Features
191
06/06/16 19:23:07 31STK600 0196
To pause a disc, press thecorresponding number of thecurrent disc on the appropriate sideof the preset bars. To play the discagain, press the preset bar again.
If you turn the system off while a CDis playing, either with the PWR/VOLknob or by turning off the ignitionswitch, the disc will stay in the drive.When you turn the system back on,the CD will begin playing where itleft off.
To take the system out of CD mode,press the AM or FM, CD/AUX, or
button. To return to CDmode, press the CD/AUX or CD(Canadian model) button. Thesystem will continue at the samepoint that it left off.
To remove the disc that is currentlyplaying, press and release the eject( ) button. You will see‘‘EJECT’’ on the center display.When you remove the disc from theslot, the system begins the loadsequence so you can load anotherdisc in that position. If you do notload another CD within 10 seconds,the system selects the previousmode [AM, FM1, FM2, or XM Radio(U.S. models)].
Press and hold the eject button untilyou hear a beep to remove all thediscs from the changer.
You can also eject discs when theignition switch is off by pressing theeject button. The disc that was lastselected is ejected first. You caneject the rest of the discs one at atime.
For information on how to handleand protect compact discs, see page
.
For information, see page .
For information, see page .
If you do not remove the CD fromthe slot, the system will reload theCD after 10 seconds and put the CDchanger in pause mode. To beginplaying the CD, press the CD/AUXor CD (Canadian model) button.
To remove a different CD from thechanger, select it with theappropriate side of the preset bar.When that CD begins playing, pressthe eject button.
234
196
233
To Pause a Disc
To Stop Playing a Disc
Removing CDs from the Changer
Protecting Discs
CD Changer Error Messages
Adjusting the Sound
Audio System
192
06/06/16 19:23:19 31STK600 0197
Your vehicle is capable of receivingXM Satellite Radio anywhere in theUnited States, except Hawaii andAlaska.XM is a registered trade mark ofXM Satellite Radio, Inc.
XM Satellite Radio receives signalsfrom two satellites to produce clear,high-quality digital reception. Itoffers many channels in severalcategories. Along with a largeselection of different types of music,XM Satellite Radio also allows you toview channel and category selectionson the center display.
CONTINUED
On U.S. RDX model onlyXM Satellite Radio
Audio System
Features
193
SCAN BUTTON
SEEK/SKIP(CATEGORY) BAR
CATEGORY NAME
XM BUTTON
CATEGORY MODEINDICATOR
CHANNEL MODEINDICATOR
CHANNEL NAME
PRESETNUMBER
XM BAND
DISP/MODE BUTTON
TUNE/FOLDER BAR
VOLUME LEVEL
PWR/VOL KNOB
PRESET BARS
06/06/16 19:23:28 31STK600 0198
-
-
-
-
To listen to the XM satellite Radio,turn the ignition switch to theACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position.Push the PWR/VOL knob to turn onthe audio system, and press the
button. Adjust the volume byturning the PWR/VOL knob. Thelast channel you listened to will showon the center display.
Each time you press andrelease the DISP/MODE button, thecenter display changes in thefollowing sequence: Channel name,category, artist name, and music title.
To switch between thecategory mode and channel mode,press and hold the DISP/MODEbutton until the mode changes. ‘‘CH(channel)’’ or ‘‘CAT (category)’’mode indicator appears on the centerdisplay.
When in the satellite radio mode,you can use any of four methods tofind channels: TUNE, SEEK/SKIP(CATEGORY), SCAN, and thepreset bars.
Press either side of the SEEK/SKIP(CATEGORY) bar ( or )to select another category.
Press the TUNE/FOLDER bar to change channelselections. Press the side of thebar to tune to higher numberedchannels, and the side of thebar to tune to lower numberedchannels. In the category mode, youcan only select channels within thatcategory.
Operating the XM Radio DISP
MODE
To Select a Channel
SEEK/SKIP (CATEGORY)
TUNE
Audio System
194
06/06/16 20:22:39 31STK600 0199
- -The scan function givesyou a sampling of all channels whilein the channel mode. In the categorymode, only the channels within thatcategory are scanned. To activatescan, press the SCAN button. Thesystem plays each channel innumerical order for a few seconds,then selects the next channel. Whenyou hear a channel you want tocontinue listening to, press thebutton again.
To store a channel:
Pick a preset number for thechannel you want to store. Pressand hold the appropriate side ofthe preset bar until you hear abeep.
Repeat steps 2 and 3 to store thefirst six channels.
Press the button again.The other XM band will be shown.Store the next six channelsrepeating steps 2 and 3.
Once a channel is stored, press andrelease the proper side of the presetbar to tune to it.
For information, see page .
For information, see page .
You can store up to 12preset channels using each side ofthe preset bar. Each side of the barstores one channel from the XM1band and one channel from the XM2band.
In category mode, only channelswithin that category can be selected.In channel mode, all channels can beselected.
Use the tune, seek, or scanfunction to tune to a desiredchannel.
Press the button. EitherXM1 or XM2 will be shown on thecenter display.
4.
3.
5.
2.
1.
196
235
SCAN
XM Satellite Radio Reception
Adjusting the Sound
Preset
Audio System
Features
195
06/06/16 21:50:57 31STK600 0200
-
- +
-
Use the TREBLE/BASS modes to adjust the tone toyour liking. You can adjust eachmode in levels between 6 and 6.
These twomodes adjust the strength of thesound coming from each speaker.BALANCE adjusts the side-to-side
strength, while FADER adjusts thefront-to-back strength. BALANCEcan be adjusted in levels between L9and R9. FADER can be adjusted inlevels between F9 and R9. WhenFADER adjustment level reaches F9,the subwoofer speaker will be turnedoff.
Each mode is shown on the centerdisplay as it changes. Turn thePWR/VOL knob to adjust the settingto your liking. When the levelreaches the center, you will see‘‘ ’’ on the center display. Thesystem will automatically return thedisplay to the selected audio modeabout 5 seconds after you stopadjusting a mode.
Press the SOUND/CLOCK buttonrepeatedly to display the BASS,TREBLE, FADER, BALANCE,SUBWOOFER and SVC (speed-sensitive volume compensation)settings.
On RDX model
Treble/Bass
Balance/Fader
Adjusting the Sound
Audio System
196
ADJUSTMENT MODE
SOUND/CLOCK BUTTON
ADJUSTMENT LEVEL
U.S. model is shown.
PWR/VOL KNOB
06/05/19 14:43:31 31STK600 0201
-
-+
-
-Use the
SUBWOOFER mode to adjust thestrength of the sound from thesubwoofer speaker. Turn the PWR/VOL knob to the desired level ( 6to 6). Even if the adjustment levelreaches 6, the subwoofer is notturned off.
You can use the instrument panelbrightness control knob to adjust theillumination of the audio system (seepage ). The audio systemilluminates when the parking lightsare on, even if the system is turnedoff.
The SVCmode controls the volume based onvehicle speed. The faster you go, thelouder the audio volume becomes.As you slow down, the audio volumedecreases.
The SVC has four modes; SVC OFF,SVC LOW, SVC MID, and SVCHIGH. The default setting is MID.Turn the PWR/VOL knob to adjustthe setting to your liking.
124
SUBWOOFER Audio System LightingSpeed-sensitive volumecompensation (SVC)
Audio System
Features
197
06/05/19 14:43:37 31STK600 0202
Change the hour by pressing the H(preset 4) side of the preset bar untilthe numbers advance to the desiredtime. Change the minute by pressingthe M (preset 5) side of the bar untilthe numbers advance to the desiredtime.
To set the time, press the SOUND/CLOCK button until you hear a beep,then release the button. Thedisplayed time begins to blink.
You can quickly set the time to thenearest hour. If the displayed time isbefore the half hour, pressing theSOUND/CLOCK button until youhear a beep, then pressing the R(preset 6) side of the preset bar setsthe clock back to the previous hour.If the displayed time is after the halfhour, the clock sets forward to thebeginning of the next hour.
When you are finished, press theSOUND/CLOCK button again to setthe time.
On RDX modelSetting the Clock
Audio System
198
SOUND/CLOCK BUTTON
CLOCK
PRESET 5 (M)
PRESET 4 (H) PRESET 6 (R)
U.S. model is shown.
06/05/19 14:43:44 31STK600 0203
This dial consists of an upper part(selector) and a lower part (dial).Turning the dial left or right to selector scroll through a list or item(s) onthe navigation display and adjust thelevel or condition. Push the selectorto the left, right, up, and down toscroll through and select a list oritem(s). The selected item will behighlighted on the display. Toconfirm the item or enter the setting,push on the center of the selector(ENTER).
Your vehicle has the interface dial onthe dashboard to operate the audiosystem and navigation system. Mostfunctions of these systems can alsobe controlled with the appropriatebuttons on the dashboard, but somefunctions can be accessed orselected with the interface dial only.
When you operate the audio systemwith the interface dial, press theAUDIO button on the control panelto show the audio control display onthe navigation display. You can scrollthe display and enter the setting withthe interface dial. You will see theindicator , , ,or on the display. Thisindicates the direction to move theinterface dial.
You can operate the audio systemwith the control buttons on the CDchanger unit without displaying theaudio control display on thenavigation display. The audio settingwill be shown on the upper display.
The audio system for your vehiclecan also be operated by voice control.See the navigation section in yourquick start guide for an overview ofthis system, and the navigationsystem manual for complete details.
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Audio System
Interface Dial
Voice Control System Features
199
ENTERSELECTOR
DIAL
06/06/16 21:51:07 31STK600 0204
On RDX with Technology Package modelTo Play the AM/FM Radio
Audio System
200
U.S. model is shown.AUDIO CONTROL DISPLAY
RADIO BAND
SCAN INDICATOR STEREOINDICATOR
A.SEL INDICATOR
PRESET NUMBER UPPER DISPLAY
06/06/16 20:22:02 31STK600 0205
CONTINUED
Audio System
Features
201
U.S. model is shown.
INTERFACE DIAL
SCAN BUTTON
AUDIO BUTTON
PRESET BUTTONS
TUNE/FOLDER BAR
AM/FM BUTTON
PWR/VOL KNOB
SEEK/SKIP BAR
06/06/16 19:23:58 31STK600 0206
-
The ignition switch must be in theACCESSORY (I) or the ON (II)position. Press the AUDIO button toview the audio control display. Turnthe system on by pressing the PWR/VOL knob or the AM/FM button(AM or FM button on Canadianmodels). Adjust the volume byturning the PWR/VOL knob.
To tune with the interface dial, pressthe AUDIO button to view the audiocontrol display, then push theselector down, and turn the dial toTUNE. Then press ENTER on theselector, and turn the dial to thedesired frequency. To exit theTUNE mode, press ENTER again.
XM satellite radio information isavailable on page .
You can use any of five methods tofind radio stations on the selectedband: TUNE, SEEK, SCAN, thepreset buttons or icons, and AUTOSELECT.
Use the TUNE/FOLDERbar to tune the radio to a desiredfrequency. Press the side of thebar to tune to a higher frequency,and the side of the bar to tuneto a lower frequency.
If you press and hold the orside of the bar, the frequency
will begin to change rapidly. It willstop when you release it.
The band and frequency the radiowas last tuned to are shown on theupper display. To change bands,press the AM/FM button (AM orFM button). You can also changebands with the interface dial. Pressthe AUDIO button to view the audiocontrol display and the band changesto FM1, FM2, or AM each time youpush the selector up. On the FMbands, ‘‘STEREO’’ will be shown onthe audio control display. ‘‘ST’’ willalso appear on the upper display ifthe station is broadcasting in stereo.Stereo reproduction on AM is notavailable.
221
On U.S. models
Audio System
To Select a Station
TUNE
202
TUNE ICON
06/06/16 19:24:07 31STK600 0207
- -The SEEK functionsearches up and down from thecurrent frequency to find a stationwith a strong signal. To activate it,press the or side of theSEEK/SKIP bar, then release it.
The SCAN functionsamples all stations with strongsignals on the selected band. Toactivate it, press the SCAN button,then release it. You will see ‘‘SCAN’’on the upper display.
To activate the scan function withthe interface dial, press the AUDIObutton to view the audio controldisplay, then push down the selectoron the interface dial, and push theselector to the right. You will see‘‘SCAN’’ on the audio control display.
The system will scan for a stationwith a strong signal. When it findsone, it will stop and play that stationfor about 10 seconds. If you donothing, the system will then scanfor the next strong station and play itfor 10 seconds. When it plays astation that you want to listen to,press the SCAN button again, orpush the interface selector to theright again.
To activate the seek function withthe interface dial, press the AUDIObutton to view the audio controldisplay, then push the selector onthe interface dial to the right or left.
CONTINUED
SEEK SCAN
Audio System
Features
203
SEEK ICONSSCAN INDICATOR
SCAN ICON
06/05/19 19:20:20 31STK600 0208
-
-
Each preset button/iconcan store one frequency on AM andtwo frequencies on FM. To view thepreset icons on the audio controldisplay, push the AUDIO button.
Select the desired band, AM orFM. FM1 and FM2 let you storetwo frequencies with each presetbutton (icon).
Use the TUNE, SEEK, or SCANfunction to tune the radio to adesired station.
Pick a preset number (1 6), youwant for that station. Press thepreset button, and hold it until youhear a beep.
To store the frequency on a preseticon, turn the interface dial toselect a desired preset icon. Theselected preset icon will behighlighted. Press and holdENTER on the selector for morethan 2 seconds to store thefrequency.
Repeat steps 1 through 3 to store atotal of six stations on AM andtwelve stations on FM.
1.
2.
3. 4.
Audio System
Preset
204
PRESET ICONS
06/05/19 14:44:27 31STK600 0209
-
To activate AUTO SELECT, pressthe AUDIO button to view the audiocontrol display. Push the interfaceselector down to scroll down thedisplay, turn the dial to A. SEL, thenpress ENTER on the interfaceselector. You will see ‘‘AUTO SEL’’flashing in the audio control display,and ‘‘A. SEL’’ on the upper display.Then, the system goes into scanmode for several seconds.
If you aretraveling far from home and can nolonger receive your preset stations,you can use the auto select feature tofind stations in the local area.
If you do not like the stations autoselect has stored, you can storeother frequencies on the presetbuttons (icons) as previouslydescribed.
To turn off auto select, pressENTER on the interface selector(press the A.SEL button) again. Thisrestores the presets you originallyset.
For information on AM/FM radiofrequencies and reception, see page
.
For information, see page .
You will see ‘‘0’’ displayed if autoselect cannot find a strong station forevery preset button.
Press the A.SEL button. You will seeAUTO SEL on the screen, and thesystem goes into scan mode forseveral seconds. The system storesthe frequencies of six AM andtwelve FM stations in the presetbuttons.
227
231
On Canadian models
Audio System
AUTO SELECTRadio Frequencies and Reception
Adjusting the Sound
Features
205
AUTO SEL INDICATOR
A.SEL ICON
06/06/16 19:24:16 31STK600 0210
On RDX with Technology Package model
Audio System
Operating the CD Changer
206
Normal mode MP3/WMA mode
SCAN INDICATOR
FOLDER NUMBER
WMA MODE INDICATOR
MP3 MODE INDICATOR
U.S. model is shown.
DISC NUMBER
TRACK NUMBERSCAN INDICATOR
06/05/19 14:44:43 31STK600 0211
CONTINUED
Audio System
Features
207
INTERFACE DIALAUDIO BUTTON
LOAD BUTTON
SCAN BUTTON DISP/MODE BUTTON
EJECT BUTTON
TUNE/FOLDER BAR
DISC/AUX BUTTON DISC LOAD INDICATOR
PRESET BUTTONS
DISC SLOT PWR/VOL KNOB
U.S. model is shown.
SEEK/SKIP BAR
06/06/16 19:25:38 31STK600 0212
Your vehicle’s audio system has anin-dash disc changer with the samecontrols used for the radio. Tooperate the disc changer, the ignitionswitch must be in the ACCESSORY(I) or the ON (II) position.
The disc changer can play these discformats:
CD (CD-DA)CD-R/RWDVD-ADTS
The disc packages or jackets shouldhave one of these marks.
DVD-A discs not meeting DVDverification standards may not beplayable.
The changer cannot play DVD-V orDVD-R/RW formats.
Some CD-DA and CD-ROM mixeddiscs are not playable.
‘‘DTS’’ and ‘‘DTS Digital Surround’’are registered trademarks of DigitalTheater Systems, Inc.
You cannot load and play 3-inch(8-cm) discs in this system.
The changer can also play MP3 orWMA format (see page ).212
Audio System
208
TM
Do not use discs with adhesive labels.The label can curl up and cause thedisc to jam in the unit.
06/06/16 21:48:08 31STK600 0213
To load multiple discs in oneoperation:
Press and hold the LOAD buttonon the changer unit until you heara beep. You will see ‘‘BUSY’’ onthe upper display, and the discload indicator turns red and startsblinking.
Insert the disc into the disc slotwhen the disc load indicator turnsgreen and ‘‘LOAD’’ appears in theupper display at the same time.Insert it only halfway; the drivewill pull it in the rest of the way.You will see ‘‘BUSY’’ on the upperdisplay, and the disc load indicatorturns red again and blinks as theCD is loaded.
When the disc load indicator turnsgreen and ‘‘LOAD’’ appears on theupper display again, insert thenext CD in the slot.
Repeat steps 1 through 3 until allsix positions are loaded. If you arenot loading all six positions, pressthe LOAD button again after thelast CD has loaded. ‘‘DISC READ’’appears on the upper display, thenthe system begins playing the lastloaded.
If you stop loading discs before allsix positions are filled, the systemwill wait for 10 seconds, stop the loadoperation, and begin playing the lastdisc loaded.
To load a single disc:Press and release the LOADbutton on the changer unit. Youwill see ‘‘BUSY’’ on the upperdisplay, and the disc load indicatorturns red and starts blinking.
Insert a disc into the disc slotwhen the disc load indicator turnsgreen, and ‘‘LOAD’’ appears onthe upper display at the same time.Insert the disc only about halfway;the drive will pull it in the rest ofthe way. You will see the discnumber blinking on the upperdisplay, and the disc load indicatorturns red again and blinks as theCD is loaded.
Do not try to insert a disc until‘‘LOAD’’ appears. You coulddamage the audio unit.
You will see ‘‘DISC READ’’ on theupper display, then the systembegins to play the CD.
Do not try to insert a disc until‘‘LOAD’’ appears. You coulddamage the audio unit.
1.
2.
3.
4.
1.
3.
2.
CONTINUED
Loading CDs in the Changer
Audio System
Features
209
06/05/19 14:45:12 31STK600 0214
You can load a CD into an emptyposition while a CD is playing. Pressthe AUDIO button to view the audiocontrol display. Select the emptyposition (‘‘No Disc’’ is shown on theaudio control display) by rotating theinterface dial. Then press ENTER onthe selector to enter your selection.The current CD stops playing andstarts the loading sequence. The CDjust loaded will play.
You can also select the emptyposition by pressing the appropriatepreset button.
You can load a disc(s) in any mode(AM, FM, XM radio, or AUX) if youdo not select an empty position.
You cannot select the empty positionif there is no disc in the changer.
Audio System
210
EMPTY POSITION
06/05/19 14:45:17 31STK600 0215
-
When playing a CD (CD-DA), theaudio control display shows discnumber, album name, track number,and elapsed time. When playing aCD without this information, thenumber of the disc and track playingand the elapsed time are shown onthe audio control display.
If you want to see the list of the discsin the CD changer, press the AUDIObutton to view the audio controldisplay. You will see the current discposition highlighted.
Select the changer by pressing theDISC/AUX button. You will see the‘‘CD’’ on the upper display. Thesystem will begin playing the lastselected CD in the CD changer.
To select a disc, press an appropriatepreset button (1 6), or select anappropriate preset icon by rotatingthe interface dial, then press ENTERon the interface selector. If youselect an empty position (‘‘No Disc’’is shown) in the CD changer, thesystem will load a CD into the emptyslot (see page ).
When the system reaches the end ofthe disc, it will advance to thebeginning of the first track/file (inMP3/WMA mode) in the next disc,then play that track/file.
209
To Play a Disc
Audio System
Features
211
CURRENT DISC EMPTY POSITION
06/06/16 19:25:59 31STK600 0216
The CD changer can also play CD-Rsand CD-RWs compressed in MP3and WMA format. When playing adisc in MP3 or WMA, you will see‘‘MP3’’ or ‘‘WMA’’ on the upperdisplay. A disc can support morethan 99 folders, and each folder canhold up to 255 playable files.
The specifications of the compatibleWMA file are:
Sampling frequency: 32/44.1/48 kHzBit rate: 48/64/80/96/128/160/192kbpsCompatible with variable bit rate andmulti-session.Maximum layers (including ROOT):8 layers
If the disc has a complex structure, itwill be a while to read the disc beforethe system begins to play it.
When there are more than 99 foldersin a disc, the upper display onlyshows two digits.
When playing a CD compressed inMP3/WMA format, the audiocontrol display shows disc number,folder name, file number, andelapsed time. When playing a CDwithout this information, the discnumber, track number, and theelapsed time are shown on the audiocontrol display.
-While a disc is playing you can usethe SEEK/SKIP bar to selectpassages and change tracks (files inMP3/WMA mode).
In MP3/WMA mode, use theTUNE/FOLDER bar to selectfolders in the disc, and use theSEEK/SKIP bar to change files.
Each time youpress and release the side ofthe SEEK/SKIP bar, the systemskips forward to the beginning of thenext track (file in MP3/WMA mode).Press and release the side ofthe bar to skip backward to thebeginning of the current track/file.Press it again to skip to thebeginning of the previous track/file.
You can also change tracks/files onthe audio control display. Press theAUDIO button to view the display,then push the selector on theinterface dial to the right to skipforward to the beginning of the nexttrack/file. Push the selector left toskip backward to the beginning ofthe current track/file. Press it againto skip to the beginning of theprevious track/file.
To move rapidly within a track/file,press and hold the or sideof the SEEK/SKIP bar.
CONTINUED
To Change or Select Tracks/Files SEEK/SKIP
Audio System
Features
213
SKIP ICON
06/05/19 19:20:33 31STK600 0218
-
To select a track, rotate the interfacedial or push up and down theselector on the interface dial. Thenpress ENTER on the selector toenter your selection.
You will see a list of the folder(s) inthe current disc. To select a folder(s), rotate the interface dial or pushup and down the selector on theinterface dial. Then press ENTER onthe selector to enter your selection.If the disc has several folders, thelist advances to the next folder.When the list of the files is displayed,select it by rotating the dial, orpushing the selector up and down.
Toselect a different folder, press andrelease the side of the TUNE/FOLDER bar to move to thebeginning of the next folder. Pressand release the side of the barto move to the beginning of thecurrent folder. Press it again to skipto the beginning of the previousfolder.
You can also select a track/file (inMP3/WMA) directly from the tracklist on the audio control display.Press the AUDIO button to view thedisplay, then rotate the interface dialto the current disc. Press ENTER onthe selector to view the track list onthe display. The current disc ishighlighted.
In MP3/WMA mode
In MP3/WMA modeFOLDER SELECTION
Audio System
Using a Track List
214
CURRENT TRACKCURRENTFOLDER(S)
06/05/19 14:45:49 31STK600 0219
- -This feature, whenactivated, continuously replays thecurrent track (file in MP3/WMAmode). To activate it, press theAUDIO button to view the display,then push down the selector on theinterface dial. Rotate the interfacedial to select track repeat. PressENTER on the selector to enter yourselection.
You will see ‘‘REPEAT’’ next to theTRACK icon on the audio controldisplay. To turn off this feature,select track repeat as previouslydescribed, then press ENTER again.
This feature,when activated, continuously replaysthe current CD. Press the AUDIObutton to view the audio controldisplay, then push down the selectoron the interface dial. Rotate theinterface dial to select the discrepeat. Press ENTER on the selectorto enter your selection. You will see‘‘REPEAT’’ next to the DISC icon onthe audio control display. To turn offthis feature, select the disc repeat,then press ENTER again.
REPEAT DISC REPEAT
Audio System
Features
215
REPEAT INDICATOR
TRACK REPEAT ICON
REPEAT INDICATOR
DISC REPEAT ICON
06/06/16 19:26:12 31STK600 0220
-
-
You will see ‘‘FOLDER REPEAT’’ onthe audio control display. To turn offthis feature, select folder repeat,then press ENTER again.
This feature,when activated, replays all the fileson the selected folder in the orderthey are compressed in MP3/WMA.To activate folder repeat, press theAUDIO button to view the display,then push down the selector on theinterface dial. Rotate the interfacedial to select folder repeat. PressENTER on the selector to enter yourselection.
The scan function samplesall the tracks/files (in MP3/WMAmode) of the current disc/folder inthe order they are recorded on theCD. To activate this feature, pressand release the SCAN button. Youwill also see ‘‘SCAN’’ and the track/file number blinking on the upperdisplay. To hear the rest of thetrack/file, press and hold the SCANbutton for more than 2 seconds. Ifyou don’t, the system advances tothe next tracks/files, plays about 10seconds of it, and continues throughthe rest of the track/file the sameway. When the system finishesscanning all the tracks/files in thecurrent disc, the system returns tothe track/file it first started scanningwith, scan is canceled, and thesystem begins to play that track/file
normally.
To activate scan feature on the audiocontrol display, press the AUDIObutton to view the display. Pushdown the selector on the interfacedial, then push the selector to theleft. You will see ‘‘SCAN’’ next to theTRACK icon on the audio controldisplay. To turn off this feature, pushthe selector to the left again within10 seconds.
In MP3/WMA modeFOLDER REPEAT
SCAN
Audio System
216
SCAN INDICATOR
TRACK SCAN ICON
FOLDER REPEAT INDICATOR
FOLDER REPEAT ICON
06/05/19 14:46:04 31STK600 0221
--In MP3/WMA mode
The folder scanfunction samples the first file of eachfolder in the current disc in the orderthey are compressed in MP3/WMA.To activate this feature, press theSCAN button twice. The first file ofeach folder plays for about 10seconds. You will see ‘‘FOLDERSCAN’’ next to disc number on theaudio control display. You will alsosee ‘‘SCAN’’ and the folder numberblinking on the upper display. Tohear the rest of the file in the foldercurrently scanning, press and holdthe SCAN button for more than 2seconds.
If you don’t, the system advances tothe next folder, plays about 10seconds of it, and continues throughthe rest of the folders the same way.When the system finishes scanningall the folders of the current disc, thesystem returns to the folder itstarted scanning with, folder scan iscanceled and the system begins toplay that folder normally.
The disc scanfunction samples the first track/file(in MP3/WMA mode) of each discwithin the changer in numericalorder. To activate this feature, pressthe SCAN button twice. In the MP3/WMA mode, press the SCAN buttonthree times. The first track/file ofeach disc plays for about 10 seconds.You will see ‘‘SCAN’’ next to theDISC icon on the audio controldisplay. You will also see ‘‘SCAN’’and the disc number blinking on theupper display. To hear the rest of thetrack/file in the disc currentlyscanning, press and hold the SCANbutton for more than 2 seconds.
CONTINUED
FOLDER SCANDISC SCAN
Audio System
Features
217
FOLDER SCAN INDICATOR
06/05/19 14:46:11 31STK600 0222
-
If you don’t, the system advances tothe next disc, plays about 10 secondsof it, and continues through the restof the discs the same way. When thesystem finishes scanning all thediscs, disc scan is canceled and thesystem begins to play the first track/file of that disc normally.
You will see ‘‘RANDOM’’ next to theTRACK/FILE icon on the audiodisplay. To turn off this feature,select random, then press ENTERagain.
Each time you press and release theSCAN button, the mode changesfrom scan to folder scan, disc scanthen to normal playing.
This feature plays thetracks (all files in each folder inMP3/WMA mode) within a disc inrandom order. To activate randomplay, press the AUDIO button toview the audio control display, thenpush down the selector on theinterface dial. Rotate the interfacedial to select random. Press ENTERon the selector to enter yourselection.
Audio System
RANDOM (Random within adisc)
218
SCAN INDICATOR RANDOM INDICATOR
TRACK RANDOM ICONDISC SCAN ICON
06/05/19 14:46:18 31STK600 0223
-In MP3/WMA mode
Thisfeature plays the files within a folderin random order, rather than in theorder they are compressed in MP3/WMA. To activate folder randomplay, press the AUDIO button toview the audio control display, thenpush down the selector on theinterface dial. Rotate the interfacedial to select the folder random.Press ENTER on the selector toenter your selection.
You will see ‘‘FOLDER RANDOM’’on the audio control display. To turnoff this feature, select the folderrandom then, press ENTER again.
You can play a DVD-A disc in the CDchanger. The disc controls are sameas previously described.
To pause a disc, press thecorresponding number of thecurrent disc on the preset buttons.To play the disc again, press thepreset button again.
You can also pause a disc on theaudio control display. Press theAUDIO button to view the display,select a corresponding number ofthe current disc on the preset iconsby rotating the interface dial, thenpress ENTER on the interfaceselector. To play the disc again,select the preset icon, then pressENTER again.
FOLDER RANDOMPlaying a DVD-A Disc
To Pause a Disc
Audio System
Features
219
FOLDER RANDOM INDICATOR
FOLDER RANDOM ICON
06/05/19 14:46:26 31STK600 0224
If you turn the system off while a CDis playing, either with the PWR/VOLknob or by turning off the ignitionswitch, the disc will stay in the drive.When you turn the system back on,the CD will begin playing where itleft off.
To take the system out of CD mode,press the AM/FM, or DISC/AUX, or
button to switch to the radio,or satellite radio (U.S. models only),or auxiliary input while a CD isplaying. When you return to CDmode by pressing the DISC/AUXbutton, play will continue at the samepoint that it left off.
To remove the disc that is currentlyplaying, press and release the eject( ) button. You will see‘‘EJECT’’ on the upper display. Whenyou remove the disc from the slot,the system begins the load sequenceso you can load another disc in thatposition. If you do not load anotherdisc within 10 seconds, the systemselects the previous mode [AM, FM1,FM2, or XM Radio (U.S. models)].
If you do not remove the disc fromthe slot, the system will reload thedisc after 10 seconds and put the CDchanger in pause mode. To beginplaying the disc, press the DISC/AUX button.
To remove a different CD from thechanger, select it with theappropriate preset button, or icon onthe audio control display. When thatdisc begins playing, press the ejectbutton.
Press and hold the eject button untilyou hear a beep to remove all thediscs from the changer.
You can also eject discs when theignition switch is off by pressing theeject button. The disc that was lastselected is ejected first. You caneject the rest of the discs one at atime.
For information on how to handleand protect compact discs, see page
.
For information, see page .
For information, see page .
233
234
227
To Stop Playing a Disc Removing CDs from the Changer
Protecting Discs
Adjusting the Sound
CD Changer Error Messages
Audio System
220
06/05/19 14:46:37 31STK600 0225
CONTINUED
On U.S. RDX with Technology Package model onlyXM Satellite Radio
Audio System
Features
221
XM BAND
CH MODE INDICATOR
CATEGORY MODE INDICATOR
PRESETNUMBER
CHANNEL NUMBER
06/05/19 14:46:44 31STK600 0226
Audio System
222
AUDIO BUTTONINTERFACE DIAL
XM BUTTON
TUNE/FOLDER BAR
PRESET BUTTONS
DISP/MODE BUTTON
PWR/VOL KNOB
SEEK/SKIP(CATEGORY) BAR
SCAN BUTTON
06/06/16 19:26:17 31STK600 0227
- -
Your vehicle is capable of receivingXM Satellite Radio anywhere in theUnited States, except Hawaii andAlaska.XM is a registered trade mark ofXM Satellite Radio, Inc.
XM Satellite Radio receives signalsfrom two satellites to produce clear,high-quality digital reception. Itoffers many channels in severalcategories. Along with a largeselection of different types of music,XM Satellite Radio also allows you toview channel and category selectionsin the upper display and the audiocontrol display.
To listen to the XM satellite Radio,turn the ignition switch to theACCESSORY (I) or ON (II) position.Push the PWR/VOL knob to turn onthe audio system, and press the
button. To view the audiocontrol display, press the AUDIObutton. Adjust the volume turningthe PWR/VOL knob. The lastchannel you listened to will show onthe upper display.
Each time you press andrelease the DISP/MODE button, theupper display changes in thefollowing sequence: Channel name,category, artist name, and music title.
To switch between thecategory mode and channel mode,press and hold the DISP/MODEbutton until the mode changes.appears ‘‘CH’’ or ‘‘CAT’’ modeindicator appears on the upperdisplay.
CONTINUED
Audio System
Operating the XM Radio
DISP MODE
Features
223
06/05/19 14:46:57 31STK600 0228
-
-
You can also change channelselections on the audio controldisplay. Press the AUDIO button toview the display, then push down theselector on the interface dial. Rotatethe interface dial to select the tune.Press ENTER on the selector toenter your selection. Rotate theinterface knob to the desiredchannel. In the category mode, youcan only select channels within thatcategory.
Press either side of the SEEK/SKIP(CATEGORY) bar ( or )to select another category.
You can also change the category onthe audio control display. Press theAUDIO button to view the display,then push the selector on theinterface dial to the right side or leftside to select another category.
When in the satellite radio mode,you can use any of four methods tofind channels: TUNE, SEEK/SKIP(CATEGORY), SCAN, and thepreset icons.
You can also switch between thecategory mode and channel mode,on the audio control display. Pressthe AUDIO button to view thedisplay, then push down the selectoron the interface dial. Rotate theinterface dial to select the mode.Press ENTER on the selector toenter your selection.
Press the TUNE/FOLDER bar to change channelselections. Press the side of thebar to tune to higher numberedchannels, and the side of thebar to tune to lower numberedchannels. In the category mode, youcan only select channels within thatcategory.
Audio System
SEEK/SKIP (CATEGORY)
To Select a Channel
TUNE
224
TUNE ICON SEEK/SKIP (CATEGORY) ICON
06/06/16 20:22:30 31STK600 0229
- -The scan function givesyou a sampling of all channels whilein the channel mode. In the categorymode, only the channels within thatcategory are scanned. To activatescan, press the SCAN button. Thesystem plays each channel innumerical order for a few seconds,then selects the next channel. Whenyou hear a channel you want tocontinue listening to, press thebutton again.
You can store up to 12preset channels using the presetbuttons/icons. Each button/iconstores one channel from the XM1band and one channel from the XM2band.
To store a channel:
You can also scan the channels onthe audio control display. Press theAUDIO button to view the display,then push down the selector on theinterface dial. Push the selector tothe right to activate scan feature. In category mode, only channels
within that category can be selected.In channel mode, all channels can beselected.
Use the tune, seek, or scanfunction to tune to a desiredchannel.
Press the button. To viewthe audio control display, press theAUDIO button. Either XM1 or XM2 will be shown on the display.
1.
2.
CONTINUED
Audio System
SCAN Preset
Features
225
SCAN ICON
SCAN INDICATOR
06/06/16 21:51:18 31STK600 0230
Pick a preset number for thechannel you want to store. Pressand hold the appropriate buttonuntil you hear a beep.
To store the channel on a preseticon, rotate the interface dial toselect a desired preset icon. Theselected preset icon will behighlighted. Press and holdENTER on the selector for morethan 2 seconds to store thechannel.
Repeat steps 2 and 3 to store thefirst six channels.
Press the button again.The other XM band will be shown.Store the next six channelsrepeating steps 2 and 3.
Once a channel is stored, press andrelease the proper preset button totune to it.
For information, see page .
For information, see page .
3.
4.
5.
227
235
Audio System
XM Satellite Radio Reception
Adjusting the Sound
226
PRESET ICONS
06/05/19 14:47:25 31STK600 0231
CONTINUED
BASS, TREBLE, BALANCE, andFADER are each adjustable. You canalso adjust the strength of the soundcoming from the center andsubwoofer speakers. In addition, youcan set the Dolby PL (Prologic) IIand Speed-sensitive volumecompensation (SVC).
To adjust each mode, press theAUDIO button to view the audiocontrol display, push the interfaceselector down, and turn the interfacedial to SOUND. Then press ENTERon the selector.
Select the mode you want to adjustby pushing the interface selector upor down, or by turning the interfacedial.
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Audio System
Adjusting the Sound
Features
227
SOUND ICON
06/05/19 14:47:31 31STK600 0232
-
- +
The current setting is also shown onthe upper display.
The system will automatically returnthe display to the selected audiomode about 5 seconds after you stopadjusting a mode.
To adjust bassand treble, select BASS or TREBLE,and press ENTER on the interfaceselector. The current setting isshown on the audio control display.Turn the interface dial to the desiredlevel ( 6 to 6), and enter yourselection by pressing ENTER.
BASS/TREBLE
Audio System
228
CURRENT SETTING
CURRENT SETTING
06/05/19 14:47:38 31STK600 0233
- -
-+
-
-
Thesemodes adjust the strength of thesound coming from each speaker.Fader adjusts the front-to-backstrength, while balance adjusts theside-to-side strength. To adjust faderand balance, select FADER orBALANCE, then press ENTER onthe interface selector. The currentsetting is shown on the audio controldisplay. Turn the interface dial to thedesired level (fader: F9 to R9,balance: L9 to R9), and enter yourselection by pressing ENTER. Toequalize the fader or balance, turnthe interface dial until the readingson the sound grid come to the centerof the adjustment bar.
Toadjust the strength of the soundfrom the center or subwooferspeaker, select it and press ENTERon the interface selector. Turn theinterface dial to the desired level (6 to 6), and enter your selection bypressing ENTER. The currentsetting is shown on the audio controldisplay. Even if the adjustment levelreaches 6, the sub woofer is notturned off.
Dolby PL(Prologic) II signal processingcreates multi-channel surroundsound from the audio signalrecorded with 2ch stereo sources.Dolby prologic II can only activatewhen listening to CD (CD-DA, MP3/WMA), XM radio, and AUX. When itactivates, ‘‘DPL II’’ is shown on theupper display.
To set this feature on or off, selectDolby PL II, and press ENTER onthe interface selector. Rotate theinterface dial to ON or OFF, andpress ENTER.
Manufactured under license fromDolby Laboratories. ‘‘Dolby’’,‘‘ProLogic’’, and the double-D symbolare trademarks of DolbyLaboratories.
CONTINUED
Audio System
FADER/BALANCE CENTER/SUBWOOFER
Dolby PL (Prologic) II
Features
229
06/05/19 14:47:44 31STK600 0234
- The SVCmode controls the volume based onvehicle speed. The faster you go, thelouder the audio volume becomes.As you slow down, the audio volumedecreases.
The SVC has four modes; OFF,LOW, MID, and HIGH. The defaultsetting is MID.
Turn the interface dial to the desiredsetting, and enter your selection bypressing ENTER. The auxiliary input jack is on the disc
changer unit. The system will acceptauxiliary input from standard audioaccessories.
Connect a compatible audio unit tothe jack, then select it by pressing:
The radio can receive the completeAM and FM bands.Those bands cover these frequen-cies:
AM band: 530 to 1,710 kHzFM band: 87.7 to 107.9 MHz
How well the radio receives stationsis dependent on many factors, suchas the distance from the station’stransmitter, nearby large objects,and atmospheric conditions.
Driving very near the transmitter ofa station that is broadcasting on afrequency close to the frequency ofthe station you are listening to canalso affect your radio’s reception.You may temporarily hear bothstations, or hear only the station youare close to.
A radio station’s signal gets weakeras you get farther away from itstransmitter. If you are listening to anAM station, you will notice the soundvolume becoming weaker, and thestation drifting in and out. If you arelistening to an FM station, you willsee the stereo indicator flickering offand on as the signal weakens.Eventually, the stereo indicator willgo off and the sound will fadecompletely as you get out of range ofthe station’s signal.
Radio stations on the AM band areassigned frequencies at least 10 kHzapart (530, 540, 550). Stations on theFM band are assigned frequencies atleast 0.2 MHz apart (87.9, 88.1, 88.3).
Stations must use these exactfrequencies. It is fairly common forstations to round off the frequency intheir advertising, so your radio coulddisplay a frequency of 100.9 eventhough the announcer may identifythe station as ‘‘FM101.’’
CONTINUED
Radio Frequencies Radio Reception
Radio Reception
Features
231
06/05/19 14:48:01 31STK600 0236
Radio signals, especially on the FMband, are deflected by large objectssuch as buildings and hills. Yourradio then receives both the directsignal from the station’s transmitter,and the deflected signal. This causesthe sound to distort or flutter. This isa main cause of poor radio receptionin city driving.
Radio reception can be affected byatmospheric conditions such asthunderstorms, high humidity, andeven sunspots. You may be able toreceive a distant radio station oneday and not receive it the next daybecause of a change in conditions.
Electrical interference from passingvehicles and stationary sources(such as garages or parkingstructures) can cause temporaryreception problems.
As required by the FCC:Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.
Radio Reception
232
06/05/19 14:48:07 31STK600 0237
When a CD is not being played, storeit in its case to protect it from dustand other contamination. To preventwarpage, keep CDs out of directsunlight and extreme heat.
To clean a CD, use a clean soft cloth.Wipe across the CD from the centerto the outside edge.
A new CD may be rough on theinner and outer edges. The smallplastic pieces causing this roughnesscan flake off and fall on the re-cording surface of the CD, causingskipping or other problems. Removethese pieces by rubbing the innerand outer edges with the side of apencil or pen.
Handle a CD by its edges; nevertouch either surface. Do not placestabilizer rings or labels on the CD.These, along with contaminationfrom fingerprints, liquids, and felt-tippens, can cause the CD to not playproperly or possibly jam in the drive.
Never try to insert foreign objects inthe disc changer.
When using CD-R/CD-RW discs,use only high quality CDs labeledfor audio use.
When recording a CD-R/CD-RW,the recording must be closed for itto be used by the system.
Play only standard round CDs.Odd-shaped CDs may jam in thedrive or cause other problems.
Handle your CDs properly toprevent damage and skipping.
Protecting CDsGeneral Information
Protecting Your Discs
Features
233
06/05/19 14:48:16 31STK600 0238
If you see an error message in thedisplay while playing a CD, find thecause in the chart to the right. If youcannot clear the error message, takethe vehicle to your dealer.
ErrorMessage
Cause Solution
FOCUS Error
Mechanical Error
High Temperature
Check Disc
Check Disc and ChangerError
Press the EJECT button, and pull out the disc.Check if it is inserted correctly in the discchanger.Make sure the disc is not scratched or damaged.Press the EJECT button, and pull out the disc.Check the disc for damage or deformation.If the disc cannot be pulled out, or the errormessage does not disappear after the disc isejected, see your dealer.Will disappear when the temperature returns tonormal.
Press the EJECT button, and pull out the disc.Check if it is playable disc in the CD changer(see page 208 ).
Press the EJECT button, and pull out the disc.Check the disc for damage or deformation.If the disc cannot be pulled out, or the errormessage does not disappear after the disc isejected, see your dealer.
CD Changer Error Messages
234
06/05/19 14:48:23 31STK600 0239
Satellite radio receives signals fromtwo satellites to produce clear, high-quality digital reception. It offersmany channels in several categories.Along with a large selection ofdifferent types of music, satelliteradio also allows you to view channeland category selections in the audiodisplay.
The XM satellites are in orbit overthe equator; therefore, objects southof the vehicle may cause satellitereception interruptions. To helpcompensate for this, ground-basedrepeaters are placed in majormetropolitan areas.
Satellite signals are more likely to beblocked by tall buildings andmountains the farther north youtravel from the equator.
CONTINUED
Satellite Radio Signals
Playing the XM Satellite Radio (U.S. Models)
Features
235
Signal may beblocked bymountains orlarge obstaclesto the south.
SATELLITE
GROUNDREPEATER
Signal is weaker inthese areas.
06/05/19 14:48:30 31STK600 0240
Depending on where you drive, youmay experience reception problems.Interference can be caused by any ofthese conditions:
Driving on the south side of aneast/west mountain road.Driving on the north side of alarge commercial truck on aneast/west road.Driving in tunnels.Driving on a road beside a verticalwall, steep cliff, or hill to the southof you.Driving on the lower level of amulti-tiered road.Driving on a single lane roadalongside dense trees taller than50 ft. (15 m) to the south of you.
If your XM Radio service has expiredor you purchased your vehicle froma previous owner, you can listen to asampling of the broadcasts availableon XM satellite radio. With theignition switch in the ACCESSORY(I) or the ON (II) position, push thePWR/VOL knob to turn on the audiosystem, and press the CD/XMbutton. A variety of music types andstyles will play.
If you decide to purchase XMsatellite radio service, contact XMRadio at , or at1-800-852-9696. You will need to givethem your radio I.D. number andyour credit card number. To get yourradio I.D. number, turn the TUNE
knob until ‘‘0’’ appears in the display.Your I.D. will appear in the display.
After you’ve registered with XMRadio, keep your audio system in thesatellite radio mode while you waitfor activation. This should take about30 minutes.
While waiting for activation, makesure your vehicle remains in an openarea with good reception. Once youraudio system is activated, ‘‘category’’or ‘‘CH’’ will appear in the display,and you’ll be able to listen to XMRadio broadcasts. XM Radio willcontinue to send an activation signalto your vehicle for at least 12 hoursfrom the activation request. If theservice has not been activated after36 hours, contact XM Radio.There may also be other geographic
situations or structures that couldaffect satellite radio reception.
As required by the FCC:Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.
www.xmradio.com
Receiving Satellite Radio Service
Playing the XM Satellite Radio (U.S. Models)
236
06/05/19 14:48:40 31STK600 0241
+
-
+-
▲ ▼
Three controls for the audio systemare mounted in the steering wheelhub. They let you control basicfunctions without removing yourhand from the steering wheel.
If you are listening to the radio, usethe CH button to change stations.Each time you press and release thetop ( ) of the button, the systemgoes to the next preset station on theband you are listening to. Press andrelease the bottom ( ) to go back tothe previous station.
To activate the seek function,press and hold the top ( ) orbottom ( ) of the CH button untilyou hear a beep. The systemsearches up or down from thecurrent frequency to find a stationwith a strong signal.
The VOL button adjusts the volumeup ( ) or down ( ). Press the topor bottom of the button, hold it untilthe desired volume is reached, thenrelease it.
The MODE button changes themode. Pressing the buttonrepeatedly selects FM1, FM2, AM,XM Satellite Radio (U.S. modelsexcept Alaskan and Hawaiianmodels), or CD (if a CD is loaded).
CONTINUED
Remote Audio Controls
Features
237
MODE BUTTON
VOL BUTTON CH BUTTON
06/05/19 14:48:47 31STK600 0242
+
-
+ -
+
-
+ -
If you are playing CD, the systemskips to the beginning of the nexttrack/file (in MP3/WMA mode)each time you press the top ( ) ofthe CH button. Press the bottom( ) to return to the beginning of thecurrent track/file. Press it again toreturn to the previous track/file.
To select a different disc/folder (inMP3/WMA mode), press and holdthe top ( ) or bottom ( ) of theCH button until you hear a beep.
If you are listening to XM SatelliteRadio, use the CH button to changechannels. Each time you press thetop ( ) of the button, the systemgoes to the next preset channel.Press the bottom ( ) to go back tothe previous preset channel.
To select a different channel of thecategory you are listening to, pressand hold the top ( ) or bottom ( )of the CH button until you hear abeep.
On U.S. models except Alaskan andHawaiian
Remote Audio Controls
238
06/05/19 14:48:52 31STK600 0243
Your vehicle’s audio system willdisable itself if it is disconnectedfrom electrical power for any reason.To make it work again, you mustenter a specific five-digit code withthe preset bars or buttons(depending on models). Becausethere are hundreds of numbercombinations possible from the fivedigits, making the system workwithout knowing the exact code isnearly impossible.
You should have received a card thatlists your audio system code numberand serial number. It is best to storethis card in a safe place at home. Inaddition, you should write the audiosystem’s serial number in this owner’smanual.
If you lose the card, you must obtainthe code number from your dealer.To do this, you will need the audiosystem’s serial number.
If your vehicle’s battery is discon-nected or goes dead, or the radiofuse is removed, the audio systemwill disable itself. If this happens,you will see ‘‘ ’’ on the centeror upper display (depending onmodels) the next time you turn onthe system. Use the preset bars orbuttons (depending on models) toenter the five-digit code. The code islocated on the radio code cardincluded in your owner’s manual kit.When it is entered correctly, theradio will start playing.
If you make a mistake entering thecode, do not start over; complete thefive-digit sequence, then enter thecorrect code. You have 10 tries toenter the correct code. If you areunsuccessful in 10 attempts, youmust then leave the system on for 1hour before trying again.
The system will retain your AM andFM presets even if power isdisconnected.
Radio Theft Protection
Features
239
06/05/19 14:48:58 31STK600 0244
The security system automaticallysets 15 seconds after you lock thedoors, hood, and the tailgate. For thesystem to activate, you must lock thedoors and the tailgate from theoutside with the key, driver’s locktab, door lock master switch, orremote transmitter. The securitysystem indicator on the instrumentpanel starts blinking immediately toshow you the system is setting itself.
The security system helps to protectyour vehicle and valuables from theft.The horn sounds and a combinationof headlights, parking lights, sidemarker lights, and taillights flashes ifsomeone attempts to break into yourvehicle or remove the radio. Thisalarm continues for 2 minutes, thenthe system resets. To reset analarming system before the 2minutes have elapsed, unlock thedriver’s door with the key or theremote transmitter.
Once the security system is set,opening any door, the tailgate, or thehood without using the key or theremote transmitter, will cause it toalarm. It also alarms if the radio isremoved from the dashboard or thewiring is cut.
Do not attempt to alter this systemor add other devices to it.
To see if the system is setafter you exit the vehicle, press theLOCK button on the remotetransmitter within 5 seconds. If thesystem is set, a beep will sound.
The security system will not set ifthe hood, tailgate, or any door is notfully closed. Before you leave thevehicle, make sure the doors,tailgate, and hood are securelyclosed.
The alarm will also be activated ifthe passenger inside the lockedvehicle turns the ignition switch on.
Security System
240
NOTE:SECURITY SYSTEM INDICATOR
06/05/19 14:49:05 31STK600 0245
Cruise control allows you to maintaina set speed above 25 mph (40 km/h)without keeping your foot on theaccelerator pedal. It should be usedfor cruising on straight, openhighways. It is not recommended forcity driving, winding roads, slipperyroads, heavy rain, or bad weather.
Accelerate to the desired cruisingspeed above 25 mph (40 km/h).
Push in the CRUISE button on thesteering wheel. The CRUISEMAIN indicator on the instrumentpanel comes on.
Press and release the SET/DECEL button on the steeringwheel. The CRUISE CONTROLindicator on the instrument panelcomes on to show the system isnow activated.
Cruise control may not hold the setspeed when you are going up anddown hills. If your vehicle speedincreases going down a hill, use thebrakes to slow down. This will cancelthe cruise control. To resume the setspeed, press the RES/ACCEL button.The CRUISE CONTROL indicatoron the instrument panel will comeback on.
When climbing a steep hill, theautomatic transmission maydownshift to hold the set speed.
1.
2.
3.Using Cruise Control
Cruise Control
Features
241
CRUISE BUTTON
CANCEL BUTTON
RES/ACCELBUTTON
SET/DECELBUTTON
Improper use of the cruisecontrol can lead to a crash.
Use the cruise control onlywhen traveling on openhighways in good weather.
06/06/16 19:27:55 31STK600 0246
You can increase the set cruisingspeed in any of these ways:
Press and hold the RES/ACCELbutton. When you reach thedesired cruising speed, release thebutton.
Push on the accelerator pedal.Accelerate to the desired cruisingspeed, then press the SET/DECEL button.
To increase your speed in verysmall amounts, tap the RES/ACCEL button. Each time you dothis, the vehicle speeds up about 1mph (1.6 km/h).
You can decrease the set cruisingspeed in any of these ways:
Press and hold the SET/DECELbutton. Release the button whenyou reach the desired speed.
To slow down in very smallamounts, tap the SET/DECELbutton. Each time you do this,your vehicle will slow down about1 mph (1.6 km/h).
Tap the brake pedal lightly withyour foot. The CRUISECONTROL indicator on theinstrument panel will go out.When the vehicle slows to thedesired speed, press the SET/DECEL button.
Even with cruise control on, you canstill use the accelerator pedal tospeed up for passing. Aftercompleting the pass, take your footoff the accelerator pedal. The vehiclewill return to the set cruising speed.
Resting your foot on the brake pedalcauses cruise control to cancel.
Cruise Control
Changing the Set Speed
242
06/06/16 19:28:04 31STK600 0247
You can cancel cruise control in anyof these ways:
Tap the brake pedal.
Push the CANCEL button on thesteering wheel.
Push the CRUISE button on thesteering wheel.
The cruise control will be canceledwhen the vehicle speed reachesabout 25 mph (40 km/h) or less.
Tapping either of the paddle shiftersshifts the gear up or down, but thecruise control will be canceled if youdownshift to first gear.
For more information on drivingwith paddle shifters, see page .
When you push the CANCEL buttonor tap the brake pedal, the systemremembers the previously set speed.To return to that speed, accelerate toabove 25 mph (40 km/h), then pressand release the RES/ACCEL button.The CRUISE CONTROL indicatorcomes on. The vehicle accelerates tothe same speed as before.
Pressing the CRUISE button turnsthe system completely off and erasesthe previous cruising speed.
299
Cruise Control
Cancelling Cruise Control Resuming the Set Speed
Features
243
CANCEL BUTTON
CRUISE BUTTON
06/06/16 19:28:13 31STK600 0248
AcuraLink enhances your ownershipexperience by providing a directcommunication link between yourvehicle and the Acura Server.Working through the XM radiosatellite, AcuraLink works inconjunction with the navigationsystem, HandsFreeLink (HFL), andaudio system in your vehicle. Itdisplays and receives several kindsof messages, including:
Operating tips and information onyour vehicle’s features.
Important recall and safetyinformation.
Maintenance information to keepyour vehicle in top condition.
Diagnostic information to provideinformation about any problemswith your vehicle.
The selector can be pushed left,right, up, down, and in. Use theselector to scroll through lists, toselect menus, and to highlight menuitems. When you make a selection,push the center of the selector(ENTER) to go to that selection.
The knob turns left and right. Use itto make selections or adjustments toa list or menu on the screen.
Most AcuraLink functions arecontrolled by the interface dial. Theinterface dial has two parts, a knoband a selector.
On U.S. RDX with Technology Packagemodel except Alaskan and Hawaiian
Interface Dial
AcuraLink
244
ENTER
SELECTOR
KNOB
06/06/16 19:28:22 31STK600 0249
Unread messages have a closedenvelope icon next to them. The icondisappears when it has already beenread.
Only diagnostic infomessages appear while driving. Theyindicate if your vehicle has aproblem that may need immediateattention (see page ).
After purchasing your vehicle,messages may not appearimmediately.Your dealer has to register thevehicle identification before you canreceive messages. This can takeseveral days to process.
If you have a new message, anenvelope icon appears in the topright corner of the navigation screen.
Press ENTER on the interfaceselector, then select New Messagefrom the navigation system mapmenu. If there is more than onenew message, you will see a list ofmessage titles.
To open a message: Scroll up or down, and select themessage you want to read bypressing ENTER on the interfaceselector.
Select Message to display theSelect a message category screen.Then, select ALL MESSAGES.
To view previously read messages,press the INFO button, then selectmessages.
251
Reading Messages
AcuraLink
Features
245
NOTE:
ENVELOPE ICON
06/05/19 14:49:48 31STK600 0250
Diagnostic info and recall/campaign messages can only bedeleted by your dealer.
To delete a single message:Press the INFO button to bring upthe Information screen.
Scroll to the Messages option,then select it by pressing ENTERon the interface selector.
Use the interface knob to scroll upor down to the message title youwant to delete, and select it bypressing ENTER on the interfaceselector.
Scroll to Delete with the interfaceknob, and select it by pressingENTER on the interface selector.
When you open a message, you canread a summary of it, and thenchoose one of several options. If anoption is not available for a message,that button will not be highlighted.
Scroll to the category with themessages you want to delete, andselect the category by pressingENTER on the interface selector.
Scroll to the Delete Messagesoption, and select it by pressingENTER on the interface selector.
Use the interface knob to scroll tothe AcuraLink/Messages button,and select it by pressing ENTERon the interface selector.
Select MORE by pushing theinterface selector to the right.
Press the SETUP button to viewthe setup screen.
The Delete All Messagescommand only works for quick tipand maintenance minder messages.Other messages must be deletedindividually.
To delete all messages:
AcuraLink
Deleting Messages Message Options
246
NOTE: NOTE:
06/05/19 14:50:00 31STK600 0251
-
-
-
-
-
-
To set your AcuraLink preferences(the types of messages you want toreceive, if any), visit the Owner Linkwebsite at www.owners.acura.com,and choose what you would like toreceive. If you do not have internetaccess, call Acura Client Services at(800) 382-2238; they can set yourmessage preferences for you.
Select this button todelete the current message.
Select this button to hear avoice read the entire message. Thisgives you more information than thescreen can display at one time. Whenyou select the Voice button, itchanges to a Stop Reading button.Select the button again to stop thevoice.
Select this button to call aphone number embedded in themessage. When you select , theHandsFreeLink (HFL) dials thenumber for you.To make a call, your Bluetoothcompatible phone must be paired toyour vehicle’s HandsFreeLink (seepage ).
Select this button to find the nearestAcura dealer using the navigationsystem.
Selectthis button to call the Acura dealeryou purchased your vehicle from.AcuraLink also directs you to thisdealer so you can schedule amaintenance appointment or receiveinformation about a message. If youvisit another dealer for service twotimes within a 14-month period,AcuraLink will reset to call thatdealer.
Select thisbutton to get more information aboutthe current diagnostic message. Touse this option, your cell phone mustbe linked to the HFL and have acompatible data service available.Access the Owner Link website tofind out which data services arecurrently compatible with AcuraLink.257
AcuraLink
Message PreferencesDelete
Voice
Call
Call
Find Nearest Acura Dealer
Call Your Acura Dealer
Diagnostic Info
Features
247
06/06/16 19:28:30 31STK600 0252
-
-
-
-
Selectthis button to begin the processrequired to connect to Acura. This isused to access the most recentdiagnostic information when aproblem occurs.
Select ON to havethe system automatically read eachmessage to you. Select OFF tomanually select the Voice buttonwhen you want a message read toyou.
To access the following functions,press the SETUP button, push theinterface dial to the right to selectMORE, then rotate the interface dialto select AcuraLink/Messages.
Select thisbutton to delete all stored messageswithin a category, except fordiagnostic info and recall campaignmessages. These messages can onlybe deleted by a certified technicianafter the recall is done or theproblem is corrected, or through abroadcast message from Acura.
Select ON if you want to be notifiedof new messages (envelope iconappears on the navigation screen).Select OFF if you do not want to benotified of new messages (envelopeicon does not appear on thenavigation screen).
For the Phone DataConnection button to be active, youneed a Bluetooth compatible andenabled cellphone paired to theHandsFreeLink (HFL), and acompatible data service (see
on page ).262
AcuraLink
AcuraLink/Message Screen
Phone-Data Connection
Auto Reading
Delete Messages
New Message Notification
PairingYour Phone
248
NOTE:
06/06/16 19:28:38 31STK600 0253
There are six message categories inAcuraLink: Quick Tips, FeatureGuides, Maintenance Minders,Recalls/Campaigns, Diagnostic Info,and Dealer Appointment Reminders.The system can store up to 256messages.
Message categories can be added,revised, or deleted throughbroadcast messages from Acura.
These messages, based on updatedvehicle information and commentsfrom other RDX owners, supplementyour Owner’s Manual and QuickStart Guide. They provide you withrelevant information for a safe andenjoyable ownership experience. Foradditional information, call AcuraClient Services directly through theHFL.
During the first 90 days ofownership, one of 16 differentmessages appears each day. Thesemessages help you to use andunderstand the technologicalfeatures of your vehicle.
AcuraLink
Feature GuideQuick TipsMessage Categories
Features
249
06/05/19 14:50:24 31STK600 0254
If your vehicle is affected by a recallor other important safetyinformation, a letter will be mailed toyou about the issue and how to fix it.If you don’t get your vehicle fixed,you will also receive a remindermessage through AcuraLink. Youcan then use the message options tocall your dealer for an appointmentor to find the nearest dealer.
You can then use the messageoptions to call your dealer for anappointment or to find the nearestdealer.
These messages provide detailedinformation about the serviceneeded for your vehicle. When amaintenance message appears onthe multi-information display, a list ofneeded maintenance items alsoappears in an AcuraLink message.These messages tell you the exactmaintenance needed, helping you toavoid unnecessary maintenancecosts.
AcuraLink
Recall/CampaignsMaintenance Minder
250
06/05/19 14:50:30 31STK600 0255
Depending on the severity of theproblem, the message will let youknow if you should see your dealerimmediately or if you can wait awhile.
When an instrument panel indicatorcomes on, AcuraLink immediatelynotifies you with the message,‘‘Check more information.’’ If you donot want the information right away,select the Check Later option. If youwant the information now, select theCheck Now option. (If the navigationscreen is not active, you must selectOK from the navigation disclaimerscreen before you can check theinformation.)
If an instrument panel indicator stayson when it should go off, or amessage appears on the multi-information display, AcuraLink canidentify the problem, send theinformation to Acura for analysis,and then provide you with the mostaccurate repair information availableall before going to a dealer. Thishelps you handle the problem as itoccurs, preventing or limiting costlyrepairs.
A diagnostic message is generated ifany of the instrument panelindicators stay on when they shouldgo off. For more information on theinstrument panel indicators, see page
.
The AcuraLink system cannotdetermine some mechanicalproblems (such as squeaks orrattles) that are not triggered by thediagnostic indicator monitors.
63 CONTINUED
AcuraLink
Diagnostic Info
Features
251
06/05/19 14:50:37 31STK600 0256
When you make an appointmentthrough the Owner’s Link OnlineScheduling Service, you can bereminded about that appointmentthrough the AcuraLink two days inadvance. If you need to reschedule,you can call your dealer directly withthe HFL.
The timing of your reminder isbased on your reminder preferenceestablished on Owner Link.
You will see information from theonboard troubleshooting database.
You can then use message options tocall your dealer for an appointment,find the nearest dealer, or find outmore information about the issue.
When you select the Diagnostic Infooption, if the HFL is connected to acellular data service, AcuraLinkgathers more information about theproblem, and sends it to Acura.There, the information is analyzedand returned to the vehicle with themost accurate repair information.
AcuraLink
Dealer Appointment Reminder
252
06/05/19 14:50:45 31STK600 0257
-
To do this, press and hold the twooutside buttons on the HomeLinktransceiver for about 20 seconds,until the red indicator flashes.Release the buttons, then proceed tostep 1.
If you justreceived your vehicle and have nottrained any of the buttons inHomeLink before, you should eraseany previously learned codes beforetraining the first button.
If you are training the second orthird buttons, go directly to step 1.
Unplug the garage door openermotor from the electrical outlet.
Hold the end of the garage dooropener remote 2 to 5 inches fromHomeLink. Make sure you are notblocking your view of the redindicator in HomeLink.
The HomeLink universaltransceiver built into your vehiclecan be programmed to operate up tothree remotely controlled devicesaround your home, such as garagedoors, lighting, or home securitysystems.
If you are training HomeLink tooperate a garage door or gate, youshould unplug the motor for thatdevice during training. Repeatedlypressing the remote control buttoncould burn out the motor.
HomeLink stores the code in apermanent memory. There shouldbe no need to retrain HomeLink ifyour vehicle’s battery goes dead or isdisconnected. If your garage dooropener was manufactured beforeApril 1982, you may not be able toprogram HomeLink to operate it.They do not have the safety featurethat causes the motor to stop and
reverse if an obstacle is detectedduring closing, increasing the risk ofinjury.
Always refer to the openinginstructions and safety informationthat came with your garage dooropener or other equipment youintend to operate with HomeLink. Ifyou do not have this information,contact the manufacturer of theequipment.
For quick and accurate training,make sure the remote transmitterfor the device (garage door,automatic gate, security system, etc.)has a fresh battery.
1.
2.
CONTINUED
Training HomeLink
General Information
Important Safety Precautions
Before you begin
HomeLink Universal Transceiver
Features
253
06/05/19 14:50:56 31STK600 0258
Plug in the garage door openermotor, then test the HomeLinkbutton by pushing it for about 1
second.If the button works,programming is complete.If the button does not work goto step 6.
Press and hold the remotetransmitter button and one of theHomeLink buttons at the sametime.
If the red indicator in HomeLinkbegins to flash slowly at first,then rapidly, release bothbuttons, and go to step 5.
If the red indicator in HomeLinkcontinues to flash slowly (doesnot flash rapidly), your remotetransmitter may stoptransmitting after a short time.Go to step 4.
Press and hold the remotetransmitter button and one of theHomeLink buttons at the sametime. While continuing to hold theHomeLink button, press andrelease the remote transmitterbutton every 2 seconds.
If the red indicator in HomeLinkbegins to flash slowly at first,then rapidly, release bothbuttons, and go to step 5.If the red indicator in HomeLinkcontinues to flash slowly (doesnot begin to flash rapidly),repeat steps 2 thru 4.
Repeat these steps to train theother two HomeLink buttons tooperate any other compatibleremotely controlled devicesaround your home (lighting,automatic gate, security system,etc.).
If the indicator flashes rapidlyfor 2 seconds then stays on, youhave a rolling code transmitter:go to ‘‘Training with a RollingCode System’’ (see page ).
If the indicator stays on orflashes slowly, repeat steps 2thru 5.
Push and hold the HomeLinkbutton for a few seconds, thenwatch the red indicator onHomeLink.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
255
HomeLink Universal Transceiver
254
06/05/19 14:51:06 31STK600 0259
For security purposes, newer garagedoor opening systems use a ‘‘rolling’’or variable code. Information fromthe remote control and the garagedoor opener are needed beforeHomeLink can operate the garagedoor opener.
Find the ‘‘training’’ button on yourgarage door opener unit. Thelocation will vary, depending onthe manufacturer.
Make sure you have properlycompleted the ‘‘TrainingHomeLink’’ procedure.
Press the HomeLink button againfor about 1 second. It shouldoperate the garage door.
The ‘‘Training HomeLink’’procedure trains HomeLink to theproper garage door opener code.The following proceduresynchronizes HomeLink to thegarage door opener so it sends andreceives the correct codes.
Press the training button on thegarage door opener unit until theindicator next to the button comeson. The indicator may blink, orcome on and stay on. You thenhave approximately 30 seconds tocomplete the following steps.
Press and hold the button onHomeLink for 3 to 4 seconds.
Press and hold the HomeLinkbutton again for 3 to 4 seconds.This should turn off the trainingindicator on the garage dooropener unit. (Some systems mayrequire you to press the button upto three times.)
6.
2.
4.
5.
1.
3.
Training With a Rolling CodeSystem
HomeLink Universal Transceiver
Features
255
TRAINING BUTTON
06/05/19 14:51:15 31STK600 0260
You should erase all three codesbefore selling the vehicle.
To erase the codes stored in all threebuttons, press and hold the twooutside buttons until the redindicator begins to flash, thenrelease the buttons.
If you want to retrain a programmedbutton for a new device, you do nothave to erase all button memory.You can replace the existing memorycode using this procedure:
If a standard transmitter wasprogrammed, the indicator willstay on for about 25 seconds.
HomeLink is a registeredtrademark of Johnson Controls, Inc.
If you have problems with trainingthe HomeLink Universal Transceiver,or would like information on homeproducts that can be operated byHomeLink, call (800) 355-3515. Onthe Internet, go towww.homelink.com.
Once the HomeLink indicatorbegins to flash slowly, continue tohold the HomeLink button, andfollow steps 3 thru 6 under‘‘Training HomeLink’’ (see page
).
If a rolling code transmitter waspreviously programmed, theindicator will flash rapidly for 2seconds, and then stay on forabout 23 seconds.
Press and hold the HomeLinkbutton to be trained until theHomeLink indicator begins toflash slowly.
1.
2.
253
As required by the FCC:This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.
Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.
This device complies with IndustryCanada Standard RSS-210.Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference that may causeundesired operation of the device.
Erasing Codes
Retraining a ButtonCustomer Assistance
HomeLink Universal Transceiver
256
06/05/19 14:51:26 31STK600 0261
Bluetooth is a registered trademarkof Bluetooth SIG, Inc.Bluetooth is the wireless technologythat links your phone to the HFL.The HFL uses a Class 2 Bluetooth,which means the maximum rangebetween your phone and vehicle is30 feet (10 meters).
To use the HFL, your phone musthave approved Bluetooth capabilityalong with the Hands Free Profile.This type of phone is availablethrough many phone makers andcellular carriers. You can also find anapproved phone by visiting
In Canada, visit
With a linked phone, the HFL allowsyou to send and receive calls in yourvehicle without holding the phone.
The HFL can store up to 50 namesand phone numbers in its phonebook.With a linked phone, you can thenautomatically dial any name ornumber in the phonebook.
Here are the main components ofthe HFL system:
The HFL microphone is on theceiling console. The microphone isshared with the navigation system.
Your vehicle is equipped with theHandsFreeLink (HFL). HFL usesBluetooth technology as a wirelesslink between it and your Bluetoothcompatible cellphone. When you arein your vehicle and your phone islinked to the HFL, you’ll enjoyhands-free phone use. The HFL isavailable in both English and French(Canadian models only). To changethe language, see page .
Here are the main features of theHFL. Instructions for using the HFLbegin on page .
HFL recognizes simple voicecommands, such as phone numbersand names. It uses these commandsto automatically dial, receive, andstore numbers. For moreinformation on voice control, seeUsing Voice Control on page .
273
258
260
www.acura.com. (www.acura.ca.) or by calling the HandsFree Link customer support at(888) 528-7876.
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Bluetooth Wireless Technology Incoming/Outgoing Calls
Phonebook
Microphone
Voice Control
HandsFreeLink
Features
257
TM
06/06/16 19:28:50 31STK600 0262
Here is the function of each HFLbutton:
HFL Talk: This button is used beforeyou give a command, to answerincoming calls, and to confirmsystem information.
HFL Back: This button is used toend a call, go back to the previousvoice control command, and tocancel an operation.
To operate the HFL, use the HFLTalk and Back buttons on the leftside of the steering wheel. Below theHFL buttons is another set of voicecontrol buttons for the navigation,climate control, and audio systems.
When the HFL is in use, the soundcomes through the vehicle’s frontaudio system speakers. If the audiosystem is in use while making a call,the HFL over-rides the audio system.To change the volume level, use theaudio system volume knob.
To use the voice control system,refer to the navigation systemmanual.
HFL ButtonsAudio System
HandsFreeLink
258
HFL BACKBUTTON
VOICE CONTROL BUTTONS
HFL TALKBUTTON
TM
06/05/19 14:51:44 31STK600 0263
*
*
*
-
-
-
-
-
*
Signal Strength Indicates thenetwork signal strength of thecurrent phone call. Five barsequals full strength.
ROAM Status Indicates yourphone is roaming.
Battery Level Status Indicatesthe power remaining in yourphone’s current battery charge.Five bars equals full batterystrength.
When you are operating the HFL, orwhen you manually select HFL in themulti-information display, you willsee this information in the display:
HFL Mode Message Indicateswhen you are dialing and receivingcalls.
Phone Dialing Indicates thenumber you entered or thenumber of the incoming call.
Some phones do not send thisinformation to the HFL.
You will also see a ‘‘HANDSFREELINK’’ on the upper display.
:
Multi-Information Display
HandsFreeLink
Features
259
SIGNALSTRENGTH
PHONE DIALINGROAMSTATUS
HFL MODEMESSAGE
BATTERYLEVELSTATUS
TM
06/05/19 14:51:53 31STK600 0264
The HFL is operated by the HFLTalk and Back buttons on the leftside of the steering wheel. The nextfew pages provide instructions for allbasic features of the HFL. Many commands can be spoken
together. For example, you cansay, ‘‘Dial 123-456-7891.’’
To enter a string of numbers in aCall or Dial command, you can saythem all at once, or you canseparate them in blocks of 3, 4, 7,10, or 11.
To skip a voice prompt, press theTalk button while the HFL isspeaking. The HFL will then beginlistening for your next command.
Here are some guidelines for usingvoice control:
To enter a command, press theTalk button. Then, after the beep,say your command in a clear,natural tone.
For best system operation, set theclimate control fan speed to low,and direct the center vents awayfrom the microphone in the ceiling.
If the HFL does not recognize acommand, its response is, ‘‘Pardon.’’If it doesn’t recognize thecommand a second time, itsresponse is, ‘‘Please repeat.’’ If itdoesn’t recognize the command athird time, it plays the Helpprompt.
All phones may notoperate identically, and some maycause inconsistent operation of theHFL.
To hear a list of available optionsat any time, press the Talk button,wait for the beep, and say, ‘‘Handsfree help.’’
How to Use the HFL Using Voice Control
HandsFreeLink
260
NOTE:
TM
06/05/19 14:52:02 31STK600 0265
To go back one step in a commandprocess, say, ‘‘Go back,’’ or pressthe Back button.
When you finish a commandsequence, the HFL goes back toits main menu. For example, whenyou store the name, ‘‘Eric,’’ theHFL response is, ‘‘Eric has beenstored.’’ The next time you pressthe Talk button, you will be at themain menu.
If nothing is said while the HFL islistening for a command, the HFLwill time out and stop its voicerecognition. The next time youpress the Talk button, the HFLbegins listening from the point atwhich it timed out.
To end a command sequence atany time, press and hold the Backbutton, or press the Talk button,wait for the beep, and say, ‘‘Cancel.’’The next time you press the Talkbutton, the HFL begins from itsmain menu.
The voice of the HFL can be set tomale or female (U.S. models only).Also, the incoming notification canbe set to a ring tone, a prompt, or nonotification.
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘System.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘System optionsare setup and clear.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Setup.’’ TheHFL response is ‘‘Would you likemale or female prompts?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Male’’ or‘‘Female,’’ depending on thesystem voice you want. The HFLresponse is, ‘‘Male (Female)prompts have been selected.Would you like an audiblenotification of an incoming call?’’
1.
2.
3.
To set up the system, do this:
CONTINUED
HandsFreeLink
Setting Up the System
Features
261
TM
06/05/19 14:52:11 31STK600 0266
Press and release the Talk button.If you say ‘‘Yes’’ after the beep, theHFL response is, ‘‘Would you likea ring tone or a prompt?’’ If yousay ‘‘No’’ after the beep, the HFLreturns to its main menu. Saying‘‘No’’ will result in no ring tone orprompt playback during anincoming call. The audio systemwill still mute, and a message willbe displayed.
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Ring tone’’ or‘‘Prompt.’’ If you choose ‘‘Ringtone’’ you will hear a ring tonethrough the audio speakers toannounce an incoming call. If youchoose ‘‘Prompt,’’ you will hearthis message to announce anincoming call: ‘‘You have anincoming call.’’
Your Bluetooth compatible phonewith HandsFree Profile must bepaired to the HFL before you canmake and receive hands-free calls.
HFL does not allow you to pairyour phone if the vehicle ismoving.For pairing, your phone must be inits Discovery mode.Up to six phones can be paired tothe HFL.The following procedure works formost phones. If you cannot pairyour phone to the HFL with thisprocedure, refer to your phone’soperating manual, talk to yourphone retailer, or call theHandsFreeLink customer supportat (888) 528-7876.During the pairing process, turnoff any previously paired phonesbefore pairing a new phone.
4.
5.
Pairing Your Phone
HandsFreeLink
262
NOTE:
TM
06/05/19 14:52:19 31STK600 0267
With your phone on and theignition in the ACCESSORY (I) orON (II) position, press and releasethe Talk button. After the beep,say ‘‘Phone set up.’’ The HFLresponse is ‘‘Phone set up optionsare status, pair, edit, delete, andlist.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Pair.’’ TheHFL response is ‘‘The pairingprocess requires operation of yourmobile phone. For safety, onlyperform this function while thevehicle is stopped. State a four-digit code for pairing. Note thiscode. It will be requested by thephone.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the four-digitcode you want to use. For example,say ‘‘1, 2, 3, 4.’’ The HFL responseis, ‘‘1, 2, 3, 4. Is this correct?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the name youwant to use. For example, say‘‘Eric’s phone.’’ The HFL responseis ‘‘Eric’s phone has beensuccessfully paired. Returning tothe main menu.’’
If you want to pair another phone,repeat steps 1 through 7.
Steps 5 and 6 show acommon way to get your phone intoits Discovery mode. If these steps donot work on your phone, refer to thephone’s operating manual.
Follow the prompts on your phoneto get it into its Discovery mode.The phone will search for the HFL.When it comes up, selectHandsFreeLink from the list ofoptions displayed on your phone.
When asked by the phone, enterthe four-digit code from step 3 intoyour phone. The HFL response is‘‘A new phone has been found.What would you like to name thisphone?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Yes.’’ TheHFL response is ‘‘Searching for aBluetooth phone. Make sure thephone you are trying to pair is inDiscovery mode.’’
Once the paring process iscompleted, AcuraLink may display aconnection confirmation screen. Thisscreen is used to create a dataconnection between your cell phoneand the AcuraLink system. You canchoose to setup the data connectionnow, or do it later. If you want to doit now, exit the HFL menu bypressing the HFL Back button oneor more times.
1. 4.
5.
6.
7.
2.
3.
8.
CONTINUED
HandsFreeLink
Features
263
NOTE:
TM
06/05/19 14:52:29 31STK600 0268
To rename a paired phone, do this: To delete a paired phone, do this:Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Phone setup.’’The HFL response is ‘‘Phonesetup options are status, pair, edit,delete, and list.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Edit.’’ TheHFL response is ‘‘Which phonewould you like to edit?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the name ofthe phone you want to rename.For example, say ‘‘Eric’s phone.’’The HFL response is ‘‘What is thenew name for Eric’s phone?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the new nameof the phone. For example, say‘‘Lisa’s phone.’’ The HFL responseis, ‘‘The name has been changed.Returning to the main menu.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Phone setup.’’The HFL response is, ‘‘Phonesetup options are status, pair, edit,delete, and list.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Delete.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘Which phonewould you like to delete?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the name ofthe phone you want to delete. Forexample say ‘‘Eric’s phone.’’ TheHFL response is ‘‘Would you liketo delete Eric’s phone?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Yes.’’ TheHFL response is ‘‘Preparing todelete Eric’s phone.’’ Say ‘‘OK’’ tocontinue. Otherwise, say ‘‘Go back,’’or ‘‘Cancel.’’
Press and release the Talk button.If you say ‘‘OK’’ after the beep, theHFL response is ‘‘The phone hasbeen deleted. Returning to themain menu.’’ If you say ‘‘Go back,’’or ‘‘Cancel,’’ the phone will not bedeleted.
2.
3.
4.1. 1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
HandsFreeLink
264
TM
06/05/19 14:52:38 31STK600 0269
To list all paired phones, do this: To find out the status of the phone beingused, do this:
To change from the currently linkedphone to another paired phone, do this:Press and release the Talk button.
After the beep, say ‘‘Phone setup.’’The HFL response is ‘‘Phonesetup options are status, pair, edit,delete, and list.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Phone setup.’’The HFL response is ‘‘Phonesetup options are status, pair, edit,delete, and list.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Next phone.’’The HFL response is ‘‘Searchingfor the next phone.’’ The HFLthen disconnects the linked phoneand searches for another pairedphone. If no other phones arefound, the first phone remainslinked.
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘List.’’ TheHFL responds by listing the nameof each paired phone. When allphones paired to the system havebeen read, the HFL response is‘‘The entire list has been read.Returning to the main menu.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Status.’’ Anexample of the HFL response is,‘‘Eric’s phone is linked. Batterystrength is three bars. Signalstrength is five bars, and thephone is roaming. Returning to themain menu.’’
2.
1.1.
2.
1.
HandsFreeLink
Features
265
TM
06/05/19 14:52:46 31STK600 0270
You can make calls using any phonenumber, or by using a name in theHFL phonebook. You can also redialthe last number called. During a call,the HFL allows you to talk up to 30minutes after you remove the keyfrom the ignition switch.
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Call’’ or ‘‘Dial.’’The HFL response is ‘‘Calling’’ or‘‘Dialing.’’ Once connected, youwill hear the person you calledthrough the audio speakers. Tochange the volume, use the audiosystem volume knob.
To end the call, press the Backbutton.
With your phone on and theignition in the ACCESSORY (I) orON (II) position, press and releasethe Talk button. After the beep,say ‘‘Call’’ or ‘‘Dial.’’ The HFLresponse is, ‘‘What name ornumber would you like to call/dial?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the numberyou want to call. For example, say‘‘123 456 7891.’’ The HFL responseis ‘‘123 456 7891. Say call, dial, orcontinue to add numbers.’’
3.
1.
2.
4.
To make a call using a phone number,do this:
Making a Call
HandsFreeLink
266
TM
06/05/19 14:52:53 31STK600 0271
To make a call using a name in the HFLphonebook, do this:
With your phone on and theignition in the ACCESSORY (I) orON (II) position, press and releasethe Talk button. After the beep,say ‘‘Call’’ or ‘‘Dial.’’ The HFLresponse is ‘‘What name ornumber would you like to call/dial?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the name youwant to call. For example, say‘‘Eric.’’ The HFL response is‘‘Would you like to call Eric?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Yes.’’ TheHFL response is ‘‘Calling’’ or‘‘Dialing.’’ Once connected, youwill hear the person you calledthrough the audio speakers. Tochange the volume, use the audiosystem volume knob.
To redial the last number called bythe phone, press and release theTalk button. After the beep, say‘‘Redial.’’ The HFL response is,‘‘Redialing.’’ Once connected, youwill hear the person you calledthrough the audio speakers. Tochange the volume, use the audiosystem volume knob.
To end the call, press the Backbutton.
3.
1.
2.
4.
HandsFreeLink
267
TM
06/05/19 14:52:59 31STK600 0272
Features
The HFL allows you to sendnumbers or names during a call. Thisis useful when you call a menu-driven phone system. You can alsoprogram account numbers into theHFL phonebook for easy retrievalduring menu-driven calls.
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Send.’’ TheHFL response is ‘‘What name ornumber would you like to send?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the name youwant to send. For example, say‘‘Account number.’’ The HFLresponse is ‘‘Would you like tosend account number?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Send.’’ Thedial tones will be sent, and the callwill continue.
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Send.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘What name ornumber would you like to send?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the numberyou want to send. For example,say ‘‘1, 2, 3.’’ The HFL response is‘‘1, 2, 3. Say send, or continue toadd numbers.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Send.’’ Thedial tones will be sent, and the callwill continue.
1.
2.
1.
2.
3. 3.
To send a name during a call, do this:To send a number during a call, do this:Sending Numbers or NamesDuring a Call
HandsFreeLink
268
TM
06/05/19 14:53:07 31STK600 0273
If you receive a call when you are noton the phone, the HFL interrupts theaudio system (if it is on), and playsthe incoming call notification, ifactivated. To answer the call, pressthe Talk button and begin speaking.If you don’t want to answer the call,press the Back button.
If your phone has Call Waiting, andyou receive a call when you are onthe phone, press and release theTalk button to answer it. When youdo this, the original call is placed onhold. To return to the original call,press the Talk button again. If youdon’t want to answer the new call,disregard it, and continue with youroriginal call. If you want to hang upthe original call and answer the newcall, press the Back button.
During a call, you can transfer itfrom the HFL to your phone, or fromyour phone to the HFL.
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Transfer.’’The audio switches from the HFLto the phone.
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Transfer.’’The audio switches from yourphone to the HFL.
During a call, you can mute orunmute your voice to the person youare talking to.
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Mute.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘Mute is active.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Mute.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘Mute iscanceled.’’
1.1.
2.
2.
To transfer a call from the HFL to yourphone, do this:
To transfer a call from your phone to theHFL, do this:
To mute your voice, do this:
To unmute your voice, do this:
HandsFreeLink
Receiving a Call Muting a CallTransferring a Call
Features
269
TM
06/05/19 14:53:18 31STK600 0274
The HFL phonebook can store upto 50 names with their associatednumbers. These can be any typesof numbers. For example, you canstore a phone number and use it tomake a call, or you can store anaccount number and use it duringa call to a menu-driven phonesystem.
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Phonebook.’’The HFL response is ‘‘Phonebookoptions are store, edit, delete, andlist.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Store.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘What namewould you like to store?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the name youwould like to store. For example,say ‘‘Eric’’ or say ‘‘account number.’’The HFL response is ‘‘What is thenumber for Eric,’’ or ‘‘What is thenumber for account number?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the number.For example, say ‘‘123 456 7891.’’The HFL response is ‘‘123 4567891.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Enter.’’ TheHFL response is ‘‘Eric (or accountnumber) has been stored.Returning to the main menu.’’
3.
1.
2.
4.
5.
To add a name, do this:
HandsFreeLink
Setting up the Phonebook
270
TM
06/05/19 14:53:25 31STK600 0275
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the name youwould like to delete. For example,say ‘‘Eric.’’ The HFL response is‘‘Do you want to delete Eric?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Yes.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘The name hasbeen deleted. Returning to themain menu.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Phonebook.’’The HFL response is, ‘‘ThePhonebook options are store, edit,delete, and list.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the newnumber for Eric. For example, say‘‘987 654 3219.’’ The HFL responseis, ‘‘987 654 3219.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Enter.’’ TheHFL response is ‘‘The number hasbeen changed. Returning to themain menu.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Phonebook.’’The HFL response is, ‘‘Phonebookoptions are store, edit, delete, andlist.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Delete.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘What namewould you like to delete?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Phonebook.’’The HFL response is ‘‘Phonebookoptions are store, edit, delete, andlist.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Edit.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘What namewould you like to edit?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say the name youwould like to edit. For example,say ‘‘Eric.’’ The HFL response is‘‘What is the new number forEric?’’
2.
1.
4. 3.
4.5.
1.
2.
1.
3. To list all names in the phonebook, dothis:
To delete a name, do this:
To edit the number of a name, do this:
CONTINUED
HandsFreeLink
Features
271
TM
06/05/19 14:53:36 31STK600 0276
To call a name from the phonebook list,do this:
To clear the system, do this:
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘List.’’ TheHFL responds by listing thenames in the phonebook. Whenthe end of the list is reached, theHFL response is, ‘‘The entire listhas been read. Returning to themain menu.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Phonebook.’’The HFL response is ‘‘Phonebookoptions are store, edit, delete, andlist.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘List.’’ TheHFL responds by listing thenames in the phonebook. When itsays the name you want to call, forexample, Eric, press the Talkbutton, and then say ‘‘Call.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘Would you liketo call Eric?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Yes.’’ TheHFL response is ‘‘Calling.’’ Onceconnected, you will hear theperson you called through theaudio speakers. To change thevolume, use the audio systemvolume knob.
This operation clears the HFL ofyour passcode, your paired phones,and all names in the HFL phonebook.Clearing is recommended before yousell your vehicle.
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘System.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘System optionsare setup and clear.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Clear.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘This processwill clear all paired phones, clearall entries in the phonebook, clearthe passcode, and restore thedefaults in the system setup. Isthis what you would like to do?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Yes.’’ TheHFL response is ‘‘Preparing toclear all paired phones, allphonebook entries, the passcode,and restore the defaults in thesystem setup. This may take up to2 minutes to complete.’’ Press andrelease the Talk button. After thebeep, say ‘‘OK’’ to proceed,otherwise say ‘‘Go back’’ or‘‘Cancel.’’
If you said ‘‘OK,’’ after a shortperiod of time, the HFL responseis, ‘‘System has been cleared.Returning to the main menu.’’
2.
3.
4.
1.
1.
2.
3.
2.
Clearing the System
HandsFreeLink
272
TM
06/05/19 14:53:46 31STK600 0277
< >
<>
If there are paired phones withoutFrench name tags, the HFLresponse is ‘‘Pour que le systèmeidentifie les téléphones qui ont étéjumelés dans une autre langue, lesnoms des téléphones doivent êtreré-enregistrés.’’
If there are paired phoneswithout French name tags thefollowing prompts will continue.
The HFL response is, for example,‘‘Quel est le nom Français pour
Paul’s phone ?’’ Press andrelease the Talk button. After thebeep, say ‘‘Téléphone de Paul.’’The HFL response is, ‘‘Quel est lenom Français pour Pat’sphone ?’’ Press and release theTalk button. Say ‘‘Téléphone dePat.’’ After all paired phonesmissing a French name tag are re-recorded, the HFL will prompt,‘‘Retour au menu principal.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘ChangerLangue.’’ The HFL response is,‘‘English or Français?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Yes.’’ If thereare no paired phones withoutEnglish name tags, the HFLresponse is ‘‘The language hasbeen changed. Returning to themain menu.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘English.’’ TheHFL response is, ‘‘You haveselected English. Name tags thatwere stored while in French modewill not be accessible in Englishmode. Would you like tocontinue?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Oui.’’ If thereare no paired phones withoutFrench name tags, the HFLresponse is ‘‘La langue a étéchangée. Retour au menu principal.’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Changelanguage.’’ The HFL response is‘‘English or Français?’’
Press and release the Talk button.After the beep, say ‘‘Français.’’The HFL response is ‘‘Vous avezsélectionné le Français. Les nomsen registrés dans une autre languene seront pas accessible en modeFrançais. Voulez-vous continuer?’’
1.
2.
3.
4.
1.
2.
3.
To change from French to English, dothis:
To change from English to French, dothis:
CONTINUED
Changing Language(Canadian Models Only)
HandsFreeLink
Features
273
NOTE:
TM
06/05/19 14:53:57 31STK600 0278
< >
<>
If there are paired phones withoutEnglish name tags, the HFLresponse is ‘‘The language has beenchanged. For the system to identifyphones that were paired while inanother language, the phone namesneed to be re-recorded.’’
If there are paired phoneswithout English name tags, thefollowing prompts will continue.
The HFL says, for example, ‘‘Whatis the English name for
Téléphone de Paul ?’’ Pressand release the Talk button. Afterthe beep, say ‘‘Paul’s phone. ’’ TheHFL response is ‘‘What is theEnglish name for Téléphone dePat ?’’ Press and release the Talkbutton. After the beep, say ‘‘Pat’sphone.’’ After all paired phonesmissing an English name tag arere-recorded, the HFL will say‘‘Returning to the main menu.’’
4.
HandsFreeLink
274
NOTE:
TM
06/05/19 14:54:01 31STK600 0279
Whenever you shift to reverse (R)with the ignition switch in the ON(II) position, the rear view is shownon the navigation system screen.
For the best picture, always keep therearview camera clean, and do notcover the camera lens. To avoidscratching the lens when you clean it,use a moist, soft cloth.
Since the rearview camera displayarea is limited, you should alwaysback up slowly and carefully, andlook behind you for obstacles.
When in reverse, the navigationbuttons are locked out, except theinterface dial on the dashboard. Turnthe dial clockwise to make thecamera image brighter, and counter-clockwise to darken the image.
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Rearview Camera and Monitor
Features
275
INTERFACE DIAL
The camera brightness cannot beadjusted by voice control.
06/06/16 19:28:56 31STK600 0280
Before you begin driving yourvehicle, you should know whatgasoline to use and how to check thelevels of important fluids. You alsoneed to know how to properly storeluggage or packages. Theinformation in this section will helpyou. If you plan to add anyaccessories to your vehicle, pleaseread the information in this sectionfirst.
.............................Break-in Period . 278.................Fuel Recommendation . 278
.........Service Station Procedures . 279....................................Refueling . 279
........Check Fuel Cap Message . 280.....Tighten Fuel Cap Message . 281
Opening and Closing................................the Hood . 282
...............................Fuel Economy . 284...Accessories and Modifications . 285
.............................Carrying Cargo . 287
Before Driving
Before
Driving
277
06/05/19 14:54:12 31STK600 0282
Help assure your vehicle’s futurereliability and performance by payingextra attention to how you driveduring the first 600 miles (1,000 km).During this period:
Avoid full-throttle starts and rapidacceleration.
Avoid hard braking for the first200 miles (300 km).
Do not change the oil until thescheduled maintenance time.
You should also follow theserecommendations with anoverhauled or exchanged engine, orwhen the brakes are replaced.
Do not tow a trailer.
In addition, in order to maintain goodperformance, fuel economy, andemissions control, we stronglyrecommend, in areas where it isavailable, the use of gasoline thatdoes NOT contain manganese-basedfuel additives such as MMT.Use of gasoline with these additivesmay adversely affect performance,and cause the malfunction indicatorlamp on your instrument panel tocome on. If this happens, contactyour authorized dealer for service.
Your vehicle is designed to operateon premium unleaded gasoline with apump octane of 91 or higher. If thisoctane grade is unavailable, regularunleaded gasoline with a pumpoctane of 87 or higher may be usedtemporarily. The use of regularunleaded gasoline can cause metallicknocking noises in the engine andwill result in decreased engineperformance. The long-term use ofregular-grade gasoline can lead toengine damage.
We recommend using qualitygasolines containing detergentadditives that help prevent fuelsystem and engine deposits.
Break-in Period Fuel Recommendation
Break-in Period, Fuel Recommendation
278
06/06/16 19:29:06 31STK600 0283
CONTINUED
Park with the driver’s side closestto the service station pump.
Some gasoline today is blended withoxygenates such as ethanol orMTBE. Your vehicle is designed tooperate on oxygenated gasolinecontaining up to 10 % ethanol byvolume and up to 15 % MTBE byvolume. Do not use gasolinecontaining methanol.
If your notice any undesirableoperating symptoms, try anotherservice station or switch to anotherbrand of gasoline.
For further important fuel-relatedinformation, please refer to your
.Open the fuel fill door by pullingon the handle at the outside of thedriver’s seat.
1.
2.
Refueling
Quick Start Guide
Fuel Recommendation, Service Station Procedures
Before
Driving
279
Pull
FUEL FILL CAP
FUEL FILL DOOR RELEASE HANDLE
TETHER
Gasoline is highly flammableand explosive. You can beburned or seriously injuredwhen handling fuel.
Stop the engine, and keepheat, sparks, and flame away.Handle fuel only outdoors.Wipe up spills immediately.
06/05/19 19:48:46 31STK600 0284
Screw the fuel fill cap back onuntil it clicks at least once.
even though the tank is not full,there may be a problem with yourvehicle’s fuel vapor recoverysystem. The system helps keepfuel vapors from going into theatmosphere. Try filling at anotherpump. If this does not fix theproblem, consult your dealer.
Stop filling the tank after the fuelnozzle automatically clicks off. Donot try to ‘‘top off’’ the tank. Leavesome room for the fuel to expandwith temperature changes.
Remove the fuel fill cap slowly.You may hear a hissing sound aspressure inside the tank escapes.Place the cap in the holder on thefuel fill door. If you do not properly tighten the cap,
you will see a ‘‘CHECK FUEL CAP’’message on the information display(see the next column).
If you do not properly tighten the cap,you will see a ‘‘TIGHTEN FUELCAP’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
Push the fuel fill door closed untilit latches.
If your fuel fill cap is loose ormissing, a ‘‘CHECK FUEL CAP’’message appears on the informationdisplay after you start the engine.
4.
5.
6.
3.
281
If the fuel nozzle keeps clicking off
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX model
On RDX modelCheck Fuel Cap Message
Service Station Procedure
280
06/05/19 14:54:39 31STK600 0285
▲ ▼
Turn the engine off, and confirm thefuel fill cap is installed. If it is, loosenit, then retighten it until it clicks atleast once. When you can restart theengine, the message appears again.The message goes off after severaldays of normal driving once youtighten or replace the fuel fill cap. Toscroll to another message, press theINFO ( / ) button.
If your fuel fill cap is loose ormissing, a ‘‘TIGHTEN FUEL CAP’’message appears on the multi-information display after you startthe engine.
Turn the engine off, and confirm thefuel fill cap is installed. If it is, loosenit, then retighten it until it clicks atleast once. When you restart theengine, the message appears again.The message goes off after severaldays of normal driving once youtighten or replace the fuel fill cap. Toscroll to another display, press theSelect/Reset knob.
If the system still detects a leak inyour vehicle’s evaporative emissionssystem, the malfunction indicatorlamp (MIL) comes on. If the fuel fillcap was not already tightened, turnthe engine off, and check orretighten the fuel fill cap until itclicks at least once. The MIL shouldgo off after several days of normaldriving once the cap is tightened orreplaced. If the MIL does not go off,have your vehicle inspected by adealer. For more information, seepage .
If the system still detects a leak inyour vehicle’s evaporative emissionssystem, the malfunction indicatorlamp (MIL) comes on. If the fuel fillcap was not already tightened, turnthe engine off, and check orretighten the fuel fill cap until itclicks at least once. The MIL shouldgo off after several days of normaldriving once the cap is tightened orreplaced. If the MIL does not go off,have your vehicle inspected by adealer. For more information, seepage . 394394
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Tighten Fuel Cap Message
Service Station Procedure
Before
Driving
281
06/06/16 20:22:08 31STK600 0286
Park the vehicle, and set theparking brake. Pull the hoodrelease handle located under thelower left corner of the dashboard.The hood will pop up slightly.
Put your fingers under the frontedge of the hood near the center.Slide your hand to the left untilyou feel the hood latch handle.Push this handle up to release it.Lift up the hood.
If the hood latch handle movesstiffly, or if you can open the hoodwithout lifting the handle, themechanism should be cleaned andlubricated.
Holding the grip, pull the supportrod out of its clip. Insert the endinto the designated hole in thehood.
To close the hood, lift it up slightly toremove the support rod from thehole. Put the support rod back intoits holding clip. Lower the hood toabout a foot (30 cm) above thefender, then let it drop. Make sure itis securely latched.
1. 2. 3.
Service Station Procedures
Opening and Closing the Hood
282
HOOD RELEASE HANDLE
LATCH
GRIP
CLIPSUPPORT ROD
06/05/19 14:54:53 31STK600 0287
Park the vehicle on a level surface.Wait a few minutes after turning theengine off before you check the oil.
Remove the dipstick (orange loop).
Wipe off the dipstick with a cleancloth or paper towel.
Hold the dipstick with a cleancloth or paper towel, and theninsert it all the way back in its hole.
Make sure the ‘‘UP’’ mark on theloop is facing up when you insertthe dipstick.
Remove the dipstick again, andcheck the level. It should bebetween the upper and lowermarks.
If it is near or below the lower mark,see on page .
Look at the coolant level in theradiator reserve tank. Make sure it isbetween the MAX and MIN lines. Ifit is below the MIN line, see
on page forinformation on adding the propercoolant.
Refer toon page for information
about checking other items on yourvehicle.
1.
2.
3.
4.
347
351
342
Service Station Procedures
Oil Check
Adding Engine Oil
Engine Coolant Check
AddingEngine Coolant
Owner’s MaintenanceChecks
Before
Driving
283
DIPSTICK
UPPER MARK
LOWER MARK
‘‘UP’’MARK RESERVE TANK
MAX
MIN
06/05/19 14:55:05 31STK600 0288
Combine several short trips intoone.
The air conditioning puts an extraload on the engine which makes ituse more fuel. Use the fresh-airventilation when possible.
Drive moderately. Rapidacceleration, abrupt cornering,and hard braking use more fuel.
Always drive in the highest gearpossible.
Try to maintain a constant speed.Every time you slow down andspeed up, your vehicle uses extrafuel. Use cruise control whenappropriate.
Always maintain your vehicleaccording to the maintenancemessages. See
(page ).
an underinflated tirecauses more ‘‘rolling resistance,’’which uses more fuel.
The build-up of snow or mud onyour vehicle’s underside addsweight and rolling resistance.Frequent cleaning helps your fuelmileage and reduces the chance ofcorrosion.
342
For example,
Improving Fuel Economy
Owner’sMaintenance Checks
Fuel Economy
284
06/05/19 14:55:12 31STK600 0289
When properly installed, cellularphones, alarms, two-way radios, andlow-powered audio systems shouldnot interfere with your vehicle’scomputer controlled systems, suchas your airbags and anti-lock brakes.
Although non-Acura accessories mayfit on your vehicle, they may notmeet factory specifications, andcould adversely affect your vehicle’shandling and stability.
Your dealer has Acura accessoriesthat allow you to personalize yourvehicle. These accessories havebeen designed and approved for yourvehicle, and are covered by warranty.
Modifying your vehicle, or installingsome non-Acura accessories, canmake your vehicle unsafe. Beforeyou make any modifications or addany accessories, be sure to read thefollowing information.
CONTINUED
Accessories
Accessories and Modifications
Before
Driving
285
Improper accessories ormodifications can affect yourvehicle’s handling, stability, andperformance, and cause acrash in which you can be hurtor killed.
Follow all instructions in thisowner’s manual regardingaccessories and modifications.
06/05/19 14:55:19 31STK600 0290
Non-Acura wheels can causeexcessive stress on suspensioncomponents and are notcompatible with the tire pressuremonitoring system.
Larger or smaller wheels and tirescan interfere with the operation ofyour vehicle’s anti-lock brakes andother systems.
Modifying your steering wheel orany other part of your vehicle’ssafety features can make thesystems ineffective.
If you plan to modify your vehicle,consult your dealer.
Removing parts from your vehicle,or replacing components with non-Acura components could seriouslyaffect your vehicle’s handling,stability, and reliability.
Here are some examples:
Raising your vehicle with a non-Acura suspension kit can affectthe handling and stability.
Before installing any accessory:
Make sure the accessory does notobscure any lights, or interferewith proper vehicle operation orperformance.
Be sure electronic accessories donot overload electrical circuits(see page ) or interfere withproper operation of your vehicle.
Before installing any electronicaccessory, have the installercontact your dealer for assistance.If possible, have your dealerinspect the final installation.
Do not install accessories on theside pillars or across the rearwindows. In these areas,accessories may interfere withproper operation of the sidecurtain airbags.
Lowering the vehicle with a non-Acura suspension kit thatsignificantly reduces groundclearance can allow theundercarriage to hit speed bumpsor other raised objects, whichcould cause the airbags to deploy.
398
Modifying Your Vehicle
Accessories and Modifications
286
06/06/16 19:34:48 31STK600 0291
Your vehicle has several convenientstorage areas:
Glove box
Door lining pocketsCenter pocketConsole compartmentCargo area, including the rearseats when folded down.
Front door pockets
However, carrying too much cargo,or improperly storing it, can affectyour vehicle’s handling, stability,stopping distance, and tires, andmake it unsafe. Before carrying anytype of cargo, be sure to read thefollowing pages.
Carrying Cargo
Before
Driving
287
GLOVE BOXCARGO AREA
CENTER POCKET
FRONT DOOR POCKET
CONSOLE COMPARTMENT
DOOR LINING POCKETS
06/05/19 14:55:37 31STK600 0292
- ×
Steps for determining correct loadlimit:
Determine the combined weightof the driver and passengers thatwill be riding in your vehicle.
The maximum load for your vehicleis 870 lbs for U.S. vehicles, and 395kg for Canadian vehicles. This figureincludes the total weight of alloccupants, cargo, and accessories,and the tongue load if you are towinga trailer.
Locate the statement, ‘‘thecombined weight of occupants andcargo should never exceed 870lbs’’ on your vehicle’s placard.(The placard is on the driver’sdoorjamb.)
Subtract the combined weight ofthe driver and passengers from870 lbs.
The resulting figure equals theavailable amount of cargo andluggage load capacity.For example, if the maximum loadis 870 lbs and there will be five 150lb. passengers in your vehicle, theamount of available cargo andluggage load capacity is 120 lbs.(870 750 (5 150) = 120 lbs.)
Determine the combined weightof luggage and cargo being loadedin the vehicle. That weight maynot safely exceed the availablecargo and luggage load capacitycalculated in step 4.
If your vehicle will be towing atrailer, the load from your trailerwill be transferred to your vehicle.Consult this manual to determinehow this reduces the availablecargo and luggage load capacity ofyour vehicle (see page ).
In addition, the total weight of thevehicle, all occupants, accessories,cargo, and trailer tongue load mustnot exceed the gross vehicle weightrating (GVWR) or the gross axleweight rating (GAWR). Both are ona label on the driver’s doorjamb.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
317
Load Limits
Carrying Cargo
288
Overloading or improperloading can affect handling andstability and cause a crash inwhich you can be hurt or killed.
Follow all load limits and otherloading guidelines in thismanual.
06/06/16 19:34:57 31STK600 0293
Store or secure all items that couldbe thrown around and hurtsomeone during a crash.
Keep the glove box closed whiledriving. If it is open, a passengercould injure their knees during acrash or sudden stop.
Be sure items placed on the floorbehind the front seats cannot rollunder the seats and interfere withthe driver’s ability to operate thepedals, the proper operation of theseats, or proper operation of thesensors under the seats.
Do not put any items on top of thecargo area cover. They can blockyour view and be thrown aroundthe vehicle during a crash.
Distribute cargo evenly on thefloor of the cargo area, placing theheaviest items on the bottom andas far forward as possible. Tiedown items that could be thrownabout the vehicle during a crash orsudden stop.
If you fold the rear seats down, tiedown items that could be thrownabout the vehicle during a crash orsudden stop. Also, keep all cargobelow the bottom of the windows.If it is higher, it could interferewith the proper operation of theside curtain airbags.
If you carry large items thatprevent you from closing thetailgate, exhaust gas can enter thepassenger area. To avoid thepossibility of
, follow the instructionson page .
If you carry any items on a roofrack, be sure the total weight ofthe rack and the items does notexceed the maximum allowableweight. Please contact your dealerfor further information.
If you use an accessory roof rack,the roof rack weight limit may belower. Refer to the information thatcame with your roof rack.
58
Carrying Cargo in the PassengerCompartment
Carrying Cargo in the Cargo Area
carbon monoxidepoisoning
Carrying Cargo
Before
Driving
289
06/05/19 14:55:55 31STK600 0294
To secure the cargo, you can use thefour cargo hooks on the cargo area.The illustration shows the location ofeach cargo hook.
The cargo net can be used to helphold down light items in the cargoarea. The cargo net may not preventheavy items from being thrownforward in a crash or a sudden stop.Heavy items should be secured tothe cargo area floor with the hooksor cinch straps attached to the cargohooks.
The hanger bars can be used to hangitems. The hanger bar is designed tohang light items (maximum load: 11lbs or 5 kg on each side). Heavyitems may damage the bars.
The cargo hooks on the floor can beused to install the cargo net forsecuring items.
Carrying Cargo
Cargo Hooks/Hanger Bars Optional Cargo Net
290
HOOK
HANGERBARS
06/05/19 14:56:01 31STK600 0295
This section gives you tips onstarting the engine under variousconditions, and how to operate theautomatic transmission. It alsoincludes important information onparking your vehicle, the brakingsystem, the super handling-all wheeldrive (SH-AWD) system, the vehiclestability assist (VSA) system, the tirepressure monitoring system (TPMS),and facts you need if you areplanning to tow a trailer or drive off-highway.
........................Driving Guidelines . 292
........................Preparing to Drive . 293.......................Starting the Engine . 294
..............Automatic Transmission . 295Driving with the Paddle
Because your vehicle rides higheroff the ground, it has a high centerof gravity that can cause it to rollover if you make abrupt turns. Utilityvehicles have a significantly higherroll over rate than other types ofvehicles.
Your vehicle has higher groundclearance that allows you to travelover bumps, obstacles, and roughterrain. It also provides goodvisibility so you can anticipateproblems earlier.
To prevent rollovers or loss ofcontrol:
Take corners at slower speedsthan you would with a passengervehicle.
Avoid sharp turns and abruptmaneuvers whenever possible.
Do not modify your vehicle in anyway that would raise the center ofgravity.
Do not carry heavy cargo on theroof.
Your vehicle is equipped with asuper handling-all wheel drive (SH-AWD) system. When the systemsenses a loss of one or more wheeltraction, it automatically transferssome power to the other wheels.This gives you better traction andmobility.
You still need to exercise the samecare when accelerating, steering, andbraking that you would in a two-wheel drive vehicle.
See page for off-highway drivingguidelines.
324
Driving Guidelines
292
06/05/19 14:56:13 31STK600 0297
Check the seat adjustment (seepage ).
Check the adjustment of theinside and outside mirrors (seepage ).
Check the steering wheeladjustment (see page ).
Fasten your seat belt. Check thatyour passengers have fastenedtheir seat belts (see page ).
Make sure the doors and thetailgate are securely closed andlocked.
When you start the engine, checkthe gauges and indicators in theinstrument panel, and themessages in the informationdisplay or multi-informationdisplay (depending on models)(see pages , , , and
).
You should do these checks andadjustments before you drive yourvehicle:
Make sure all windows, mirrors,and outside lights are clean andunobstructed. Remove frost, snow,or ice.
Check that the hood is fully closed.
Visually check the tires. If a tirelooks low, use a gauge to check itspressure (see page ).
Check that any items you may becarrying are stored properly orfastened down securely.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
16
155
126
372
145
6384
64 75
Preparing to Drive
Driving
293
06/06/16 19:35:11 31STK600 0298
Apply the parking brake.
In cold weather, turn off allelectrical accessories to reducethe drain on the battery.
Make sure the shift lever is inPark. Press on the brake pedal.
Without touching the acceleratorpedal, turn the ignition key to theSTART (III) position. Do not holdthe key in the START (III)position for more than 15 secondsat a time. If the engine does notstart right away, pause for at least10 seconds before trying again.
If the engine does not start within15 seconds, or starts but stallsright away, repeat step 4 with theaccelerator pedal pressed halfwaydown. If the engine starts, releasepressure on the accelerator pedalso the engine does not race.
If the engine fails to start, pressthe accelerator pedal all the waydown, and hold it there whilestarting to clear flooding. If theengine still does not start, returnto step 5.
Your vehicle has an electric vacuumpump located in the enginecompartment. When you drive incold weather or thinner air at highaltitude, the electric vacuum pumpoperates more frequently after theengine is started.
When the electric vacuum pump is inoperation, it makes some mechanicalnoises come from the enginecompartment. This is normal.
1.
2.
3.
4.5.
6.
128
Starting the Engine
294
The immobilizer system protects yourvehicle f rom thef t. If an improperly-coded key (or other device) is used, theengine’s f uel system is disabled. Formore inf ormation, see page .
The engine is harder to start in coldweather. Also, the thinner air f ound ataltitudes above 8,000 f eet (2,400meters) adds to this problem.
06/05/19 14:56:30 31STK600 0299
These indicators on the instrumentpanel show which position the shiftlever is in.
The ‘‘D’’ indicator comes on for afew seconds when you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position. If it flashes while driving (inany shift position), it indicates apossible problem in the transmission.
If the malfunction indicator lampcomes on along with the ‘‘D’’indicator, there is a problem with theautomatic transmission controlsystem. Avoid rapid acceleration, andhave the transmission checked byyour dealer as soon as possible.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECKTRANSMISSION’’ message on themulti-information display (see page
).
To shift from Park to any position,press firmly on the brake pedal andpress the release button on the frontof the shift lever, then pull the lever.You cannot shift out of Park whenthe ignition switch is in the LOCK(0) or the ACCESSORY (I) position.85
CONTINUED
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Shift Lever Position Indicators Shifting
Automatic Transmission
Driving
295
SHIFT LEVER
RELEASE BUTTON
06/06/16 19:35:20 31STK600 0300
- -
If you have done all of the above andstill cannot move the lever out ofPark, see onpage .
This position mechani-cally locks the transmission. UsePark whenever you are turning off orstarting the engine. To shift out ofPark, you must press on the brakepedal and have your foot off theaccelerator pedal. Press the releasebutton on the front of the shift leverto move it.
To avoid transmission damage, cometo a complete stop before shiftinginto Park. You must also press therelease button to shift into Park. Theshift lever must be in Park beforeyou can remove the key from theignition switch.
Press the brakepedal and press the release buttonon the front of the shift lever to shiftfrom Park to reverse. To shift fromreverse to neutral, come to acomplete stop, and then shift. Pressthe release button before shiftinginto reverse from neutral.
298
To shift from:
P to R
R to PN to RD to SS to DD to NN to DR to N
Do this:Press the brake pedal, andpress the shift lever releasebutton.Press the shift lever releasebutton.
Move the shift lever.
Automatic Transmission
Shift Lock Release
Park (P) Reverse (R)
296
06/05/19 14:56:44 31STK600 0301
- -
-
Use neutral if youneed to restart a stalled engine, or ifit is necessary to stop briefly withthe engine idling. Shift to the Parkposition if you need to leave yourvehicle for any reason. Press on thebrake pedal when you are movingthe shift lever from neutral toanother gear.
With the shift lever in D or S, youcan also use the paddle shifters toshift the transmission up or down.Once you begin to use the paddleshifters in S, the transmission will nolonger upshift or downshiftautomatically. For more informationof driving with the paddle shifters,see page .
If you exceed the maximum speedfor the gear you are in, the enginespeed will enter into the tachometer’sred zone. If this occurs, you may feelthe engine cut in and out. This iscaused by a limiter in the engine’scomputer controls. The engine willrun normally when you reduce therpm below the red zone.
Use this position foryour normal driving. The transmis-sion automatically selects a suitablegear for your speed and acceleration.
To shift into the Sposition, press the release button onthe front of the shift lever, and movethe lever to S. This position is similarto D, except only gears from first tofourth are selected. The S positionkeeps the transmission from cyclingbetween fourth and fifth gears instop-and-go driving.
299
Neutral (N)
Engine Speed Limiter
Drive (D)
S position (S)
Automatic Transmission
Driving
297
06/06/16 19:35:26 31STK600 0302
This allows you to move the shiftlever out of Park if the normalmethod of pushing on the brakepedal and pressing the releasebutton does not work.
Set the parking brake.
Remove the key from the ignitionswitch.
Push down on the key while youpress the release button on theshift lever and move the shift leverout of Park to neutral.
Insert the key in the shift lockrelease slot.
Put a cloth on the notch of theshift lock release slot cover. Usinga small flat-tipped screwdriver or ametal fingernail file, carefully pryon the notch of the cover toremove it.
Remove the key from the shiftlock release slot, then install thecover. Make sure the notch on thecover is on the rear.Return the key to the ignitionswitch, press the brake pedal, andrestart the engine.
If you need to use the shift lockrelease, it means your vehicle isdeveloping a problem. Have itchecked by your dealer.
1.
2.
3.4.
5.
6.
Shift Lock Release
Automatic Transmission
298
COVER
RELEASEBUTTON
NOTCH
SHIFT LOCKRELEASE SLOT
KEY
06/05/19 14:57:00 31STK600 0303
+
-
+-
CONTINUED
Each time you pull the (right), thetransmission shifts to a higher gear.Pull the (left) to downshift. Youwill see the selected gear number onthe instrument panel.
When you pull either paddle shifter,the gear position indicator shows youthe selected gear number.
When you are driving in D position,pulling the either paddle shifterswitches from the ordinaryautomatic transmission [drive mode(D)] to the D-paddle shift mode. Youcan shift the transmission up ordown manually with the paddleshifters.
To shift up or down, use the(right) or (left) paddle shifter oneach side of the steering wheel.
Downshifting gives you more powerwhen climbing, and provides enginebraking when going down a steep hill.
Using the Paddle Shifters in Dposition (D-Paddle Shift Mode)
Driving with the Paddle Shifters
Driving
299
GEAR POSITION INDICATOR
06/05/19 14:57:08 31STK600 0304
The transmission downshifts to firstgear and returns to drive mode (D)when the vehicle comes to acomplete stop and the vehicle speedis about 6 mph (10 km/h).
The transmission control systemmonitors the accelerator pedal useand your driving conditions. Whenyou press the accelerator pedal as inthe normal driving, the systemjudges that you are driving at aconstant cruising speed withoutusing the paddle shifters. Underthese conditions, D-paddle shiftmode is canceled, and thetransmission automatically returns todrive mode(D).
If there is a problem in thetransmission while you are drivingwith the paddle shifters, the Dindicator flashes, the D-paddle shiftmode is canceled, and thetransmission returns to drive mode(D).
The transmission remains in theselected gear if you do not accelerate.
When the transmission returns todrive mode (D), the displayed gearnumber goes out.
Each time you pull either paddleshifter, the transmission shifts onegear up or down. If you want to shiftup or down more than two gears, pullthe paddle shifter twice, pause, andthen pull it again.
The automatic transmission will notallow you to change shift if:
You downshift before the enginespeed reaches the upper limit ofthe lower gear.
If you try to do this, the gearposition indicator will flash thenumber of the lower gear severaltimes, then return to a higher gear.
You upshift before the enginespeed reaches the lower limit ofthe higher gear.
You press both paddle shifters atthe same time.
You press one of the two paddleshifters with another paddleshifter being pressed.
Driving with the Paddle Shifters
300
06/05/19 14:57:17 31STK600 0305
+-
When you move the shift lever from‘‘D’’ to ‘‘S’’ position and pull eitherpaddle shifter, the gear positionindicator displays on ‘‘M’’ along withthe selected gear number.
To upshift, pull the (right) paddleshifter. To downshift, pull the(left) paddle shifter.
When you accelerate from a stop,the transmission starts in first gear,and you must manually upshiftbetween first and fifth gears. Makesure you upshift before the enginespeed reaches the tachometer’s redzone.
The transmission remains in theselected gear (5, 4, 3, 2, or 1). Thereis no automatic downshift when youpush the accelerator pedal to thefloor.
When you are driving in 4th or 5thgear, the transmission downshifts tothe lower gear under the followingconditions:
The vehicle slows down to acertain speed.
You press the brake pedal.
With the shift lever in S position, youcan select the sequential shift modeto shift gears; much like a manualtransmission using the paddleshifters, but without a clutch pedal.
To enter the sequential shift mode,press the release button on the frontof the shift lever, move the lever tothe S position, then pull either paddleshifter. To cancel the sequential shiftmode and return to the ordinaryautomatic transmission, move theshift lever from S position. Whenmoving the shift lever, be careful notto operate incorrectly. While you aredriving in the sequential shift mode,the transmission will notautomatically return to ordinaryautomatic transmission.
CONTINUED
Using the Paddle Shift in Sposition (Sequential Shift Mode)
Driving with the Paddle Shifters
Driving
301
‘‘M’’ INDICATOR
GEAR POSITION INDICATOR
06/05/19 14:57:26 31STK600 0306
→
→
→
→
→
→
→
→
Downshifting with the paddle shifterallows you to increase the enginebraking when going down steep orlong hills, and provides more powerwhen climbing uphills. You canupshift the transmission manually toreduce the rpm. Driving in thehigher gear helps fuel economy.
The transmission also shiftsautomatically as the vehicle comes toa complete stop. It downshifts to firstgear when the vehicle speed reaches6 mph (10 km/h) or less.
The automatic transmission will notallow you to change shift if:
You downshift before the enginespeed reaches the upper limit ofthe lower gear.
To shiftfrom
2 1
3 2
4 3
5 4
Speed range
under 29 mph (47 km/h)
under 63 mph (100 km/h)
under 94 mph (150 km/h)
under 114 mph (182 km/h)
Here are the speed ranges forupshifting and downshifting.
To shiftfrom
1 2
2 3
3 4
4 5
Speed range
over 0 mph (0 km/h)
over 8 mph (13 km/h)
over 17 mph (27 km/h)
over 47 mph (75 km/h)
If you try to do this, the gearposition indicator will flash thenumber of the lower gear severaltimes, then return to a higher gear.
You upshift before the enginespeed reaches the lower limit ofthe higher gear.
You try to shift to third or a highergear when the vehicle is stationary.
You press both paddle shifters atthe same time.
You press one of the two paddleshifters with another paddleshifter being pressed.
Driving with the Paddle Shifters
302
06/05/26 17:22:00 31STK600 0307
+
CONTINUED
The SH-AWD torque distributionmonitor on the multi-informationdisplay shows you the amount oftorque being sent to the wheels.Each wheel: right front (RF), leftfront (LF), right rear (RR), and leftrear (LR), has its own torqueindicator.
When you are in sequential shiftmode, and the vehicle is stopped,pull the (right) paddle shifter toshift to second gear. You will see ‘‘M2’’ in the display. Starting in secondgear helps to reduce wheelspin indeep snow or on a slippery surface.
The super handling-all wheel drive(SH-AWD) system is a full time all-wheel-drive system thatautomatically controls and transfersvarying amounts of engine torque toall wheels independently, accordingto the driving conditions.
While the SH-AWD system helps toenhance the vehicle’s drivingstability in all situations, it is stillyour responsibility to drive andcorner at reasonable speeds and toleave a sufficient margin of safety.
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
SH-AWD Torque DistributionMonitor
Super Handling-All Wheel Drive(SH-AWD) system
Driving with the Paddle Shifter, Super Handling-All Wheel Drive (SH-AWD) System
Driving
Starting in Second Gear
303
TORQUE INDICATOR
TORQUE INDICATOR
06/05/19 14:57:43 31STK600 0308
Your vehicle still has normal front-wheel drive with vehicle stabilityassist (VSA), but does not have theadvantages of SH-AWD. Have yourvehicle checked by a dealer as soonas possible.
If the SH-AWD indicator on theinstrument panel stays on, and the‘‘CHECK SH-AWD SYSTEM’’message also appears on the multi-information display, there is problemwith the SH-AWD system.
If the SH-AWD indicator blinks whiledriving, it indicates the differentialtemperature is too high. You will alsosee an ‘‘SH-AWD DIFF TEMPHIGH’’ message on the multi-information display. If this happens,pull to the side of the road when it issafe, shift to Park, and let the engineidle until the indicator goes out. Ifthe indicator does not go out, takeyour vehicle to a dealer to have itchecked,
Each torque indicator is displayed asa bar graph divided into 5 segments.The number of segments representsthe amount of torque distributed toeach wheel.
When there is only a slight change intorque distribution while driving,such as cruising on level roads at thesame speed, the torque distributionmonitor may stop displaying theamount of torque. This is not asystem problem. The monitor willshow the amount if the systemsenses any change in torquedistribution.
Super Handling-All Wheel Drive (SH-AWD) System
304
06/05/19 14:57:49 31STK600 0309
Always use the parking brake whenyou park your vehicle. Make surethe parking brake is set firmly, oryour vehicle may roll if it is parkedon an incline.
Make sure the moonroof and thewindows are closed.
If the vehicle is facing uphill, turnthe front wheels away from thecurb.
If the vehicle is facing downhill,turn the front wheels toward thecurb.
Check the indicator on theinstrument panel to verify that thesecurity system is set.
Make sure the parking brake isfully released before driving away.Driving with the parking brakepartially set can overheat ordamage the rear brakes.
Set the parking brake before you putthe transmission in Park. This keepsthe vehicle from moving and puttingpressure on the parking mechanismin the transmission.
Turn off the lights.
Place any packages, valuables, etc.in the cargo area or take themwith you.
Lock the doors and the tailgate.
Never park over dry leaves, tallgrass, or other flammablematerials. The hot three waycatalytic converter could causethese materials to catch on fire.
Parking Tips
Parking
Driving
305
06/05/19 14:57:58 31STK600 0310
Your vehicle is equipped with discbrakes at all four wheels. A powerassist using negative pressuregenerated by the engine and theelectric vacuum pump helps reducethe effort needed on the brake pedal.The anti-lock brake system (ABS)helps you retain steering controlwhen braking very hard.
All four brakes have audible brakewear indicators.
The hydraulic system that operatesthe brakes has two separate circuits.Each circuit works diagonally acrossthe vehicle (the left-front brake isconnected with the right-rear brake,etc.). If one circuit should develop aproblem, you will still have brakingat two wheels.
If the brake pads need replacing, youwill hear a distinctive, metallicscreeching sound when you applythe brake pedal. If you do not havethe brake pads replaced, they willscreech all the time. It is normal forthe brakes to occasionally squeal orsqueak when you apply them.
Resting your foot on the pedal keepsthe brakes applied lightly, builds upheat, and reduces their effectiveness.It also keeps your brake lights on allthe time, confusing drivers behindyou.
Constant application of the brakeswhen going down a long hill buildsup heat and reduces their effective-ness. Use the engine to assist thebrakes by taking your foot off theaccelerator and downshifting to alower gear.
Check your brakes after drivingthrough deep water. Apply thebrakes moderately to see if they feelnormal. If not, apply them gently andfrequently until they do. Be extracautious and alert in your driving.
When the electric vacuum pump is inoperation, it makes some mechanicalnoises come from the enginecompartment. This is normal.
When you drive in cold weather orthinner air at high altitude, theelectric vacuum pump operates morefrequently after the engine is started.
For more information about theelectric vacuum pump, see page .396
Braking System
Brake Pad Wear Indicators
Braking System Design
306
06/05/31 12:10:21 31STK600 0311
The anti-lock brake system (ABS)helps prevent the brakes fromlocking up, and helps you retainsteering control by pumping thebrakes rapidly, much faster than aperson can do it.
The ABS also balances the front-to-rear braking distribution accordingto vehicle loading.
Let the ABS work for you by alwayskeeping firm, steady pressure on thebrake pedal. This is sometimesreferred to as ‘‘stomp and steer.’’
You will feel a pulsation in the brakepedal when the ABS activates, andyou may hear some noise. This isnormal: it is the ABS rapidlypumping the brakes. On drypavement, you will need to press onthe brake pedal very hard before theABS activates. However, you mayfeel the ABS activate immediately ifyou are trying to stop on snow or ice.
If this indicator comes on, the anti-lock function of the braking systemhas shut down. The brakes still worklike a conventional system, butwithout anti-lock. You should haveyour dealer inspect your vehicle assoon as possible.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECK ABSSYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).85
You should never pump the brake pedal.On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
CONTINUED
ABS Indicator
Anti-lock Brakes (ABS)
Driving
307
06/05/19 14:58:14 31STK600 0312
If the ABS indicator and the brakesystem indicator come on together,and the parking brake is fullyreleased, the front-to-rear brakingdistribution system may also be shutdown.
Test your brakes as instructed onpage . If the brakes feel normal,drive slowly and have your vehiclerepaired by your dealer as soon aspossible. Avoid sudden hard brakingwhich could cause the rear wheels tolock up and possibly lead to a loss ofcontrol.
The VSA indicator will come onalong with the ABS indicator.
It only helps with thesteering control during braking.
such as trying to take acorner too fast or making a suddenlane change. Always drive at a safespeed for the road and weatherconditions.
Always steer moderatelywhen you are braking hard. Severeor sharp steering wheel movementcan still cause your vehicle to veerinto oncoming traffic or off the road.
on loose oruneven surfaces, such as gravel orsnow, than a vehicle without anti-lock.
395
Anti-lock Brakes (ABS)
Important Safety RemindersABS does not reduce the time ordistance it takes to stop thevehicle.
ABS will not prevent a skid thatresults from changing directionabruptly,
ABS cannot prevent a loss ofstability.
A vehicle with ABS may require alonger distance to stop
308
06/05/19 14:58:21 31STK600 0313
Your vehicle is equipped with a tirepressure monitoring system (TPMS)that turns on every time you start theengine and monitors the pressure inyour tires while driving.
Although your tire pressure ismonitored, you must manually checkthe tire pressures monthly.
Each tire, including the spare, shouldbe checked monthly when cold, andset to the recommended inflationpressure as specified on the vehicleplacard and in the owner’s manual(see page ).
Driving on a significantly under-inflated tire causes the tire tooverheat and can lead to tire failure.Under-inflation also reduces fuelefficiency and tire tread life, and mayaffect the vehicle’s handling andstopping ability.
When the low tire pressure indicatoris on, one or more of your tires issignificantly underinflated. Youshould stop and check your tires assoon as possible, and inflate them tothe proper pressure as indicated onthe vehicle’s tire information placard.
Each tire has its own pressuresensor. If the air pressure of a tirebecomes significantly low, thesensor in that tire immediately sendsa signal that causes the low tirepressure indicator to come on.
With this indicator on, you will seewhich tire is losing the pressure onthe multi-information display alongwith a ‘‘CHECK TIRE PRESSURE’’message (see page ).
With this indicator on, you will seewhich tire is losing the pressure onthe tire pressure monitor (see page
).
373
311
312
CONTINUED
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX model
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Low Tire PressureIndicator
Driving
309
06/06/16 19:37:01 31STK600 0314
Because tire pressure varies bytemperature and other conditions,the low tire pressure indicator maycome on unexpectedly.
For example, if you check and fillyour tires in a warm area, then drivein extremely cold weather, the tirepressure will be lower thanmeasured and could be underinflatedand cause the low tire pressureindicator to come on. Or, if youcheck and adjust your tire pressurein cooler conditions, and drive intoextremely hot conditions, the tiremay become overinflated. However,the low tire pressure indicator willnot come on if the tires areoverinflated.
Refer to page for tire inflationguidelines.
This indicator comes on and stays onif there is a problem with the tirepressure monitoring system.
If this happens, the system will shutoff and no longer monitor tirepressures. Have the system checkedby your dealer as soon as possible.
If you have a flat tire, the low tireindicator and tire pressure monitorwill come on. Replace the indicatedflat tire with the compact spare tire(see page ).
After you replace the flat tire withthe spare, the low tire pressureindicator stays on. This is normal;the system is not monitoring thespare tire pressure. Manually checkthe spare tire pressure to be sure itis correct.
Never use a puncture-repairing agentin a flat tire. If used, you will have toreplace the tire pressure sensor.Have the flat tire repaired by yourdealer as soon as possible.
383
372
On RDX model only
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Tire Pressure MonitoringSystem (TPMS) Indicator
Changing a Tire with TPMS
310
06/06/16 19:37:10 31STK600 0315
Each wheel is equipped with a tirepressure sensor mounted inside thetire behind the valve stem. You mustuse TPMS specific wheels. It isrecommended that you always haveyour tires serviced by your dealer orqualified technician.
Your vehicle has a tire pressuremonitor on the information display.
The tire pressure monitor uses thesame display as the door and tailgateopen monitor. When any of the tireshas low pressure, the low tirepressure indicator on the instrumentpanel comes on, and you will also seewhich tire is losing the pressure onthe tire pressure monitor.
If the TPMS indicator comes on, thetire pressure monitor does not work(see page ).
If the low tire pressure indicator andthe low tire position on the low tirepressure monitor do not go out afterinflating the tires to the specifiedvalues, have your dealer check thesystem as soon as possible.
73
CONTINUED
On RDX model
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Tire Pressure Monitor
Driving
311
LOW PRESSURE TIRE
06/06/16 19:37:16 31STK600 0316
▲ ▼To display the tire pressure monitor,press the INFO ( / ) button untilit appears on the multi-informationdisplay.
When all tire pressures are normal,the tire pressure monitor will show a‘‘TIRE PRESS. OK SYSTEM FUNCNORMAL’’ message.
When any of the tires have lowpressure, the low tire pressureindicator on the instrument panelcomes on, and the multi-informationdisplay also interrupts the currentdisplay and shows a ‘‘CHECK TIREPRESSURE’’ message. You can seeone or more of the low pressure tirepositions highlighted in the displayalong with this message.
When any of the tires have lowpressure, the tire pressure monitorshows a ‘‘TIRE PRESS. ERRORSYSTEM FUNC NORMAL’’message.
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
312
INFO BUTTONS
06/05/19 14:58:51 31STK600 0317
If one or more tires have lowpressure, the low tire pressureindicator on the instrument panelalso comes on (see page ).
It is possible that the pressuresshown on the multi-informationdisplay and the pressures youmanually measure are slightlydifferent.If the difference is significant or youcannot make the low tire pressureindicator and message on the multi-information display go out afterinflating the tires to the specifiedvalues, have your dealer check thesystem as soon as possible.When the TPMS is functioning
normally, you can see the tirepressure readings of each tire in psi(U.S. models) or kPa (Canadianmodels) by pressing the SEL/RESET button while the multi-information display shows the tirepressure monitor.
If there is a problem with the TPMS,the multi-information display showsa ‘‘CHECK TPMS SYSTEM’’message.
73
CONTINUED
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
Tire Pressure Readings Check TPMS System Message
Driving
313
U. S.
Canada
SEL/RESET BUTTON
06/05/19 14:58:59 31STK600 0318
If the low tire pressure indicatorcomes on, or the multi-informationdisplay shows a ‘‘CHECK TPMSSYSTEM’’ message, the VSA systemautomatically turns on even whenthe VSA system is turned off bypressing the VSA OFF switch (seepage ). If this happens, youcannot turn the VSA system off bypressing the VSA OFF switch again.
If you see this message, the tirepressure monitor shows a ‘‘SYSTEMFUNCTION ERROR’’ message. Thesystem may not be able to detect orsignal low tire pressure as intended.Also, the tire pressure readings willnot be displayed. Have your vehiclechecked by a dealer as soon aspossible.
316
As required by the FCC:This device complies with Part 15 of theFCC rules. Operation is subject to thefollowing two conditions: (1) This devicemay not cause harmful interference, and(2) this device must accept anyinterference received, includinginterference that may cause undesiredoperation.
Changes or modifications not expresslyapproved by the party responsible forcompliance could void the user’sauthority to operate the equipment.
This device complies with IndustryCanada Standard RSS-210.Operation is subject to the following twoconditions: (1) this device may not causeinterference, and (2) this device mustaccept any interference that may causeundesired operation of the device.
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS)
314
06/05/19 14:59:05 31STK600 0319
The VSA system cannot enhance thevehicle’s driving stability in allsituations and does not control yourvehicle’s entire braking system. It isstill your responsibility to drive andcorner at reasonable speeds and toleave a sufficient margin of safety.
The vehicle stability assist (VSA)system helps to stabilize the vehicleduring cornering if the vehicle turnsmore or less than desired. It alsoassists you in maintaining tractionwhile accelerating on loose orslippery road surfaces. It does thisby regulating the engine’s output andby selectively applying the brakes.
When VSA activates, you may noticethat the engine does not respond tothe accelerator in the same way itdoes at other times. You will also seethe VSA activation indicator blink.
When VSA activates, you will see theVSA activation indicator blink (seepage ).
If this indicator comes on whiledriving, pull to the side of the roadwhen it is safe, and turn off theengine. Reset the system byrestarting the engine. If the VSAsystem indicator stays on, or comesback on while driving, have the VSAsystem inspected by your dealer.
If the indicator does not come onwhen the ignition switch is turned tothe ON (II) position, there may be aproblem with the VSA system. Haveyour dealer inspect your vehicle assoon as possible.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECK VSASYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
Without VSA, your vehicle will havenormal braking and cornering ability,but it will not have VSA traction andstability enhancement.
When you put a spare tire on thewheel, TPMS indicator or ‘‘CHECKTPMS SYSTEM’’ message(depending on the models) maycome on. When the indicator ormessage is on, you are unable to turnoff the VSA system with the VSAOFF switch.
70 85
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
VSA Activation Indicator
Vehicle Stability Assist(VSA) System Indicator
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System
Driving
315
06/05/19 14:59:15 31STK600 0320
This switch is under the driver’s sidevent. To turn the VSA system on andoff, press and hold it until you hear abeep.
When VSA is off, the VSA activationindicator comes on as a reminder.
VSA is turned on every time youstart the engine, even if you turned itoff the last time you drove thevehicle.
Driving with varying tire or wheelsizes may cause the VSA tomalfunction. When replacing tires,make sure they are the same sizeand type as your original tires (seepage ).
If you install winter tires, make surethey are the same size as those thatwere originally supplied with yourvehicle. Exercise the same cautionduring winter driving as you would ifyour vehicle was not equipped withVSA.
In certain unusual conditions whenyour vehicle gets stuck in shallowmud or fresh snow, it may be easierto free it with the VSA temporarilyswitched off. When the VSA systemis off, the traction control system isalso off. You should only attempt tofree your vehicle with the VSA off ifyou are not able to free it when theVSA is on.
Immediately after freeing yourvehicle, be sure to switch the VSA onagain. We do not recommend drivingyour vehicle with the VSA andtraction control systems switched off.
376
Vehicle Stability Assist (VSA) System
VSA Off Switch VSA and Tire Sizes
316
VSA OFF SWITCH
06/06/16 19:37:25 31STK600 0321
Your vehicle has been designedprimarily to carry passengers andtheir cargo. You can also use it totow a trailer if you carefully observethe load limits, use the properequipment, and follow the guidelinesin this section.
Be sure to read thesection on page
if you plan to tow off pavedsurfaces.
Themaximum allowable weight of thetrailer and everything in or on itmust not exceed 1,500 lbs (680 kg).Towing a load that is too heavy canseriously affect your vehicle’shandling and performance. It canalso damage the engine anddrivetrain.
The weight that thetongue of a fully-loaded trailer putson the hitch should be approximately10 % of the total trailer weight. Toomuch tongue load reduces front-tiretraction and steering control. Toolittle tongue load can make thetrailer unstable and cause it to sway.
324
CONTINUED
Off-HighwayDriving Guidelines
Load Limits
Total Trailer Weight: Tongue Load:
Towing a Trailer
Driving
317
Exceeding any load limit orimproperly loading your vehicleand trailer can cause a crash inwhich you can be seriously hurtor killed.
Check the loading of yourvehicle and trailer carefullybefore starting to drive.
06/05/19 14:59:31 31STK600 0322
-
-
-To achieve a proper tongue load,start by loading 60 % of the loadtoward the front of the trailer and40 % toward the rear, then re-adjustthe load as needed.
The maximumallowable weight of the vehicle, alloccupants, all accessories, all cargo,and the tongue load is 4,894 lbs(2,220 kg).
The maximumallowable weight of the vehicle, alloccupants, all accessories, all cargo,and the tongue load must not exceed2,546 lbs (1,155 kg) on the front axle,and 2,381 lbs (1,080 kg) on the rearaxle.
The maximumallowable weight of the fully loadedvehicle and trailer is 6,394 lbs (2,900kg)
Towing can require a variety ofequipment, depending on the size ofyour trailer, how it will be used, howmuch load you are towing, andwhere you tow.
Discuss your needs with your trailersales or rental agency, and follow theguidelines in this section. Also makesure that all equipment is properlyinstalled and maintained, and that itmeets federal, state, province, andlocal regulations.
If you normally pull the same loadeach time you tow a trailer, you canuse a suitable scale or a specialtongue load gauge to check thetongue load the first time you set upa towing combination (a fully loadedvehicle and trailer), then recheck thetongue load whenever the conditionschange.
The best way to confirm that allloads are within limits is to checkthem at a public scale. For publicscales in your area, check your localphone book, or contact your trailerdealer or rental agency forassistance.
If you cannot get to a public scale,you can estimate the total trailerweight by adding the weight of yourtrailer (as quoted by themanufacturer) with everything in oron the trailer.
Gross Vehicle Weight Rating(GVWR)
Gross Axle Weight Ratings(GAWR)
Gross Combined Weight Rating(GCWR)
Towing Equipment andAccessories
Checking Loads
Towing a Trailer
318
06/05/19 14:59:39 31STK600 0323
Trailer lights and equipment mustcomply with federal, state, province,and local regulations. Check withyour local trailer sales or rentalagencies for the requirements in thearea where you plan to tow, and useonly equipment designed for yourvehicle.
Acura requires that any trailer with atotal trailer weight of 1,000 lbs (455kg) or more have its own brakes.
If you choose electric brakes, besure they are electronically actuated.Do not attempt to tap into yourvehicle’s hydraulic system. Nomatter how successful it may seem,any attempt to attach trailer brakesto your vehicle’s hydraulic systemwill lower braking effectiveness andcreate a potential hazard.
See your trailer dealer or rentalagency for more information oninstalling electric brakes.
Any hitch used on your vehicle mustbe properly bolted to the underbody.
Always use safety chains when youtow a trailer. Make sure the chainsare secured to the trailer and hitch,and that they cross under the tongueand can catch the trailer if itbecomes unhitched. Leave enoughslack to allow the trailer to turncorners easily, but do not let thechains drag on the ground.
CONTINUED
Trailer LightsTrailer BrakesHitches
Safety Chains
Towing a Trailer
Driving
319
06/05/19 14:59:47 31STK600 0324
Many states and Canadian provincesrequire special outside mirrors whentowing a trailer. Even if they don’t,you should install special mirrors ifyou cannot clearly see behind you, orif the trailer creates a blind spot.
Ask your trailer sales or rentalagency if any other items arerecommended or required for yourtowing situation.
Since lighting and wiring vary bytrailer type and brand, you shouldhave a qualified technician install asuitable connector between thevehicle and the trailer. Improperequipment or installation can causedamage to your vehicle’s electricalsystem and affect your vehiclewarranty.
Your vehicle has a trailer lightingconnector located under the rightside tool case in the cargo area.Refer to the drawing above for thewiring color code and purpose ofeach pin.
Additional Towing Equipment
Towing a Trailer
320
GROUND(BLACK)
HAZARDLIGHT(ORANGE)
LEFT TURNSIGNAL(YELLOW)
RIGHT TURNSIGNAL(BROWN)
BRAKELIGHT(LIGHTGREEN)
TAILLIGHT(RED)
06/05/19 14:59:54 31STK600 0325
The lights and brakes on yourvehicle and the trailer are workingproperly.
When preparing to tow, and beforedriving away, be sure to check thefollowing:
The trailer has been properlyserviced and is in good condition.
All weights and loads are withinlimits.
The hitch, safety chains, and anyother attachments are secure.
All items in or on the trailer areproperly secured and cannot shiftwhile you drive.
Your vehicle tires and spare areproperly inflated, and the trailertires and spare are inflated asrecommended by the trailermaker.
You may want to fill the fuel tankwith premium fuel. Premium fuelprovides improved performance.
The vehicle has been properlyserviced, and the suspension,cooling system, and lights are ingood operating condition.
Pre-Tow Checklist
Towing a Trailer
Driving
321
06/05/19 15:00:02 31STK600 0326
When climbing hills, closely watchyour temperature gauge (see pages
and ). If it nears the H (Hot)mark, turn the A/C off, reducespeed and, if necessary, pull to theside of the road to let the engine cool.
When driving down hills, reduceyour speed, and shift down to Sposition, or use the puddle shift tothe lower gear (3, 2 or 1)in the Sposition. When towing a trailer, donot ‘‘ride’’ the brakes, and remember,it will take longer to slow down andstop when towing a trailer.
Drive slower than normal in alldriving situations, and obey postedspeed limits for vehicles with trailers.Use the D position when towing atrailer on level roads. See ‘‘
’’ in the next column foradditional gear information. Do notexceed 55 mph (88 km/h). At higherspeeds, the trailer may sway oraffect vehicle handling.
Make turns more slowly and widerthan normal. The trailer tracks asmaller arc than your vehicle, and itcan hit or run over something thevehicle misses. Allow more time anddistance for braking. Do not brake orturn suddenly as this could cause thetrailer to jackknife or turn over.
The added weight, length, andheight of a trailer will affect yourvehicle’s handling and performance,so driving with a trailer requiressome special driving skills andtechniques.
For your safety and the safety ofothers, take time to practice drivingmaneuvers before heading for theopen road, and follow the guidelinesin this section.
8378
Driving on HillsTowing Speeds and Gears
Driving onHills
Making Turns and Braking
Driving Safely With a Trailer
Towing a Trailer
322
06/05/19 15:00:10 31STK600 0327
If you must stop when facing uphill,use the foot brake or parking brake.Do not try to hold the vehicle inplace by pressing on the accelerator,as this can cause the automatictransmission to overheat.
Crosswinds and air turbulencecaused by passing trucks can disruptyour steering and cause the trailer tosway. When being passed by a largevehicle, keep a constant speed, andsteer straight ahead. Do not try tomake quick steering or brakingcorrections.
Always drive slowly and havesomeone guide you when backing up.Grip the of the steeringwheel; then turn the wheel to the leftto get the trailer to move to the left,and turn the wheel right to move thetrailer to the right.
Follow all normal precautions whenparking, including putting thetransmission in Park and firmlysetting the parking brake. Also, placewheel chocks at each of the trailer’stires.
bottom
Handling Crosswinds and Buffeting
Backing Up
Parking
Towing a Trailer
Driving
323
06/05/19 15:00:16 31STK600 0328
To avoid loss of control or rollover,be sure to follow all precautions andrecommendations.
Wherever you drive, make sureyou and your passengers alwayswear seat belts.
Keep your speed low, and nevergo faster than the conditions allow.
It’s up to you to continually assessthe situation and drive within thelimits.
Be sure to store cargo properly,and do not exceed your vehiclecargo load limits (see pages
and ).
Your vehicle has been designedprimarily for use on pavement. Butits higher ground clearance andsuper handling-all wheel drive (SH-AWD) system allow you tooccasionally travel on unpaved roads,to campgrounds, picnic sites, andsimilar locations. It is not designedfor trailblazing, mountain climbing,or other challenging off-roadactivities.
If you decide to drive on unpavedroads, you will find that it requiressomewhat different driving skills.Your vehicle will also handlesomewhat differently than it does onpavement. So be sure to read thisowner’s manual, pay special attentionto the precautions and tips in thissection, and get acquainted withyour vehicle before you leave thepavement.
288 317
General Information Important Safety Precautions
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines
324
Follow all instructions andguidelines in this owner’smanual.Keep your speed low, anddon’t drive faster thanconditions permit.
Improperly operating thisvehicle on or off pavement cancause an accident or rollover inwhich you and your passengerscould be seriously injured orkilled.
06/06/16 19:37:34 31STK600 0329
Before you leave the pavement, besure to do all scheduled maintenanceand service, and inspect your vehiclefor any problems. Pay specialattention to the condition of the tires,and check the tire pressures.
After you return to the pavement,carefully inspect your vehicle tomake sure there is no damage thatcould make driving it unsafe.Recheck the condition of the tiresand the tire pressures.
The route presents limits (too steepor bumpy roads). You have limits(driving skill and comfort). And yourvehicle has limits (traction, stability,and power).
Driving off-highway can behazardous if you fail to recognizelimits and take the properprecautions.
Debris in the road can damage yoursuspension or other components.Because your vehicle has a highcenter of gravity, driving over a largeobstacle, or allowing a wheel to dropinto a deep hole can cause yourvehicle to tip or roll over.
If you can’t clearly see all conditionsor obstacles on a slope, walk theslope before you drive on it. If youhave any doubt whether or not youcan safely drive on the slope, don’tdo it. Find another route.
If you are driving up a hill and findthat you cannot continue,
. Your vehicle could rollover. Slowly back down the hill,following the same route you took upthe hill.
For better traction on all surfaces,accelerate slowly and gradually buildup speed. If you try to start too faston wet soil, mud, snow, or ice, youmight not have enough traction toget underway, and you may digyourself a hole. Starting with theshift lever in D position will help youhave a smoother start on snow or ice.
Keep in mind that you will usuallyneed more time and distance tobrake to a stop on unpaved surfaces.Avoid hard braking. Do not ‘‘pump’’the brakes; let the anti-lock brakingsystem pump them for you.
do not try toturn around
Check Out Your Vehicle
Remember
Accelerating and Braking Avoiding Obstacles
Driving on Slopes
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines
Driving
325
06/05/19 15:00:35 31STK600 0330
Avoid driving through deep water. Ifyou encounter water in your route (asmall stream or large puddle, forexample), evaluate it carefully beforegoing ahead. Make sure it is shallow,flowing slowly, and has firm groundunderneath. If you are not sure ofthe depth or the ground, turn aroundand find another route.
Driving through deep water can alsodamage your vehicle. The water canget into the transmission anddifferential, diluting the lubricantand causing an eventual failure. Itcan also wash the grease out of thewheel bearings.
Avoid driving on soft sand, deep mud,or other surfaces where you couldget stuck. If you do happen to getstuck because of inclement weatheror other conditions, choose a safeand appropriate course of action.
You should never use a jack to trygetting unstuck. A jack only workson firm, level ground. Also, yourvehicle could easily slip off the jackand hurt you or someone else.
If you spin the wheels excessivelytrying to get unstuck, you mayoverheat the components of the SH-AWD system. The SH-AWDindicator on the instrument panel willblink to indicate the rear differentialtemperature is too high.
You will also see an ‘‘SH-AWD DIFFTEMP HIGH’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
If this happens, stop and alloweverything to cool down. The SH-AWD indicator goes off after therear differential temperature drops.
85
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
If You Get StuckCrossing a Stream
Off-Highway Driving Guidelines
326
06/05/19 15:00:43 31STK600 0331
This section explains why it isimportant to keep your vehicle wellmaintained and how to follow basicmaintenance safety precautions.
This section also includesinstructions on how to read themaintenance minder messages onthe information display or multi-information display (depending onmodels), a maintenance record, andinstructions for simple maintenancetasks you may want to take care ofyourself.
If you have the skills and tools toperform more complex maintenancetasks on your vehicle, you may wantto purchase the service manual. Seepage for information on how toobtain a copy, or see your dealer.
......................Maintenance Safety . 328....................Maintenance Minder . 330....................Maintenance Record . 344
All service items not detailed in thissection should be performed by acertified technician or other qualifiedmechanic.
To eliminate potential hazards, readthe instructions before you begin,and make sure you have the toolsand skills required.
Make sure your vehicle is parkedon level ground, the parking brakeis set, and the engine is off.
To clean parts, use a commerciallyavailable degreaser or partscleaner, not gasoline.
To reduce the possibility of fire orexplosion, keep cigarettes, sparks,and flames away from the batteryand all fuel-related parts.
Wear eye protection andprotective clothing when workingwith the battery or compressed air.
Maintenance Safety
Important Safety Precautions
328
Improperly maintaining thisvehicle, or failing to correct aproblem before driving cancause a crash in which you canbe seriously hurt or killed.
Always follow the inspectionand maintenancerecommendations andschedules in this owner’smanual.
06/05/19 15:00:55 31STK600 0333
Some of the most important safetyprecautions are given here. However,we cannot warn you of everyconceivable hazard that can arise inperforming maintenance. Only youcan decide whether or not youshould perform a given task.
Donot run the engine unlessinstructed to do so.
Be sure there isadequate ventilation whenever youoperate the engine.
Let theengine and exhaust system cooldown before touching any parts.
Failure to properly followmaintenance instructions andprecautions can cause you tobe seriously hurt or killed.
Always follow the proceduresand precautions in this owner’smanual.
06/05/19 15:01:01 31STK600 0334
------------
Your vehicle displays engine oil lifeand maintenance service items onthe information display or multi-information display (depending onmodels) to show you when youshould have your dealer performengine oil replacement and indicatedmaintenance services.
Based on the engine operatingconditions and accumulated enginerevolutions, the onboard computer inyour vehicle calculates the remainingengine oil life and displays it as apercentage.
The remaining engine oil life isshown on the display according tothis table:
To see the current engine oil life,turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position, and press the Select/Reset knob repeatedly until theengine oil life display appears (seepage ).76
The 15 and 10 percent oil lifeindicator reminds you that the timeis coming soon to take your vehiclein for the required maintenance.
If the remaining engine oil life is 15to 6 percent, you will see the engineoil life indicator every time you turnthe ignition switch to the ON (II)position. The maintenance minderindicator will also come on, and themaintenance item code(s) for otherscheduled maintenance itemsneeding service will be displayednear the ‘‘OIL LIFE’’ message.
When the remaining engine oil life is5 to 1 percent, you will see a‘‘SERVICE’’ message along with thesame maintenance item code(s),every time you turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position.
CONTINUED
Maintenance Minder
Maintenance
331
MAINTENANCE MINDER INDICATOR ‘‘SERVICE’’ MESSAGE
ENGINE OIL LIFE INDICATOR
MAINTENANCE ITEM CODE(S)
06/06/16 19:37:47 31STK600 0336
The maintenance item code or codesindicate the main and sub itemsrequired at the time of the oil change(see page ).
You can switch the informationdisplay from the engine oil lifedisplay to the odometer or the tripmeter. Press and release the Select/Reset knob on the instrument panel.
When the engine oil life is 15 to 1percent, the maintenance minderindicator ( ) comes on everytime you turn the ignition switch tothe ON (II) position, then it goes outif you switch the information display.
When you see this message, havethe indicated maintenanceperformed by your dealer as soon aspossible.
When the remaining engine oil life is0 percent, the engine oil life indicatorwill blink. The display comes onevery time you turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position. Themaintenance minder indicator( ) also comes on and remainson in the instrument panel. Whenyou see this message, immediatelyhave the indicated maintenanceperformed by your dealer.
If you do not perform the indicatedmaintenance, negative mileage isdisplayed and begins to blink afterthe vehicle has been driven 10 miles(10 km) or more.
Negative mileage means yourvehicle has passed the maintenancerequired point.
Immediately have the indicatedmaintenance done by your dealer.
333
Maintenance Minder
332
06/06/16 19:37:57 31STK600 0337
To change the information displayfrom the engine oil life display to theodometer or the trip meter, pressand release the Select/Reset knob.
Immediately have the serviceperformed, and make sure to resetthe display as described on thefollowing.
All maintenance items displayed inthe information display are in code.For an explanation of thesemaintenance codes, see page .
Your dealer will reset the displayafter completing the requiredmaintenance service. You will see‘‘OIL LIFE 100%’’ on the informationdisplay the next time you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position.
If maintenance service is done bysomeone other than your dealer,reset the maintenance minder asfollows:
Press the Select/Reset knobrepeatedly until the engine oil lifeis displayed.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position.
When the engine oil life is 0 percentor negative mileage, themaintenance minder indicator( ) remains on even if youchange the information display.
1.
2.343
Maintenance Main Items and SubItems
Resetting the Engine Oil LifeDisplay
Maintenance Minder
Maintenance
333
MAINTENANCE MAIN ITEM
MAINTENANCE SUB ITEM(S)
06/05/19 15:01:33 31STK600 0338
▲ ▼
Press and hold the Select/Resetknob for about 10 seconds. Theengine oil life and the maintenanceitem code(s) will blink.
Press the Select/Reset knob foranother 5 seconds. Themaintenance item code(s) willdisappear, and the engine oil lifewill reset to ‘‘100.’’
To see the current engine oil life,turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position, and push and releasethe INFO ( / ) button on thesteering wheel repeatedly, until theengine oil life is displayed (see page
).
3. 4.
80
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Maintenance Minder
334
ENGINE OILLIFE DISPLAY
SEL/RESET BUTTON
INFOBUTTONS
06/06/16 19:38:04 31STK600 0339
▲ ▼
CONTINUED
When the remaining engine oil life is15 percent or less, the display showsa ‘‘SERVICE DUE SOON’’ messagealong with the maintenance itemcode(s) for other scheduledmaintenance items needing service.
The system message indicator onthe instrument panel will also comeon, and a beeper will sound.
To cancel the system message, pressand release the INFO ( / ) buttonon the steering wheel. At this time,the system message indicator willalso be turned off. Then the displaywill change to the engine oil lifedisplay. You will see themaintenance item code(s) along withthe engine oil life on the multi-information display.
Maintenance Minder
Maintenance
335
SYSTEM MESSAGE INDICATOR
MAINTENANCE ITEM CODE(S)
06/05/19 15:01:47 31STK600 0340
You will also see the systemmessage every time you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position until your vehicle have theindicated maintenance performed byyour dealer.
The maintenance item code(s)indicate the main and sub itemsrequired at the time of the oil change(see page ).
The system message indicator onthe instrument panel will also comeon, and a beeper will sound.
When the remaining engine oil life isless than 5 percent, you will see theabove display. The display thenchanges to ‘‘SERVICE DUE NOW.’’Have the indicated maintenancedone as soon as possible.
340
Maintenance Minder
336
06/06/16 19:45:49 31STK600 0341
▲ ▼
You will also see the systemmessage every time you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position until your vehicle have theindicated maintenance performed byyour dealer.
If the indicated maintenance serviceis not done and the engine oil lifereaches to 0 percent, you will see a‘‘SERVICE PAST DUE’’ messagealong with the maintenance itemcode(s) on the multi-informationdisplay.
To cancel the system message, pressand release the INFO ( / ) buttonon the steering wheel. At this time,the system message indicator willalso be turned off. Then the displaywill change to the engine oil lifedisplay. You will see a ‘‘SERVICE’’message and along with themaintenance item code(s) on themulti-information display.
CONTINUED
Maintenance Minder
Maintenance
337
06/05/19 15:01:58 31STK600 0342
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
When you see this message, havethe indicated maintenance done byyour dealer immediately.
The system message indicator onthe instrument panel will also comeon, and a beeper will sound.
The system message will appearagain by pressing the INFO ( / )button after cancel it.
You will also see the systemmessage every time you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position until your vehicle have theindicated maintenance performed byyour dealer.
To cancel the system message, pressand release the INFO ( / ) buttonon the steering wheel. At this time,the system message indicator will
be turned off. Then the displaywill change to the engine oil lifedisplay. You will see the engine oillife blinking and a ‘‘SERVICE’’message along with the maintenanceitem code(s) on the multi-information display.
Maintenance Minder
not
338
06/05/19 15:02:04 31STK600 0343
▲ ▼
▲ ▼
The system message will appearagain by pressing the INFO ( / )button after cancel it.
You will also see the systemmessage every time you turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position until your vehicle have theindicated maintenance performed byyour dealer.
Negative mileage means yourvehicle has passed the maintenancerequired point.If the indicated maintenance is not
performed, you will see a " SERVICEPAST DUE" message along with themaintenance item code(s), and thenegative mileage will be also displayed. The negative mileagecontinues to display after the vehiclehas been driven 10 miles (10 km) ormore.
To cancel the system message, pressand release the INFO ( / ) buttonon the steering wheel. At this time,the system message indicator will
be turned off. Then the displaywill change to the engine oil lifedisplay. You will see the negativemileage blinking and a ‘‘SERVICE’’message along with the maintenanceitem code(s) on the multi-information display.
Immediately have the serviceperformed, and make sure to resetthe display as described on thefollowing.
Maintenance Minder
not
Maintenance
339
U.S.U.S.
Canada Canada
06/05/19 15:02:12 31STK600 0344
All maintenance items displayed inthe information display are in code.For an explanation of thesemaintenance codes, see page .
Press and hold the SEL/RESETbutton on the steering wheel formore than 10 seconds. Theremaining engine oil life resetmode will be shown on the multi-information display.
Press the SEL/RESET button onthe steering wheel until you seethe engine oil life display.
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position.
If maintenance service is done bysomeone other than your dealer,reset the maintenance minder asfollows:
Your dealer will reset the displayafter completing the requiredmaintenance service. You will see‘‘OIL LIFE 100%’’ on the display thenext time you turn the ignitionswitch to the ON (II) position.
1.
2.
3.
343
Maintenance Minder
Maintenance Main Items and SubItems
Resetting the Engine Oil LifeDisplay
340
MAINTENANCE MAIN ITEM
MAINTENANCE SUB ITEM(S)
06/05/19 15:02:21 31STK600 0345
▲ ▼Select ‘‘RESET’’ by pressing theINFO ( / ) button, then pressthe SEL/RESET button to resetthe engine oil life display. Themaintenance item code(s) willdisappear, and the engine oil lifewill reset to ‘‘100.’’ If you want tocancel the oil life reset mode,select ‘‘CANCEL.’’
If you have the required servicedone but do not reset the display, orreset the display without doing theservice, the system will not show theproper maintenance intervals. Thiscan lead to serious mechanicalproblems because you will no longerhave an accurate record of whenmaintenance is needed.
Your authorized Acura dealer knowsyour vehicle best and can providecompetent, efficient service.
However, service at a dealer is notmandatory to keep your warrantiesin effect. Maintenance may be doneby any qualified service facility orperson who is skilled in this type ofautomotive service. Make sure tohave the service facility or personreset the display as previouslydescribed. Keep all receipts as proofof completion, and have the personwho does the work fill out themaintenance record. Check yourwarranty booklet for moreinformation.
We recommend using Acura partsand fluids whenever you havemaintenance done. These aremanufactured to the same high-quality standards as the originalcomponents, so you can be confidentof their performance and durability.
4.
Important MaintenancePrecautions
Maintenance Minder
Maintenance
341
06/05/19 15:02:27 31STK600 0346
#
-
-
-
-
-
-
U.S. Vehicles:
According to state and federalregulations, failure to performmaintenance on the items markedwith will not void your emissionswarranties. However, allmaintenance services should beperformed in accordance with theintervals indicated by theinformation display.
You should check the followingitems at the specified intervals. Ifyou are unsure of how to performany check, turn to the appropriatepage listed.
Engine oil level Check everytime you fill the fuel tank. Seepage .
Engine coolant level Check theradiator reserve tank every timeyou fill the fuel tank. See page .
Automatic transmission Checkthe fluid level monthly. See page
.
Brakes Check the fluid levelmonthly. See page .
Tires Check the tire pressuremonthly. Examine the tread forwear and foreign objects. See page
Maintenance,replacement, or repair ofemissions control devices andsystems may be done by anyautomotive repair establishmentor individual using parts that are‘‘certif ied’’ to EPA standards.
Owner’s Maintenance Checks
342
06/06/16 19:45:57 31STK600 0347
*
*
#
#
#
*
Maintenance Minder
343
:
Maintenance Main ItemsReplace engine oilReplace engine oil and oil filterInspect front and rear brakesCheck parking brake adjustmentInspect these items:
Tie rod ends, steering gear box, and bootsSuspension componentsDriveshaft bootsBrake hoses and lines (including ABS)All fluid levels and condition of fluidsExhaust systemFuel lines and connections
Maintenance Sub ItemsRotate tiresReplace air cleaner element
If you drive in dusty conditions, replaceevery 15,000 miles (24,000 km).
Replace dust and pollen filterIf you drive primarily in urban areas that have highconcentrations of soot in the air from industry andfrom diesel-powered vehicles, replace every 15,000miles (24,000 km).
Inspect drive beltReplace transmission and transfer fluid
Driving in mountainous areas at very low vehiclespeeds or trailer towing results in highertransmission and transfer temperatures. Thisrequires transmission and transfer fluid changesmore frequently than recommended by themaintenance minder. If you regularly drive yourvehicle under these conditions, have the transmissionand transfer fluid changed at 60,000 miles(100,000 km), then every 30,000 miles (48,000 km).
Driving in mountainous areas at very low vehiclespeeds or trailer towing results in higher level ofmechanical (shear) stress to fluid. This requiresdifferential fluid changes more frequently thanrecommended by the Maintenance Minder. If youregularly drive your vehicle under these conditions,have the differential fluid changed at 7,500 miles(12,000 km), then every 15,000 miles (24,000 km).
AB
Symbol Symbol12
3
4
56
1
1
If the message ‘‘SERVICE’’ does not appear more than 12 months after thedisplay is reset, change the engine oil every year.
If the message ‘‘SERVICE DUE NOW’’ does not appear more than 12 monthsafter the display is reset, change the engine oil every year.
See information on maintenance and emissions warranty on page .
Adjust the valves during services A, B, 1, 2, or 3 only if they are noisy.Inspect idle speed every 160,000 miles (256,000 km).
Independent of the maintenance items in the information display, replacethe brake fluid every 3 years.
NOTE:
1 :
342
On RDX model
On RDX with Technology Package model
Main
tenance
Min
der
06/05/19 15:02:44 31STK600 0348
Maintenance Record
344
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
Mileage
km
km
km
km
km
km
km
Signature
Date
Mileage
km
km
km
km
km
km
km
Signature
Date
MaintenancePerformed
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
MaintenancePerformed
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
You or the servicing dealer can record all completed maintenance here. When maintenance is performed, record the mileage, circle the coded item(s)completed, and write in any other non-coded items (such as brake fluid replacement) below the codes. Keep the receipts for all work done on yourvehicle. Maintenance can also be recorded in your-Acura maintenance journal.
06/05/19 15:02:51 31STK600 0349
Maintenance Record
Maintenance
345
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
mi
Signature
Date
Mileage
km
km
km
km
km
km
km
Mileage
km
km
km
km
km
km
km
Signature
Date
MaintenancePerformed
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
MaintenancePerformed
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
A B 1 2 3 4 5 6
06/05/19 15:02:56 31STK600 0350
Fluid Locations
346
ENGINECOOLANTRESERVOIR
RADIATOR CAP
WASHER FLUID(Blue cap)
AUTOMATICTRANSMISSIONFLUID DIPSTICK(Yellow loop)
BRAKE FLUID(Black cap)
ENGINE OILDIPSTICK(Orange loop)
ENGINE OILFILL CAP
POWER STEERINGFLUID(Red cap)
06/05/19 19:21:58 31STK600 0351
Unscrew and remove the engine oilfill cap on top of the valve cover.Pour in the oil slowly and carefully soyou do not spill. Clean up any spillsimmediately. Spilled oil coulddamage components in the enginecompartment.
Reinstall the engine oil fill cap, andtighten it securely. Wait a fewminutes, and recheck the oil level onthe engine oil dipstick. Do not fillabove the upper mark; you coulddamage the engine.
Oil is a major contributor to yourengine’s performance and longevity.Your vehicle is equipped with a high-performance turbocharged enginethat requires the use of syntheticmotor oil. Always use Mobil 15W-30 or an equivalent oil that meetsthe Acura HTO-06 standard. Not allsynthetic oils will meet this standard.Only use oils that display the HTO-06 standard on the label.
Failure to use Mobil 1 or anequivalent oil that meets the HTO-06standard can lead to a reduction inengine performance or durability,and can cause engine damage notcovered by your warranty.
Adding Engine Oil Required Engine Oil
Adding Engine Oil
Maintenance
347
ENGINE OIL FILL CAP
06/05/19 15:03:07 31STK600 0352
The oil viscosity or weight isprovided on the container’s label.5W-30 oil is formulated for year-round protection of your vehicle toimprove cold weather starting andfuel economy.
Your vehicle does not require any oiladditives. Additives may adverselyaffect the engine or transmissionperformance and durability.
Adding Engine Oil
Engine Oil Additives
348
Ambient Temperature
06/05/19 15:03:12 31STK600 0353
Always change the oil and filteraccording to the maintenancemessages shown on the informationdisplay or multi-information display(depending on models). The oil andfilter collect contaminants that candamage your engine if they are notremoved regularly.
Run the engine until it reachesnormal operating temperature,then shut it off.
Open the hood, and remove theengine oil fill cap. Remove the oildrain bolt and washer from thebottom of the engine. Drain the oilinto an appropriate container.
Remove the oil filter, and let theremaining oil drain. A specialwrench (available from yourdealer) is required.
Install a new oil filter according tothe instructions that come with it.
Check the oil filter to make sureits gasket did not stick to the filterbase. A stuck gasket could causean oil leak.
Changing the oil and filter requiresspecial tools and access fromunderneath the vehicle. The vehicleshould be raised on a service station-type hydraulic lift for this service.Unless you have the knowledge andproper equipment, you should havethis maintenance done by a skilledtechnician.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Changing the Oil and Filter
Maintenance
349
WASHER
OILFILTER
OIL DRAINBOLT
06/05/19 15:03:20 31STK600 0354
Put a new washer on the drain bolt,then reinstall the drain bolt.Tighten the drain bolt to:
Refill the engine with the recom-mended oil.
Engine oil change capacity(including filter):
Turn off the engine and let it sitfor several minutes, then checkthe oil level on the dipstick. Ifnecessary, add more oil.
Let the engine run for severalminutes, then check the drain boltand oil filter for leaks.
Replace the engine oil fill cap.Start the engine. The oil pressureindicator should go out within 5seconds. If it does not, turn off theengine, and check your work.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
Changing the Oil and Filter
350
29 lbf·ft (39 N·m , 4.0 kgf·m)
4.9 US qt (4.6 )
Improper disposal of engine oil can beharmf ul to the environment. If youchange your own oil, please dispose ofthe used oil properly. Put it in a sealedcontainer and take it to a recyclingcenter. Do not discard it in a trash binor dump it on the ground.
06/05/19 15:03:26 31STK600 0355
If Honda antifreeze/coolant is notavailable, you may use anothermajor-brand non-silicate coolant as atemporary replacement. Make sure itis a high-quality coolantrecommended for aluminum engines.Continued use of any non-Hondacoolant can result in corrosion,causing the cooling system tomalfunction or fail. Have the coolingsystem flushed and refilled withHonda antifreeze/coolant as soon aspossible.
If the reserve tank is completelyempty, you should also check thecoolant level in the radiator.
If the coolant level in the reservetank is at or below the MIN line, addcoolant to bring it up to the MAX line.Inspect the cooling system for leaks.
Always use Honda Long-life Anti-freeze/Coolant Type 2. This coolantis pre-mixed with 50 percentantifreeze and 50 percent water.Never add straight antifreeze orplain water.
Adding Engine Coolant
Engine Coolant
Maintenance
351
RESERVE TANK
MAX
MIN
Removing the radiator capwhile the engine is hot cancause the coolant to spray out,seriously scalding you.
Always let the engine andradiator cool down beforeremoving the radiator cap.
06/05/19 15:03:34 31STK600 0356
The coolant level should be up tothe base of the filler neck. Addcoolant if it is low.
Pour the coolant slowly andcarefully so you do not spill any.Clean up any spill immediately; itcould damage components in theengine compartment.
Do not add any rust inhibitors orother additives to your vehicle’scooling system. They may not becompatible with the coolant orengine components.
Pour coolant into the reserve tank.Fill it halfway between the MAXand MIN marks. Put the cap backon the reserve tank.
Make sure the engine and radiatorare cool.
Relieve any pressure in the coolingsystem by turning the radiator capcounterclockwise, withoutpressing down.
Remove the radiator cap bypushing down and turningcounterclockwise.
Put the radiator cap back on, andtighten it fully.
2.
1. 4.
5.
6.
3.
Engine Coolant
352
RESERVE TANKRADIATOR CAP
MAX
MIN
06/05/19 15:03:42 31STK600 0357
Check the fluid level in thewindshield washer reservoir at leastmonthly during normal use.
To check thewindshield washer fluid level, openthe hood and look the windshieldwasher reservoir located behind theleft headlight. You will see a ‘‘1/2’’mark on the reservoir.
You will see a ‘‘WASHER FLUIDLOW’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
The washer level indicator will comeon when the level is low (see page
).
85
74
On U.S. models:
On Canadian RDX with TechnologyPackage model
On Canadian RDX model
CONTINUED
Windshield Washers
Maintenance
353
WASHER LEVEL INDICATOR
Front
WINDSHIELD WASHER RESERVOIR
06/06/16 19:46:05 31STK600 0358
Fill the reservoir with a good-qualitywindshield washer fluid. Thisincreases the cleaning capability andprevents freezing in cold weather.
When you refill the reservoir, cleanthe edges of the windshield wiperblades with windshield washer fluidon a clean cloth. This will help tocondition the blade edges.
Windshield Washers
354
Fill up to here
Do not use engine antif reeze or avinegar/water solution in thewindshield washer reservoir. Antif reezecan damage your vehicle’s paint, whilea vinegar/water solution can damagethe windshield washer pump. Use onlycommercially-available windshieldwasher f luid.
06/05/19 15:03:54 31STK600 0359
CONTINUED
The transmission should be drainedand refilled with new fluid when thisservice is shown on the informationdisplay or multi-information display(depending on models).
Remove the dipstick (yellow loop)from the transmission, and wipe itwith a clean cloth.
If you are not sure how to add fluidor you do not have the properequipment to reach the transmissionfluid fill hole, you should have thismaintenance done by a skilledtechnician.
Park the vehicle on level ground.Start the engine until the radiatorfan comes on and rotate it once.Turn off the engine. For accurateresults, wait at least 60 seconds,and no more than 90 seconds,after turning off the engine tocheck the fluid level.
Check the fluid level with the engineat normal operating temperature.
Insert the dipstick all the way intothe transmission securely asshown in the illustration.
Remove the dipstick and checkthe fluid level. It should bebetween the upper and lowermarks.
1.
2. 3.
4.
Automatic Transmission Fluid
Maintenance
355
DIPSTICK
LOWER MARK
UPPER MARKHOTMARK
06/05/19 15:04:03 31STK600 0360
If the level is below the lowermark, remove the fill plug, thenadd the fluid into the hole to bringit to the level between the upperand lower marks on the dipstick.
Pour the fluid slowly and carefullyso you do not spill any. Clean upany spill immediately; it coulddamage components in the enginecompartment.
Always use Honda ATF-Z1(automatic transmission fluid). If it’snot available, you may use aDEXRON III automatictransmission fluid as a temporaryreplacement. However, continueduse can affect the shift quality. Havethe transmission flushed and refilledwith Honda ATF-Z1 as soon as it isconvenient.
Insert the dipstick all the way backinto the transmission securely asshown in the illustration.5.
6.
Automatic Transmission Fluid
356
FILL PLUG
06/05/19 15:04:09 31STK600 0361
Always use Honda Heavy DutyBrake Fluid DOT 3. If it is notavailable, you should use only DOT 3or DOT 4 fluid, from a sealedcontainer, as a temporaryreplacement.
Using any non-Honda brake fluid cancause corrosion and decrease the lifeof the system. Have the brakesystem flushed and refilled withHonda Heavy Duty Brake FluidDOT 3 as soon as possible.
Brake fluid marked DOT 5 is notcompatible with your vehicle’sbraking system and can causeextensive damage.
The fluid level should be betweenthe MIN and MAX marks on the sideof the reservoir. If the level is at orbelow the MIN mark, your brakesystem needs attention. Have thebrake system inspected for leaks orworn brake pads.
Check the fluid level in the brakefluid reservoir monthly.
Replace the brake fluid every 3 years,independent of mileage.
Brake Fluid
Maintenance
357
MAX
MIN
06/06/16 19:46:12 31STK600 0362
Check the level on the side of thereservoir when the engine is cold.The fluid should be between theUPPER LEVEL and LOWER LEVEL.If not, add power steering fluid to theUPPER LEVEL.
Pour the fluid slowly and carefully soyou do not spill any. Clean up anyspills immediately; it could damagecomponents in the enginecompartment.
Always use Honda Power SteeringFluid. You may use another powersteering fluid as an emergencyreplacement, but have the powersteering system flushed and refilledwith Honda PSF as soon as possible.
A low power steering fluid level canindicate a leak in the system. Checkthe fluid level frequently, and havethe system inspected as soon aspossible.
If you are not sure how to add fluid,contact your dealer.
Power Steering Fluid
358
UPPER LEVEL
LOWER LEVEL
Turning the steering wheel to f ull lef tor right lock and holding it there candamage the power steering pump.
06/05/19 15:04:22 31STK600 0363
The headlights were properly aimedwhen your vehicle was new. If youregularly carry heavy items in thecargo area or pull a trailer,readjustment may be required.Adjustments should be done by yourdealer or other qualified technician.
The low beam headlight bulbs are atype of high voltage discharge tube.High voltage can remain in thecircuit even with the light switch offand the key removed. Because ofthis, you should not attempt toexamine or change a low beamheadlight bulb yourself. If a lowbeam headlight bulb fails, take thevehicle to your dealer to have itreplaced.
Your vehicle has halogen headlightbulbs. When replacing a bulb, handleit by its base, and protect the glassfrom contact with your skin or hardobjects. If you touch the glass, cleanit with denatured alcohol and a cleancloth.
Insert the new bulb into the hole,and turn it one-quarter turnclockwise to lock it in place.
Push the electrical connector ontothe new bulb.
Turn on the headlights to test thenew bulb.
Remove the bulb by turning itabout one-quarter turncounterclockwise.
Remove the electrical connectorfrom the bulb by pushing on thetab and pulling the connectordown.
Open the hood.1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Headlight Aiming
Low Beam Headlight BulbReplacement
Replacing a High Beam HeadlightBulb
Lights
Maintenance
359
BULB CONNECTOR
Halogen headlight bulbs get very hotwhen lit. Oil, perspiration, or a scratchon the glass can cause the bulb tooverheat and shatter.
06/05/19 19:22:09 31STK600 0364
Test the lights to make sure thenew bulb is working.
Insert the socket back into theheadlight assembly. Turn itclockwise to lock it in place.
Open the hood. Remove thesocket from the headlightassembly by turning it one-quarterturn counterclockwise.
Pull the bulb straight out of itssocket. Push the new bulb straightinto the socket until it bottoms.
Install the socket back into theheadlight assembly. Turn itclockwise to lock it in place.
Install the new bulb in the socket.Turn it clockwise to lock it in place.
Remove the bulb from the socketby pushing the bulb in and turningit counterclockwise until it unlocks.
Open the hood. Remove thesocket from the headlightassembly by turning it one-quarterturn counterclockwise.
Turn on the lights to make surethe new bulb is working.
1.
2.
3.
1.
2.
4.
5.
3.
4.
Lights
Replacing a Front Side MarkerLight Bulb
Replacing a Front Turn Signal/Parking Light Bulb
360
BULB
SOCKET BULB
SOCKET
06/06/16 19:46:22 31STK600 0365
Open the tailgate. Place a cloth onthe edge of the light assemblycover. Remove the cover bycarefully prying in the notch on itsmiddle edge with a flat-tipscrewdriver.
Determine which of the two bulbsis burned out: taillight or back-uplight.
Remove the socket by turning itone-quarter turn counterclockwise.
Pull the bulb straight out of itssocket. Push the new bulb straightinto the socket until it bottoms.
Turn on the lights to make surethe new bulb is working.
Reinstall the socket into the lightassembly by turning it clockwiseuntil it locks.
Reinstall the light assembly cover.
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Lights
Replacing Rear Bulbs(in Tailgate)
Maintenance
361
COVER
NOTCH SOCKETS
BULBS
06/06/16 19:46:31 31STK600 0366
Remove the two bolt covers on therear pillar by prying on the bottomedge with a flat-tip screwdriver.Remove the bolts with a Phillips-head screwdriver, and remove thelight assembly from the rear pillar.
Determine which of the threebulbs is burned out: brake/taillight, turn signal or rear sidemarker.
Remove the socket by turning itone-quarter turn counterclockwise.
Pull the bulb straight out of itssocket. Push the new bulb straightinto the socket until it bottoms.
Turn on the lights to make surethe new bulb is working.
Put the socket back into the lightassembly, and turn it clockwise tolock it in place.
Install the rear light assembly inthe rear pillar. Tighten the twobolts. Snap the bolt covers intoposition.
Open the tailgate.
2.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
3.1.
Lights
Replacing Rear Bulbs(in Rear Pillar)
362
COVERSBOLTS
BULB SOCKET
06/05/19 15:05:03 31STK600 0367
CONTINUED
Your vehicle uses halogen lightbulbs. When replacing a bulb, handleit by its plastic case, and protect theglass from contact with your skin orhard objects. If you touch the glass,clean it with denatured alcohol and aclean cloth.
Use a Phillips-head screwdriver toremove the screw and use the flat-tipped screwdriver to remove theholding clip located under thefront bumper.
Remove the electrical connectorfrom the bulb by pushing on thetab and pulling the connectordown.
Remove the bulb from the foglight assembly by turning it one-quarter turn counterclockwise.
Push up the undercover.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Lights
Replacing a Front Fog Light Bulb
Maintenance
363
BULB
CONNECTORHOLDING CLIP
SCREW
Halogen bulbs get very hot when lit.Oil, perspiration, or a scratch on theglass can cause the bulb to overheatand shatter.
06/05/19 15:05:12 31STK600 0368
Install the new bulb into the holeand turn it one-quarter turnclockwise to lock it in place.
Push the electrical connector backonto the bulb. Make sure it is onall the way.
Turn on the fog lights to test thenew bulb.
Put the undercover in place.Reinstall the clip, and tighten thescrew securely.
Remove the two screw covers onthe light assembly by prying onthe side edge with a flat-tipscrewdriver.
Remove the screws with a Phillips-head screwdriver, then removethe light assembly from thetailgate.
Remove the socket from the lightassembly by turning it one-quarterturn counterclockwise.
Pull the bulb straight out of itssocket. Push the new bulb straightinto the socket until it bottoms.
5.
6.
7.
8.
1.
2.
3.
4.
Lights
Replacing a High-mount BrakeLight Bulb
364
COVERS
SOCKET
BULB
SCREWS
06/06/16 19:46:41 31STK600 0369
Press the brake pedal to makesure the new bulb is working.
Put the socket back into the lightassembly, and turn it clockwise tolock it in place.
Each outside mirror has side turnsignal lights. The lights should bereplaced by your dealer.
The license plate has two lightsabove it. The bulbs should bereplaced by your dealer.
Reinstall the high-mount brakelight assembly into the tailgate.Tighten the two screws andreinstall the covers.
6.
5.
7.
Lights
Side Turn Signal Light
Replacing a Rear License PlateLight Bulb
Maintenance
365
06/05/19 15:05:29 31STK600 0370
If your seat belts get dirty, use a softbrush with a mixture of mild soapand warm water to clean them. Donot use bleach, dye, or cleaningsolvents. Let the belts air-dry beforeyou use the vehicle.Dirt build-up in the loops of the seatbelt anchors can cause the belts toretract slowly. Wipe the insides ofthe loops with a clean clothdampened in mild soap and warmwater or isopropyl alcohol.
The driver’s floor mat that camewith your vehicle hooks over thefloor mat anchors. This keeps thefloor mat from sliding forward andpossibly interfering with the pedals.
If you remove the driver’s floor mat,make sure to re-anchor it when youput it back in your vehicle.
A non-Acura floor mat may not fityour vehicle properly. This couldprevent the proper operation of thefolding rear seats and the passenger’sseat weight sensors. We recommendusing genuine Acura floor mats. Donot put additional floor mats on topof the anchored mat.
Cleaning the Seat Belts Floor Mats
Cleaning the Seat Belts, Floor Mats
366
LOOP
FLOOR MAT ANCHORS
06/06/16 19:47:32 31STK600 0371
Your vehicle is equipped with aintercooler on the engine to cool theair flow from a turbo charger intothe engine. The intercooler fins bendeasily. Do not push them with yourfinger.
Have your dealer replace the filterwhen this service is indicated by amaintenance message on theinformation display or multi-information display (depending onthe models). It should be replacedevery 15,000 miles (24,000 km) if youdrive primarily in urban areas thathave high concentrations of soot inthe air, or if the flow from theheating and cooling system becomesless than usual.
This filter removes the dust andpollen that is brought in from theoutside through the heating andcooling system.
Audio Antenna, Intercooler, Dust and Pollen Filter
Audio Antenna Intercooler
Dust and Pollen Filter
Maintenance
367
ANTENNA
INTERCOOLER
Your vehicle is equipped with anantenna at the rear of the roof . Bef oreusing a ‘‘drive-through’’ car wash,remove the antenna by unscrewing it byhand. This prevents the antenna f rombeing damaged by the car wash brushes.
Do not spray water (f rom such sourcesas garden hoses, high pressuresprayers) into the engine compartment.It may cause serious damage to yourvehicle, and could also damage theintercooler f ins.
06/06/16 19:47:41 31STK600 0372
To replace a front wiper blade: Disconnect the blade assemblyfrom the wiper arm:
Press and hold the lock tab.Slide the blade assembly towardthe lock tab until it releasesfrom the wiper arm.
When replacing a wiper blade,make sure not to drop the wiperblade or wiper arm down on thewindshield.
Raise each wiper arm off thewindshield, lifting the driver’s sidefirst, then the passenger’s side.
Check the condition of the wiperblades at least every six months.Look for signs of cracking in therubber, or areas that are gettinghard. Replace the blades if you findthese signs, or if they leave streaksand unwiped areas when used.
2.
1.
Wiper Blades
368
WIPER ARMS
Do not open the hood when the wiperarms are raised, or you will damage thehood and the wiper arms.
06/05/19 15:05:53 31STK600 0373
←←
←
CONTINUED
Examine the new wiper blades. Ifthey have no plastic or metalreinforcement along the backedge, remove the metalreinforcement strips from the oldwiper blade, and install them inthe slots along the edge of the newblade.
Install the new blade onto theblade assembly:
Find two tabs with a ‘‘SET’’ and‘‘ ’’ mark on the wiper bladeassembly. This is the direction youinstall.
Slide the blade onto the assemblyuntil it is locked by the tabs.
Remove the blade from the bladeassembly:
Pull out the blade by grabbingthe end of the blade as shownabove illustration.
Find two tabs with a ‘‘SET’’ and‘‘ ’’ mark on the wiper bladeassembly. The opposite side ofthe ‘‘ ’’ mark is the directionyou pull out the wiper blade.
5.3. 4.
Wiper Blades
Maintenance
369
REINFORCEMENT
BLADE
BLADE
TABS
06/05/19 15:06:02 31STK600 0374
Slide the wiper blade assemblyonto the wiper arm. Make sure itlocks in place.
Make sure the blade is completelyinstalled and that its edge is notbunched up.
Lower the wiper arm down againstthe windshield, the passenger’sside first, then the driver’s side.
To replace the rear wiper blade:
Raise the wiper arm off the rearwindow.
Slide the blade out of the wiperarm.
6.
7.
1.
2.
8.
Wiper Blades
370
BLADEWIPER ARM
06/05/19 15:06:09 31STK600 0375
Examine the new wiper blades. Ifthey have no plastic or metalreinforcement along the backedge, remove the metalreinforcement strips from the oldwiper blade, and install them inthe slots along the edge of the newblade.
Slide the new blade into the wiperarm. Make sure it is engaged inthe slot along its full length.
Lower the wiper arm.5.
3. 4.
Wiper Blades
Maintenance
371
REINFORCEMENT
BLADE
06/06/16 19:47:47 31STK600 0376
Clean the wheels as you would therest of the exterior. Wash them withthe same solution, and rinse themthoroughly.
Aluminum alloy wheels have aprotective clear-coat that keeps thealuminum from corroding andtarnishing. Cleaning the wheels withharsh chemicals (including somecommercial wheel cleaners) or a stiffbrush can damage the clear-coat. Toclean the wheels, use a milddetergent and a soft brush or sponge.
To safely operate your vehicle, yourtires must be the proper type andsize, in good condition with adequatetread, and correctly inflated.
The following pages give moredetailed information on how to takecare of your tires and what to dowhen they need to be replaced.
Keeping the tires properly inflatedprovides the best combination ofhandling, tread life, and ridingcomfort.
Underinflated tires wear unevenly,adversely affect handling and fueleconomy, and are more likely tofail from being overheated.
Overinflated tires can make yourvehicle ride more harshly, aremore prone to damage from roadhazards, and wear unevenly.
The tire pressure monitoring system(TPMS) will warn you when a tirepressure is low. See page forinformation on the TPMS.
309
Tires
Wheels Tires Inflation Guidelines
372
Using tires that are excessivelyworn or improperly inflated cancause a crash in which you canbe seriously hurt or killed.
Follow all instructions in thisowner’s manual regarding tireinflation and maintenance.
06/05/19 15:06:24 31STK600 0377
Even though your vehicle isequipped with TPMS, werecommend that you visually checkyour tires every day. If you think atire might be low, check itimmediately with a tire gauge.
Use a gauge to measure the airpressure in each tire at least once amonth. Even tires that are in goodcondition may lose 1 to 2 psi (10 to20 kPa, 0.1 to 0.2 kgf/cm ) permonth. Remember to check thespare tire at the same time.
If you check air pressures when thetires are hot [driven for several miles(kilometers)], you will see readings 4to 6 psi (30 to 40 kPa, 0.3 to 0.4kgf/cm ) higher than the coldreadings. This is normal. Do not letair out to match the recommendedcold air pressure. The tire will beunderinflated.
While tubeless tires have someability to self-seal if they arepunctured, you should look closelyfor punctures if a tire starts losingpressure.
You should use your own tirepressure gauge whenever you checkyour tire pressures. This will make iteasier for you to tell if a pressureloss is due to a tire problem and notdue to a variation between gauges.
The following chart shows therecommended cold tire pressures formost normal and high-speed drivingconditions.
For additional information aboutyour tires, see page .
For convenience, the recommendedtire sizes and cold tire pressures areon a label on the driver’s doorjamb.
The compact spare tire pressure is:
Check the air pressures when thetires are cold. This means thevehicle has been parked for at least 3hours, or driven less than 1 mile (1.6km). Add or release air, if needed, tomatch the recommended cold tirepressures.
412
Cold Tire Pressurefor Normal Driving
Tire Size
Front/Rear:
Tires
Recommended Tire Pressures
Maintenance
373
60 psi (420 kPa , 4.2 kgf/cm )
P235/55R18 99V 32 psi (220 kPa ,2.2 kgf/cm )
06/06/16 19:47:57 31STK600 0378
Every time you check inflation, youshould also examine the tires fordamage, foreign objects, and wear.
You should look for:
Bumps or bulges in the tread orside of the tire. Replace the tire ifyou find either of these conditions.
Cuts, splits, or cracks in the sideof the tire. Replace the tire if youcan see fabric or cord.
Excessive tread wear.
Your tires have wear indicatorsmolded into the tread. When thetread wears down, you will see aband 1/2 inch (12.7 mm) wide bandacross the tread. This shows there isless than 1/16 inch (1.6 mm) of treadleft on the tire.
A tire this worn gives very littletraction on wet roads. You shouldreplace the tire if you can see threeor more tread wear indicators.
In addition to proper inflation,correct wheel alignment helps todecrease tire wear. If you find a tireis worn unevenly, have your dealercheck the wheel alignment.
Have your dealer check the tires ifyou feel a consistent vibration whiledriving. A tire should always berebalanced if it is removed from thewheel. When you have new tiresinstalled, make sure they arebalanced. This increases ridingcomfort and tire life. For best results,have the installer perform a dynamicbalance.
Tires
Tire Inspection Tire Maintenance
374
INDICATOR LOCATION MARKS
TREAD WEAR INDICATORS
Improper wheel weights can damageyour vehicle’s aluminum wheels. Useonly genuine Acura wheels weights f orbalancing.
06/05/19 15:06:45 31STK600 0379
To help increase tire life anddistribute wear more evenly, rotatethe tires according to themaintenance messages displayed onthe information display or multi-information display (depending onmodels). Move the tires to thepositions shown in the diagram eachtime they are rotated. If youpurchase directional tires, rotateonly front-to-back.
Replace your tires with radial tires ofthe same size, load range, speedrating, and maximum cold tirepressure rating (as shown on thetire’s sidewall).
Mixing radial and bias-ply tires onyour vehicle can reduce brakingability, traction, and steeringaccuracy. Using tires of a differentsize or construction can cause theABS and vehicle stability assistsystem (VSA) to work inconsistently.
The ABS works by comparing thespeed of the wheels. When replacingtires, use the same size originallysupplied with the vehicle. Tire sizeand construction can affect wheelspeed and may cause the system toactivate.
It is best to replace all four tires atthe same time. If that is not possibleor necessary, replace the two fronttires or two rear tires as a pair.Replacing just one tire can seriouslyaffect your vehicle’s handling.
If you ever replace a wheel, makesure the new one matches thespecifications of the original.
Replacement wheels are available atyour dealer.
Tires
Tire Rotation Replacing Tires and Wheels
Maintenance
375
Front Front
(For Non-directionalTires and Wheels)
(For DirectionalTires and Wheels)
06/05/19 15:06:53 31STK600 0380
+Tires marked ‘‘M S’’ or ‘‘AllSeason’’ on the sidewall have an all-weather tread design suitable formost winter driving conditions.
For the best performance in snowyor icy conditions, you should installsnow tires or tire chains. They maybe required by local laws undercertain conditions.
Wheels:
Tires:
See page for information aboutDOT Tire Quality Grading, and page
for tire size and labelinginformation.
If you mount snow tires on yourvehicle, make sure they are radialtires of the same size and load rangeas the original tires. Mount snowtires on all four wheels. The tractionprovided by snow tires on dry roadsmay be lower than your original tires.Check with the tire dealer formaximum speed recommendations.
410
412
Winter DrivingWheel and Tire Specifications
Snow Tires
Tires
376
18 x 7 1/2J
P235/55R18 99V
(TPMS)Installing improper tires on yourvehicle can affect handling andstability. This can cause a crashin which you can be seriouslyhurt or killed.
Always use the size and type oftires recommended in thisowner’s manual.
06/05/19 15:07:02 31STK600 0381
When installing cables, follow themanufacturer’s instructions, andmount them as tight as you can.Make sure they are not contactingthe brake lines or suspension. Driveslowly with them installed. If youhear them coming into contact withthe body or chassis, stop andinvestigate. Remove them as soon asyou begin driving on cleared roads.
Mount tire chains on your tires whenrequired by driving conditions orlocal laws. Install them only on thefront tires.
Because your vehicle has limited tireclearance, Acura stronglyrecommends using the chains listedbelow, made by Security ChainCompany (SCC).
Cable type: Shur Grip ZSZ343
Tires
Tire Chains
Maintenance
377
Using the wrong chains, or notproperly installing chains, candamage the brake lines andcause a crash in which you canbe seriously injured or killed.
Follow all instructions in thisowner’s manual regarding theselection and use of tire chains.
Traction devices that are the wrongsize or improperly installed candamage your vehicle’s brake lines,suspension, body, and wheels. Stopdriving if they are hitting any part ofthe vehicle.
06/05/19 15:07:08 31STK600 0382
-
Check the condition of the batterymonthly by looking at the testindicator window. The label on thebattery explains the test indicator’scolors.
If you need to connect the battery toa charger, disconnect both cables toprevent damaging your vehicle’selectrical system. Always disconnectthe negative ( ) cable first, andreconnect it last.
Battery posts,terminals, and related accessoriescontain lead and lead compounds.
If additional battery maintenance isneeded, see your dealer or aqualified technician.
Check the terminals for corrosion (awhite or yellowish powder). Toremove it, cover the terminals with asolution of baking soda and water. Itwill bubble up and turn brown. Whenthis stops, wash it off with plainwater. Dry off the battery with acloth or paper towel. Coat theterminals with grease to help preventfuture corrosion.
If your vehicle’s battery isdisconnected, or goes dead, the timesetting will be reset to 1:00. To setthe time again, follow the settingprocedure (see page ).198
On RDX modelsWARNING:
Wash your hands after handling.
Checking the Battery
378
TEST INDICATOR WINDOW
The battery gives off explosivehydrogen gas during normaloperation.
A spark or flame can cause thebattery to explode with enoughforce to kill or seriously hurt you.
Wear protective clothing and aface shield, or have a skilledtechnician do the batterymaintenance.
06/05/19 15:07:15 31STK600 0383
If your vehicle’s battery isdisconnected or goes dead, the audiosystem will disable itself. The nexttime you turn on the radio you willsee ‘‘ ’’ in the frequencydisplay. Use the preset bars or presetbuttons (depending on models) toenter the five-digit code (see page
).
The navigation system will alsodisable itself. The next time you turnon the ignition switch, the systemwill require you to enter a PINbefore it can be used. Refer to thenavigation system manual.
239
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Checking the Battery
Maintenance
379
06/06/16 19:48:02 31STK600 0384
Fill the fuel tank.
Change the engine oil and filter.
Wash and dry the exteriorcompletely.
Clean the interior. Make sure thecarpeting, floor mats, etc., arecompletely dry.
Block the rear wheels.
If the vehicle is to be stored for alonger period, it should besupported on jackstands so thetires are off the ground.
Cover the vehicle with a‘‘breathable’’ cover, one madefrom a porous material such ascotton. Non-porous materials, suchas plastic sheeting, trap moisture,which can damage the paint.
If you need to park your vehicle foran extended period (more than 1month), there are several things youshould do to prepare it for storage.Proper preparation helps preventdeterioration and makes it easier toget your vehicle back on the road. Ifpossible, store your vehicle indoors. Leave one window open slightly (if
the vehicle is being storedindoors).
Disconnect the battery.
Support the front and rear wiperblade arms with a folded towel orrag so they do not touch thewindshield.
To minimize sticking, apply asilicone spray lubricant to all doorand tailgate seals. Also, apply avehicle body wax to the paintedsurfaces that mate with the doorand tailgate seals.
If possible, periodically run theengine until it reaches fulloperating temperature (thecooling fans cycle on and offtwice). Preferably, do this once amonth.
Leave the parking brake off. Putthe transmission in Park.
Vehicle Storage
380
06/05/19 15:07:29 31STK600 0385
This section covers the morecommon problems that motoristsexperience with their vehicles. Itgives you information about how tosafely evaluate the problem and whatto do to correct it. If the problem hasstranded you on the side of the road,you may be able to get going again.If not, you will also find instructionson getting your vehicle towed.
......................Compact Spare Tire . 382....................Changing a Flat Tire . 383
.............If the Engine Won’t Start . 387................................Jump Starting . 389
..............If the Engine Overheats . 391.........Low Oil Pressure Indicator . 393..........Charging System Indicator . 393
.......Malfunction Indicator Lamp . 394....Brake System Indicator (Red) . 395
Brake System Indicator.....................................(Amber) . 396
Use the compact spare tire as atemporary replacement only. Getyour regular tire repaired or replaced,and put it back on your vehicle assoon as you can.
Check the inflation pressure of thecompact spare tire every time youcheck the other tires. It should beinflated to:
Replace the tire when you can seethe tread wear indicator bars. Thereplacement should be the same sizeand design tire, mounted on thesame wheel. The spare tire is notdesigned to be mounted on a regularwheel, and the spare wheel is notdesigned for mounting a regular tire.
Follow these precautions:
Never exceed 50 mph (80 km/h).
This tire gives a harsher ride andless traction on some roadsurfaces. Use greater cautionwhile driving.
Do not mount snow chains on thecompact spare tire.
Do not use your compact sparetire on another vehicle unless it isthe same make and model.
Do not use the compact spare tireif you are towing a trailer.
If you have a flat tire while driving,stop in a safe place to change it.Drive slowly along the shoulder untilyou get to an exit or an area that isfar away from the traffic lanes.
Park the vehicle on firm, level, andnon-slippery ground. Put thetransmission in Park. Apply theparking brake.If you are towing a trailer, unhitchit.
Open the tailgate. Raise the cargoarea floor lid by lifting it up withthe strap, then remove the lid.The spare tire, jack, and tools areunder the cargo area floor.
Turn on the hazard warning lights,and turn the ignition switch to theLOCK (0) position. Have allpassengers get out of the vehiclewhile you change the tire.
Unscrew the wing bolt. Use thehooked end of the wheel nutwrench extension as a wrench ifthe wing bolt is hard to loosen.Then take the spare tire out of thecargo area.
1.
2.
3.
4.
CONTINUED
Changing a Flat Tire
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
383
JACK
WING BOLT
LID
SPARE TIRE
The vehicle can easily roll offthe jack, seriously injuringanyone underneath.
Follow the directions forchanging a tire exactly, andnever get under the vehiclewhen it is supported only by thejack.
06/05/19 15:07:50 31STK600 0388
Loosen the five wheel nuts 1/2turn with the wheel nut wrench.
Place the jack under the jackingpoint nearest the tire you need tochange. Turn the end bracketclockwise until the top of the jackcontacts the jacking point. Makesure the jacking point tab isresting in the jack notch.
Remove the tools, wing bolt andthe jack. To remove the jack, turnthe jack’s end bracketcounterclockwise to loosen it.
6.5. 7.
Changing a Flat Tire
384
JACK
WING BOLT for normal tire WHEEL NUTS
WHEEL NUT WRENCH JACKING POINTTOOLS
WHEEL NUTS
06/05/19 15:07:56 31STK600 0389
CONTINUED
Use the extension and the wheelnut wrench as shown to raise thevehicle until the flat tire is off theground.
Remove the wheel nuts, thenremove the flat tire. Handle thewheel nuts carefully; they may behot from driving. Place the flat tireon the ground with the outsidesurface facing up.
Before mounting the spare tire,wipe any dirt off the mountingsurface of the wheel and hub witha clean cloth. Wipe the hubcarefully; it may be hot fromdriving.
Put on the spare tire. Put thewheel nuts back on finger-tight,then tighten them in a crisscrosspattern with the wheel nut wrenchuntil the wheel is firmly againstthe hub. Do not try to tighten thewheel nuts fully.
Lower the vehicle to the ground,and remove the jack.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
Changing a Flat Tire
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
385
BRAKE HUBWHEEL NUT WRENCH EXTENSION
06/05/19 15:08:03 31STK600 0390
Tighten the wheel nuts securely inthe same crisscross pattern. Havethe wheel nut torque checked atthe nearest automotive servicefacility.Tighten the wheel nuts to:
Store the jack in its holder. Turnthe jack’s end bracket to lock it inplace. Store the tools.
Remove the center cap from theflat tire, and store it in the cargoarea.
Place the flat tire face up in thecargo area.
Secure the flat tire by screwingthe wing bolt back into its hole.
Reinstall the cargo area floor, andclose the tailgate.
Refer to(see page ).
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.310
Changing a Flat Tire
Changing a Tire withTPMS
386
For normaltire
For sparetire
80 lbf·ft (108 N·m , 11 kgf·m)
Loose items can fly around theinterior in a crash and couldseriously injure the occupants.
Store the wheel, jack, and toolssecurely before driving.
06/06/16 19:48:10 31STK600 0391
Diagnosing why the engine won’tstart falls into two areas, dependingon what you hear when you turn theignition switch to the START (III)position:
When you turn the ignition switch tothe START (III) position, you do nothear the normal noise of the enginetrying to start. You may hear aclicking sound, a series of clicks, ornothing at all.
If the headlights dim noticeably orgo out when you try to start theengine, either the battery isdischarged or the connections arecorroded. Check the condition of thebattery and terminal connections(see page ). You can then tryjump starting the vehicle from abooster battery (see page ).
You can hear the starter motoroperating normally, or the startermotor sounds like it is spinningfaster than normal, but the enginedoes not start up and run.
You hear nothing, or almostnothing. The engine’s startermotor does not operate at all, oroperates very slowly.
Check the transmission interlock.The transmission must be in Parkor neutral or the starter will notoperate.
Check these things:
Turn the ignition switch to the ON(II) position. Turn on theheadlights, and check theirbrightness. If the headlights arevery dim or do not come on at all,the battery is discharged. See
on page .
Turn the ignition switch to theSTART (III) position. If theheadlights do not dim, check thecondition of the fuses. If the fusesare OK, there is probablysomething wrong with theelectrical circuit for the ignitionswitch or starter motor. You willneed a qualified mechanic todetermine the problem (see
on page ).
389
403
378
389
Nothing Happens or the StarterMotor Operates Very Slowly
Jump Starting
Emergency Towing
If the Engine Won’t Start
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
387
06/05/19 15:08:22 31STK600 0392
Are you using a properly codedkey? An improperly coded key willcause the immobilizer systemindicator in the instrument panelto blink rapidly (see page ).
In this case, the starter motor’sspeed sounds normal, or even fasterthan normal, when you turn theignition switch to the START (III)position, but the engine does not run.
Are you using the proper startingprocedure? Refer to
on page .
Do you have fuel? Check the fuelgauge; the low fuel indicator maynot be working.
There may be an electricalproblem, such as no power to thefuel pump. Check all the fuses(see page ).
If you find nothing wrong, you willneed a qualified technician to findthe problem. See
on page .128
398
403
294
The Starter Operates Normally
Starting theEngine
EmergencyTowing
If the Engine Won’t Start
388
06/05/19 15:08:29 31STK600 0393
Although this seems like a simpleprocedure, you should take severalprecautions.
Open the hood, and check thephysical condition of the battery.In very cold weather, check thecondition of the electrolyte. If itseems slushy or frozen, do not tryjump starting until it thaws.
The numbers in the illustration showyou the order to connect the jumpercables.
You cannot start your vehicle bypushing or pulling it.
Turn off all electrical accessories:heater, A/C, climate control, audiosystem, lights, etc. Put thetransmission in Park, and set theparking brake.
1.
2.
CONTINUED
To Jump Start Your Vehicle:
Jump Starting
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
389
BOOSTERBATTERY
A battery can explode if you donot follow the correct procedure,seriously injuring anyonenearby.
Keep all sparks, open flames,and smoking materials awayfrom the battery.
If a battery sits in extreme cold, theelectrolyte inside can f reeze.Attempting to jump start with a f rozenbattery can cause it to rupture.
06/05/19 19:22:44 31STK600 0394
+
+
-
Connect one jumper cable to thepositive ( ) terminal on yourbattery. Connect the other end tothe positive ( ) terminal on thebooster battery.
If the booster battery is in anothervehicle, have an assistant startthat vehicle and run it at a fast idle.
Start your vehicle. If the startermotor still operates slowly, checkthat the jumper cables have goodmetal-to-metal contact.
Once your vehicle is running,disconnect the negative cable fromyour vehicle, then from thebooster battery. Disconnect thepositive cable from your vehicle,then from the booster battery.
Keep the ends of the jumper cablesaway from each other and any metalon the vehicle until everything isdisconnected. Otherwise, you maycause an electrical short.
Connect the second jumper cableto the negative ( ) terminal onthe booster battery. Connect theother end to the grounding pointas shown. Do not connect thisjumper cable to any other part ofthe engine.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Jump Starting
390
06/05/19 20:49:42 31STK600 0395
CONTINUED
The reading of the vehicle’stemperature gauge on theinformation display or multi-information display (depending onmodels) should stay in the midrange.If it climbs to the H (Hot) mark, youshould determine the reason (hotday, driving up a steep hill, etc.).
If the temperature gauge readingstays at the H (Hot) mark, turn offthe engine.
If you do not see steam or spray,leave the engine running, andwatch the temperature gauge. Ifthe high heat is due to overloading,the engine should start to cooldown almost immediately. If itdoes, wait until the temperaturegauge comes down to the midpoint,then continue driving.
If you see steam and/or spraycoming from under the hood, turnoff the engine. Wait until you seeno more signs of steam or spray,then open the hood.
If the coolant temperature rises to224°F (118°C) or more, thetemperature gauge will appear onthe display and blink for severaltimes. At the same time, the beeperwill sound once.
If your vehicle overheats, you shouldtake immediate action. The onlyindication may be the temperaturegauge climbing to the H (Hot) mark.Or you may see steam or spraycoming from under the hood.
Safely pull to the side of the road.Put the transmission in Park, andset the parking brake. Turn off allaccessories, and turn on thehazard warning indicators.
1.
2.
3.
4.
If the Engine Overheats
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
391
Steam and spray from anoverheated engine canseriously scald you.
Do not open the hood if steamis coming out.
Driving with the temperature gaugereading at the H (Hot) mark can causeserious damage to the engine.
06/05/19 15:08:53 31STK600 0396
Look for any obvious coolant leaks,such as a split radiator hose.Everything is still extremely hot,so use caution. If you find a leak, itmust be repaired before youcontinue driving (see
on page ).
If you don’t find an obvious leak,check the coolant level in theradiator reserve tank (see page
).Using gloves or a large heavycloth, turn the radiator capcounterclockwise, without pushingdown, to the first stop. After thepressure releases, push down onthe cap, and turn it until it comesoff.
If there was no coolant in thereserve tank, you may need to addcoolant to the radiator. Let theengine cool down until the readingreaches the middle of thetemperature gauge or lowerbefore checking the radiator.
Start the engine, and set thetemperature to maximum heat(climate control to AUTO at‘‘ ’’). Add coolant to theradiator up to the base of the fillerneck. If you do not have theproper coolant mixture available,you can add plain water.Remember to have the coolingsystem drained and refilled withthe proper mixture as soon as youcan.
If the temperature stays normal,check the coolant level in theradiator reserve tank. If it hasgone down, add coolant to theMAX mark. Put the cap back ontightly.
Put the radiator cap back ontightly. Run the engine, and watchthe temperature gauge. If it goesback to the H mark, the engineneeds repair (see
on page ).
9.
8.7.
6.
5.
10.
11.
403
283
403
EmergencyTowing
EmergencyTowing
If the Engine Overheats
392
Removing the radiator capwhile the engine is hot cancause the coolant to spray out,seriously scalding you.
Always let the engine andradiator cool down beforeremoving the radiator cap.
06/05/19 15:09:01 31STK600 0397
Let the vehicle sit for a minute.Open the hood, and check the oillevel (see page ). An enginevery low on oil can lose pressureduring cornering and other drivingmaneuvers.
If the charging systemindicator comes on brightly
when the engine is running, thebattery is not being charged.
Safely pull off the road, and shutoff the engine. Turn on the hazardwarning lights.
This indicator should nevercome on when the engine is
running. If it starts flashing or stayson, the oil pressure has dropped verylow or lost pressure. Serious enginedamage is possible, and you shouldtake immediate action.
Start the engine, and watch the oilpressure indicator. If it does not goout within 10 seconds, turn off theengine. There is a mechanicalproblem that needs to be repairedbefore you can continue driving(see on page
).
You will also see a ‘‘CHECKCHARGING SYSTEM’’ message onthe multi-information display (seepage ).
Immediately turn off all electricalaccessories. Try not to use otherelectrically operated controls such asthe power windows. Keep the enginerunning; starting the engine willdischarge the battery rapidly.
Go to a service station or garagewhere you can get technicalassistance.
If necessary, add oil to bring thelevel back to the full mark on thedipstick (see page ).
You will also see an ‘‘OILPRESSURE LOW’’ message on themulti-information display (see page
).
1.
2.
4.
3.
283
403
84
84347
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Low Oil Pressure Indicator Charging System Indicator
Emergency Towing
Low Oil Pressure Indicator, Charging System Indicator
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
393
Running the engine with low oilpressure can cause serious mechanicaldamage almost immediately. Turn of fthe engine as soon as you can saf ely getthe vehicle stopped.
06/06/16 19:48:21 31STK600 0398
If the indicator comes onwhile driving, it means one
of the engine’s emissions controlsystems may have a problem. Eventhough you may feel no difference inyour vehicle’s performance, it canreduce your fuel economy and causeincreased emissions. Continuedoperation may cause serious damage.
If the indicator comes on repeatedly,even though it may turn off as youcontinue driving, have your vehiclechecked by your dealer as soon aspossible.
If you have recently refueled yourvehicle, the indicator coming oncould be due to a loose or missingfuel fill cap. Tighten the cap until itclicks at least once. Tightening thecap will not turn the indicator offimmediately; it can take several daysof normal driving.
The indicator may also come on withthe ‘‘D’’ indicator.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECKEMISSION SYSTEM’’ message onthe multi-information display (seepage ).
Your vehicle has certain ‘‘readinesscodes’’ that are part of the on-boarddiagnostics for the emissionssystems. In some states, part of theemissions testing is to make surethese codes are set. If they are not
set, the test cannot be completed.
If the battery in your vehicle hasbeen disconnected or gone dead,these codes are erased. It takes atleast three days of driving undervarious conditions to set the codesagain.
To check if they are set, turn theignition switch to the ON (II)position, without starting the engine.The malfunction indicator lamp willcome on for 20 seconds. If it thengoes off, the readiness codes are set.If it blinks five times, the readinesscodes are not set. If possible, do nottake your vehicle for a stateemissions test until the readinesscodes are set. Refer to
for moreinformation (see page ).418
84
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
Readiness Codes StateEmissions Testing
394
If you keep driving with themalf unction indicator lamp on, you candamage your vehicle’s emissionscontrols and engine. Those repairs maynot be covered by your vehicle’swarranties.
06/06/16 19:48:29 31STK600 0399
The brake system indicator (red)normally comes on when you turnthe ignition switch to the ON (II)position, and as a reminder to checkthe parking brake. It will stay on ifyou do not fully release the parkingbrake.
If the brake system indicator (red)comes on while driving, the brakefluid level is probably low. Presslightly on the brake pedal to see if itfeels normal. If it does, check thebrake fluid level the next time youstop at a service station (see page
).
If the fluid level is low, take yourvehicle to a dealer, and have thebrake system inspected for leaks orworn brake pads.
However, if the brake pedal does notfeel normal, you should takeimmediate action. A problem in onepart of the system’s dual circuitdesign will still give you braking attwo wheels. You will feel the brakepedal go down much farther beforethe vehicle begins to slow down, andyou will have to press harder on thepedal.
You will also see a ‘‘BRAKE FLUIDLOW’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
You will also see a ‘‘CHECK BRAKESYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
Slow down by shifting to a lowergear, and pull to the side of the roadwhen it is safe. Because of the longdistance needed to stop, it ishazardous to drive the vehicle. Youshould have it towed, and repaired assoon as possible (see
on page ).
84
357
403
84
CONTINUED
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Brake System Indicator
Brake System Indicator (Red)
EmergencyTowing
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
395
CanadaU. S.
06/06/16 19:48:37 31STK600 0400
Your vehicle has an electric vacuumpump located in the enginecompartment. It enhances theeffectiveness of your vehicle’s brakesystem more frequently when youdrive in cold weather or thinner air athigh altitude after the engine isstarted.
When the electric vacuum pump is inoperation, it makes some mechanicalnoises come from the enginecompartment. This is normal.
The brake system indicator (amber)on the instrument panel normallycomes on for a few seconds whenyou turn the ignition switch to theON (II) position. If it stays on afterthe engine starts, press on the brakepedal with your foot several timesuntil the indicator turns off. If theindicator is still on or comes on againafter this procedure, there is aproblem in the brake systemincluding the electric vacuum pump.If this happens, the brake pedalmight feel heavy when you press it.Have your vehicle checked by yourdealer.
You will also see a ‘‘CHECK BRAKESYSTEM’’ message on the multi-information display (see page ).
If you must drive the vehicle a shortdistance in this condition, driveslowly and carefully.
If the ABS indicator and the VSAsystem indicator come on with thebrake system indicator, have yourvehicle inspected by your dealerimmediately.
84
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Brake System Indicator
Brake System Indicator (Amber)
396
CanadaU. S.
06/05/24 14:38:51 31STK600 0401
The vehicle’s fuses are contained inthree fuse boxes.
The primary under-hood fuse box isin the engine compartment on thedriver’s side. To open it, push thetabs as shown.The interior fuse box is on the
driver’s lower left side.
The secondary under-hood fuse boxis next to the battery. To open it,push the tabs as shown.
Fuses
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
397
INTERIOR
FUSELABEL
TAB
UNDER-HOOD (PRIMARY) UNDER-HOOD (SECONDARY)
TAB
06/06/16 19:49:30 31STK600 0402
If something electrical in yourvehicle stops working, check for ablown fuse first. Determine from thechart on pages and , or thediagram on the fuse box lid, whichfuse or fuses control that device.Check those fuses first, but check allthe fuses before deciding that ablown fuse is the cause. Replace anyblown fuses, and check if the deviceworks.
Turn the ignition switch to theLOCK (0) position. Make sure theheadlights and all otheraccessories are off.
Remove the cover from the fusebox.
Check each of the large fuses inthe under-hood fuse box bylooking through the side windowat the wire inside. Remove thescrews with a Phillips-headscrewdriver.
3.1.
2.
401 402
(Under-hood fuse boxes)
Fuses
Checking and Replacing Fuses
398
FUSE BLOWN BLOWN
06/05/19 19:22:50 31STK600 0403
Check the smaller fuses in theunder-hood fuse boxes and all thefuses in the interior fuse box bypulling out each one with the fusepuller provided in the primaryunder-hood fuse box.
If you cannot drive the vehiclewithout fixing the problem, and youdo not have a spare fuse, take a fuseof the same rating or a lower ratingfrom one of the other circuits. Makesure you can do without that circuittemporarily (such as the accessorypower socket or radio).If you replace the blown fuse with aspare fuse that has a lower rating, itmight blow out again. This does notindicate anything wrong. Replace thefuse with one of the correct rating assoon as you can.Look for a blown wire inside the
fuse. If it is blown, replace it withone of the spare fuses of the samerating or lower. The spare fusesare provided back of the under-hood fuse cover.
4. 5.
CONTINUED
Fuses
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
399
BLOWN
FUSE PULLER
06/05/19 15:09:56 31STK600 0404
If the replacement fuse of thesame rating blows in a short time,there is probably a seriouselectrical problem in your vehicle.Leave the blown fuse in thatcircuit and have your vehiclechecked by a qualified technician.
If the audio fuse is removed, theaudio system will disable itself. Thenext time you turn on the audio youwill see ‘‘ ’’ on the display.Use the preset bars or buttons(depending on models) to enter thefive-digit code (see page ).
When the audio system is disabled,the clock setting in the audio systemwill be canceled. You will need toreset the clock (see page ).
If the navigation system fuse isremoved, the navigation system willdisable itself. The next time you turnon the ignition switch, the systemwill require you to enter a PINbefore it can be used. Refer to theNavigation System Owner’s Manual.
6.
239
198
On RDX model
On RDX with Technology Packagemodel
Fuses
400
Replacing a f use with one that has ahigher rating greatly increases thechances of damaging the electricalsystem. If you do not have areplacement f use with the proper ratingf or the circuit, install one with a lowerrating.
The operator will loadyour vehicle on the back of a truck.Any other method of towing willdamage the drive system. When youcontact the towing agency, informthem a flat-bed is required.
If your vehicle needs to be towed,call a professional towing service ororganization. Never tow your vehiclewith just a rope or chain. It is verydangerous.
The only way you can safely towyour vehicle is with flat-bedequipment.
Emergency Towing
Taking
Care
ofthe
Unexpected
403
Towing with only two tires on theground will damage parts of theall-wheel-drive system. Your vehicleshould be transported on a f lat-bedtruck or trailer.
06/05/19 15:10:24 31STK600 0408
The diagrams in this section giveyou the dimensions and capacities ofyour vehicle and the locations of theidentification numbers. It alsoincludes information you shouldknow about your vehicle’s tires andemissions control systems.
Three Way Catalytic...........................Converter . 416
....................Replacement Parts . 416..Three Way Catalytic Converter . 417
..............State Emissions Testing . 418
Technical Information
TechnicalInform
ation
405
06/05/19 15:10:30 31STK600 0410
Your vehicle has several identifyingnumbers located in various places.
The vehicle identification number(VIN) is the 17-digit number yourdealer uses to register your vehiclefor warranty purposes. It is alsonecessary for licensing and insuringyour vehicle. The easiest place tofind the VIN is on a plate fastened tothe top of the dashboard. You cansee it by looking through thewindshield on the driver’s side. It isalso on the certification labelattached to the driver’s doorjamb,and is stamped on the enginecompartment bulkhead. The VIN isalso provided in bar code on thecertification label.
Identif ication Numbers
406
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
CERTIFICATION LABEL
06/05/19 15:10:34 31STK600 0411
The transmission number is on alabel on top of the transmission.
The engine number is stamped intothe front of the engine block.
Identif ication Numbers
TechnicalInform
ation
407
AUTOMATIC TRANSMISSION NUMBER
ENGINE NUMBER
06/05/19 15:10:38 31STK600 0412
*
*
*
*
Specifications
408
Dimensions
Weights
Engine
Capacities
Capacities
1.66 US gal (6.3 )
8.1 US qt (7.7 )
2.6 US qt (2.5 )2.9 US qt (2.7 )
LengthWidthHeightWheelbaseTrack
65.2 in (1,655 mm)104.3 in (2,650 mm)61.9 in (1,572 mm)62.6 in (1,590 mm)
Gross vehicle weight rating See the certification label attachedto the driver’s doorjamb.
Type
Bore x StrokeDisplacementCompression ratioSpark plugs
Water cooled 4-stroke DOHCi-VTEC 4-cylinder gasoline engine
with turbo charger3.39 x 3.90 in (86.0 x 99.0 mm)
140.4 cu-in (2,300 cm )8.8 : 1
Fuel tank
Engine oil18.0 US gal (68 )
5.0 US qt (4.7 )4.6 US qt (4.4 )6.1 US qt (5.8 )
Excluding the oil remaining in the engine
Including the coolant in the reserve tank and that remaining in theengineReserve tank capacity:0.190 US gal (0.72 )
180.7 in (4,590 mm)73.6 in (1,870 mm) 2.40 US gal (9.1 )
The low beam headlights are high voltage discharged type.Replacement of a low beam headlight bulb should be performed byyour dealer.
See page 401 or the fuse labelattached to the dashboard.
Headlights
Front turn signal/parkinglightsFront fog lightsFront side marker lightsRear turn signal lightsBrake/Taillights (in fenders)Taillights (in tailgate)Back-up lightsRear side marker lightsLicense plate lightsHigh-mount brake lightRear ceiling lightFront ceiling lights/SpotlightsDoor courtesy lightsCargo area light
FrontRearFrontRearFront
Front/RearSpareFront/RearSpare
:
(HB3)(D2S)
HighLow
(Amber)
(H11)
06/06/16 19:50:26 31STK600 0414
-The tires on your vehicle meet allU.S. Federal Safety Requirements.All tires are also graded fortreadwear, traction, and temperatureperformance according toDepartment of Transportation(DOT) standards. The followingexplains these gradings.
Quality grades can be found whereapplicable on the tire sidewallbetween the tread shoulder and themaximum section width. Forexample:
The treadwear grade is a compara-tive rating based on the wear rate ofthe tire when tested under controlledconditions on a specified governmenttest course. For example, a tiregraded 150 would wear one and one-half (1 1/2) times as well on thegovernment course as a tire graded100. The relative performance oftires depends upon the actual condi-tions of their use, however, and maydepart significantly from the normdue to variations in driving habits,service practices, and differences inroad characteristics and climate.
The traction grades, from highest tolowest, are AA, A, B, and C. Thosegrades represent the tire’s ability tostop on wet pavement as measuredunder controlled conditions onspecified government test surfacesof asphalt and concrete. A tiremarked C may have poor tractionperformance.
Warning: The traction gradeassigned to this tire is based onstraight-ahead braking traction tests,and does not include acceleration,cornering, hydroplaning, or peaktraction characteristics.
All passenger car tires must conformto Federal Safety Requirements inaddition to these grades.
DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
Treadwear 200Traction AATemperature A
Uniform Tire Quality Grading
Treadwear Traction AA, A, B, C
410
06/05/19 15:11:26 31STK600 0415
- Warning: The temperature grade forthis tire is established for a tire thatis properly inflated and notoverloaded. Excessive speed,underinflation, or excessive loading,either separately or in combination,can cause heat buildup and possibletire failure.
The temperature grades are A (thehighest), B, and C, representing thetire’s resistance to the generation ofheat, and its ability to dissipate heatwhen tested under controlledconditions on a specified indoorlaboratory test wheel. Sustained hightemperature can cause the materialof the tire to degenerate and reducetire life, and excessive temperaturecan lead to sudden tire failure. TheGrade C corresponds to a level ofperformance which all passenger cartires must meet under the FederalMotor Vehicle Safety Standard No.109. Grades B and A representhigher levels of performance on thelaboratory test wheel than theminimum required by law.
DOT Tire Quality Grading (U.S. Vehicles)
Temperature A, B, C
TechnicalInform
ation
411
06/05/19 15:11:30 31STK600 0416
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
The tires that came on your vehiclehave a number of markings. Thoseyou should be aware of are describedbelow.
Speed symbol (analphabetical code indicatingthe maximum speed rating).
Load index (a numerical codeassociated with the maximumload the tire can carry).
Whenever tires are replaced, theyshould be replaced with tires of thesame size. Below is an example oftire size with an explanation of whateach component means.
Tire width in millimeters.
Aspect ratio (the tire’s sectionheight as a percentage of itswidth).
Tire construction code (Rindicates radial).
Rim diameter in inches.
The tire identification number (TIN)is a group of numbers and lettersthat look like the following exampleTIN. TIN is located on the sidewallof the tire.
Max Load The maximum load thetire can carry at maximum airpressure.
Max Press The maximum airpressure the tire can hold.
Date of manufacture.
Tire type code.
Manufacturer’sidentification mark.
This indicates that the tiremeets all requirements ofthe U.S. Department ofTransportation.R
DOT
B97R
FW6X
2202
235
55
18
99
V
Tire Labeling
Tire Size
Tire Identif ication Number
Maximum Tire Load
Maximum Tire Pressure
412
P235/55R18 99V
DOT B97R FW6X 2202
06/05/19 15:11:44 31STK600 0417
-
Each tire, including the spare (ifprovided), should be checkedmonthly when cold and inflated tothe inflation pressure recommendedby the vehicle manufacturer on thevehicle placard or tire inflationpressure label.
(If your vehicle has tires of adifferent size than the size indicatedon the vehicle placard or tireinflation pressure label, you shoulddetermine the proper tire inflationpressure for those tires.)
As an added safety feature, yourvehicle has been equipped with a tirepressure monitoring system (TPMS)that illuminates a low tire pressuretelltale
when one or more of your tires issignificantly under-inflated.
Accordingly, when the low tirepressure telltale illuminates, youshould stop and check your tires assoon as possible, and inflate them tothe proper pressure.
Driving on a significantlyunderinflated tire causes the tire tooverheat and can lead to tire failure.Underinflation also reduces fuelefficiency and tire tread life, and mayaffect the vehicle’s handling andstopping ability.
Please note that the TPMS is not asubstitute for proper tiremaintenance, and it is the driver’sresponsibility to maintain correct tirepressure, even if under-inflation hasnot reached the level to triggerillumination of the TPMS low tirepressure telltale.
CONTINUED
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Required Federal Explanation
TechnicalInform
ation
413
06/05/19 15:11:52 31STK600 0418
-
Your vehicle has also been equippedwith a TPMS malfunction indicatorto indicate when the system is notoperating properly. The TPMSmalfunction indicator is provided bya separate telltale, which displays thesymbol ‘‘TPMS’’ when illuminated.
When the malfunction indicator isilluminated,
the system may not be able to detector signal low tire pressure asintended.
TPMS malfunctions may occur for avariety of reasons, including theinstallation of replacement oralternate tires or wheels on thevehicle that prevent the TPMS fromfunctioning properly.
Always check the TPMS malfunctiontelltale after replacing one or moretires or wheels on your vehicle toensure that the replacement oralternate tires and wheels allow theTPMS to continue to functionproperly.
Tire Pressure Monitoring System (TPMS) Required Federal Explanation
414
06/05/19 15:11:57 31STK600 0419
*
*
The United States Clean Air Actsets standards for automobileemissions. It also requires thatautomobile manufacturers explain toowners how their emissions controlswork and what to do to maintainthem. This section summarizes howthe emissions controls work.Scheduled maintenance is on page
.
The burning of gasoline in yourvehicle’s engine produces several by-products. Some of these are carbonmonoxide (CO), oxides of nitrogen(NOx), and hydrocarbons (HC).Gasoline evaporating from the tankalso produces hydrocarbons. Con-trolling the production of NOx, CO,and HC is important to the environ-ment. Under certain conditions ofsunlight and climate, NOx and HCreact to form photochemical ‘‘smog.’’Carbon monoxide does not contri-bute to smog creation, but it is apoisonous gas.
Your vehicle has a positivecrankcase ventilation system. Thiskeeps gasses that build up in theengine’s crankcase from going intothe atmosphere. The positive
crankcase ventilation valve routesthem from the crankcase back to theintake manifold. They are thendrawn into the engine and burned.
As gasoline evaporates in the fueltank, an evaporative emissionscontrol canister filled with charcoaladsorbs the vapor. It is stored in thiscanister while the engine is off. Afterthe engine is started and warmed up,the vapor is drawn into the engineand burned during driving.
The onboard refueling vaporrecovery (ORVR) system capturesthe fuel vapors during refueling. Thevapors are adsorbed in a canisterfilled with activated carbon. Whiledriving, the fuel vapors are drawninto the engine and burned off.
In Canada, Acura vehicles complywith the Canadian emissionrequirements, as specified in anagreement with EnvironmentCanada, at the time they aremanufactured.
343
The Clean Air Act
Crankcase Emissions ControlSystem
Evaporative Emissions ControlSystem
Onboard Refueling VaporRecovery
Emissions Controls
TechnicalInform
ation
415
06/05/19 15:12:05 31STK600 0420
The emissions control systems arecovered by warranties separate fromthe rest of your vehicle. Read yourwarranty manual for more informa-tion.
The exhaust emissions controlsinclude three systems: PGM-FI,ignition timing control, and threeway catalytic converter. These threesystems work together to control theengine’s combustion and minimizethe amount of HC, CO, and NOx thatcome out the tailpipe. The exhaustemissions control systems areseparate from the crankcase andevaporative emissions controlsystems.
The PGM-FI system uses sequentialmultiport fuel injection.It has three subsystems: air intake,engine control, and fuel control. Thepowertrain control module (PCM)uses various sensors to determinehow much air is going into theengine. It then controls how muchfuel to inject under all operatingconditions.
This system constantly adjusts theignition timing, reducing the amountof HC, CO, and NOx produced.
The three way catalytic converter isin the exhaust system. Throughchemical reactions, it converts HC,CO, and NOx in the engine’s exhaustto carbon dioxide (CO ), nitrogen(N ), and water vapor.
The emissions control systems aredesigned and certified to worktogether in reducing emissions tolevels that comply with the Clean AirAct. To make sure the emissionsremain low, you should use only newAcura replacement parts or theirequivalent for repairs. Using lowerquality parts may increase theemissions from your vehicle.
2
2
Exhaust Emissions Controls Replacement PartsPGM-FI System
Ignition Timing Control System
Three Way Catalytic Converter
Emissions Controls
416
06/05/19 15:12:13 31STK600 0421
Always use unleaded gasoline.Even a small amount of leadedgasoline can contaminate thecatalyst metals, making the threeway catalytic converter ineffective.
Keep the engine well maintained.
The three way catalytic convertermust operate at a high temperaturefor the chemical reactions to takeplace. It can set on fire anycombustible materials that comenear it. Park your vehicle away fromhigh grass, dry leaves, or otherflammables.
A defective three way catalyticconverter contributes to air pollution,and can impair your engine’s per-formance. Follow these guidelines toprotect your vehicle’s three waycatalytic converter.
Have your vehicle diagnosed andrepaired if it is misfiring, back-firing, stalling, or otherwise notrunning properly.
The three way catalytic converterscontain precious metals that serve ascatalysts, promoting chemicalreactions to convert the exhaustgasses without affecting the metals.The catalytic converters are referredto as three-way catalysts, since theyact on HC, CO, and NOx.Replacement units must be originalAcura parts or their equivalent.
Three Way Catalytic Converter
TechnicalInform
ation
417
THREE WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER
06/05/19 15:12:20 31STK600 0422
If you take your vehicle for a stateemissions test shortly after thebattery has been disconnected orgone dead, it may not pass the test.This is because of certain ‘‘readinesscodes’’ that must be set in the on-board diagnostics for the emissionssystems. These codes are erasedwhen the battery is disconnected,and set again only after several daysof driving under a variety ofconditions.
Without touching the acceleratorpedal, start the engine, and let itidle for 20 seconds.
Keep the vehicle in Park. Increasethe engine speed to 2,000 rpm, andhold it there until the temperaturegauge rises to at least 1/4 of thescale (about 3 minutes).
Without touching the acceleratorpedal, start the engine, and let itidle for 20 seconds.
Drive your vehicle for 30 secondswhile accelerating.
If the testing facility determines thatthe readiness codes are not set, youwill be requested to return at a laterdate to complete the test. If you mustget the vehicle retested within thenext two or three days, you cancondition the vehicle for retesting bydoing the following.
Make sure the gas tank is nearly,but not completely, full (around3/4).
Make sure the vehicle has beenparked with the engine off for 6hours or more.
Make sure the ambienttemperature is between 40° and95°F.
Testing of Readiness Codes
State Emissions Testing
418
06/05/19 15:12:28 31STK600 0423
Select a nearby lightly traveledmajor highway where you canmaintain a speed of 50 to 60 mph(80 to 97 km/h) for at least 20minutes. Drive on the highway inD. Do not use the cruise control.When traffic allows, drive for 90seconds without moving theaccelerator pedal. (Vehicle speedmay vary slightly; this is okay.) Ifyou cannot do this for acontinuous 90 seconds because oftraffic conditions, drive for at least30 seconds, then repeat it twomore times (for a total of 90seconds).
Then drive in city/suburbantraffic for at least 10 minutes.When traffic conditions allow, letthe vehicle coast for severalseconds without using theaccelerator pedal or the brakepedal.
Make sure the vehicle has beenparked with the engine off for 30minutes.
If the testing facility determines thereadiness codes are still not set, seeyour dealer.
When you call or write, please giveus this information:
Vehicle Identification Number(see page )
Name and address of the dealerwho services your vehicle
Date of purchase
Mileage on your vehicle
Your name, address, and tele-phone number
A detailed description of theproblem
Name of the dealer who sold thevehicle to you
If you are dissatisfied with thedecision made by the dealership’smanagement, contact the AcuraClient Services Office.
Acura dealership personnel aretrained professionals. They shouldbe able to answer all your questions.If you encounter a problem that yourdealership does not solve to yoursatisfaction, please discuss it withthe dealership’s management. Theservice manager or general managercan help. Almost all problems aresolved in this way.
406
Customer Service Information
422
CUSTOMER RELATIONSRELATIONS AVEC LA CLIENTÈLE
American Honda Motor Co., Inc.Acura Client ServicesMail Stop 500-2N-7E1919 Torrance Blvd.Torrance, CA 90501-2746
Vortex Motor Corp.Bella InternationalP.O. Box 190816San Juan, PR 00919-0816
Tel: (787) 620-7028
06/05/19 15:12:46 31STK600 0427
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Your new vehicle is covered by thesewarranties:
provides proratedcoverage for a replacement batterypurchased from your dealer.
covers your new vehicle, except forthe battery, emissions controlsystems, and accessories againstdefects in materials andworkmanship.
these twowarranties cover your vehicle’semissions control systems. Time,mileage, and coverage areconditional. Please read yourwarranty booklet for exactinformation.
providescoverage for as long as the pur-chaser of the muffler owns thevehicle.
this warranty gives upto 100 % credit toward a replacementbattery.
a seatbelt that fails to function properly iscovered by a limited warranty.Please read your warranty bookletfor details.
Restrictions and exclusions apply toall these warranties. Please read the2007 Acura warranty informationbooklet that came with your vehiclefor precise information on warrantycoverages. Your vehicle’s originaltires are covered by theirmanufacturer. Tire warrantyinformation is in a separate booklet.
Please refer to the 2007 warrantymanual that came with your vehicle.
covers all Hondareplacement parts against defects inmaterials and workmanship.
all exterior body panels arecovered for rust-through from theinside for the specified time periodwith no mileage limit.
Acura accessories are covered underthis warranty. Time and mileagelimits depend on the type ofaccessory and other factors. Pleaseread your warranty manual fordetails.
U.S. Owners
Canadian Owners
Replacement Battery LimitedWarranty
New Vehicle Limited Warranty
Emissions Control Systems DefectsWarranty and EmissionsPerformance Warranty
Replacement Muffler LifetimeLimited Warranty
Original Equipment Battery LimitedWarranty
Seat Belt Limited Warranty
Replacement Parts LimitedWarranty
Rust Perforation Limited Warranty
Accessory Limited Warranty
Warranty Coverages
Warranty
andC
ustomer
Relations
423
06/05/19 15:12:56 31STK600 0428
If NHTSA receives similar com-plaints, it may open an investigation,and if it finds that a safety defectexists in a group of vehicles, it mayorder a recall and remedy campaign.However, NHTSA cannot becomeinvolved in individual problemsbetween you, your dealer, orAmerican Honda Motor Co., Inc.
If you believe that your vehicle has adefect which could cause a crash orcould cause injury or death, youshould immediately inform theNational Highway Traffic SafetyAdministration (NHTSA) in additionto notifying American Honda MotorCo., Inc.
To contact NHTSA, you may call theVehicle Safety Hotline toll-free at1-888-327-4236 (TTY: 1-800-424-9153);go to http://www.safercar.gov; orwrite to: Administrator, NHTSA,400 Seventh Street, SW., Washington,
DC 20590. You can also obtain other information about motor vehicle safety from http://www.safercar.gov.
Reporting Safety Defects (U.S. Vehicles)
424
06/05/19 15:13:00 31STK600 0429
-
*
*
*
*2007
ACU
The publications shown below can be purchased from HelmIncorporated. You can order in any of three ways:
Detach and mail the order form on the right half of this pageCall Helm Inc. at 1-800-782-4356Go online at
If you are interested in other years or models, contact Helm Inc.at 1-800-782-4356.
(credit card orders only)
Valid only for sales within the United States. Canadianowners should contact their authorized Acura dealer.
Authorized Manuals
Authorized
Manuals
Purchasing Factory Authorized Manuals (U.S. only)
425
ORDER TOLL FREE: 1-800-782-4356
OR
(NOTE: For Credit Card Holder Orders Only)
MINIMUM CREDIT CARD PURCHASE $10.00
Form Description
2007 Acura RDX
Service Manual
2007 Acura RDX
Electrical Troubleshooting Manual
2007 Acura RDX
Body Repair Manual
2007 Acura RDX
Owner’s Manual
2007 Acura RDX
Navigation System Manual
2007 Acura RDX
Maintenance Journal2007 Acura RDX
Quick Start Guide
Order Form for Previous Years-
Indicate Year and Model Desired
Publication
Form Number
61STK00
61STK00EL
61STK00
31STK600
31STK800
31STKM00
31STKQ00
ACU-R
Price
Each
$75.00
$50.00
$44.00
$37.00
$29.00
$15.00
$15.00
FREE
PUBLICATION NUMBERVEHICLE MODEL
Name YearQty
Price
Each
Total
Price
GRAND TOTAL
HANDLING CHARGE
Mich. Purchases
Add 6% Sales Tax
TOTAL MATERIAL
$6.95
Monday-Friday 8:00 A.M. 6:00 P.M. EST
By completing this form you can order the materials desired. You canpay by check or money order, or charge to your credit card. Mail toHelm Incorporated at the address shown on the back of the order form.
Prices are subject to change withoutnotice and without incurring obligation.
Orders are mailed within 10 days. Pleaseallow adequate time for delivery.
Prices are subject to change without notice and without incurring obligation.
www. helminc. com
06/05/19 15:13:09 31STK600 0430
-
-
-
SHIP
TO
PAYMENT
This manual covers maintenance and recommendedprocedures for repair to engine and chassis components.It is written for the journeyman mechanic, but is simpleenough for most mechanically-inclined owners to under-stand.
This manual describes the procedures involved in thereplacement of damaged body parts.
This manual complements the service manual byproviding in-depth troubleshooting information for eachelectrical circuit in your vehicle.
Authorized Manuals
Service Manual:
Electrical Troubleshooting Manual:
Body Repair Manual:
426
NOTE: Dealers and companies, please provide dealer or company name,and the name of the person to whose attention the shipment should besent. For purchases outside U.S.A. please write to the address shownbelow for a quotation.
Check or money order enclosed payable to Helm Inc U.S. funds only.Do not send cash
MasterCard
VISA Check here if your billing address is differentfrom the shipping address shown above.
Account Number Expiration: Mo. Yr.
CUSTOMER SIGNATURE DATE
Street Address No P.O. Box Number
( )
These publications cannot be returned for credit without receiving advance authorization within 14days of delivery. On returns, a restocking fee may be applied against the original order.
........................Change, How to . 349......................Change, When to . 330......................Checking Engine . 283..............Pressure Indicator . 65, 393